advertisement
TECHNICAL MANUAL
OPERATOR’S ORGANIZATIONAL,
DIRECT SUPPORT, AND
GENERAL SUPPORT
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SPECTRUM ANALYZER
HEWLETT-PACKARD MODEL 85558B
TM 11-6625-3061-14
HEADQUARTERS, DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
1 JANUARY 1986
A
TM 11-6625-3061-14
TM 11-6625-3061-14
SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS
Safety Symbols
The following safety symbols are used throughout this manual and in the instrument. Familiarize yourself with each of the symbols and its meaning before operating this instrument.
Instruction manual symbol: the apparatus will be marked with this symbol when it is necessary for the user to refer to the instruction manual in order to protect the apparatus against damage.
the equipment. Do not proceed beyond a
CAUTION sign until the indicated conditions are fully understood and met.
CAUTION
Indicates dangerous voltages.
The CAUTION sign denotes a hazard. It calls attention to an operation procedure, practice, or the like, which, if not correctly performed or adhered to, could result in damage to or destruction of part or all of
WARNING
The WARNING sign denotes a hazard. It calls attention to a procedure, practice, or the like, which, if not correctly performed or adhered to, could result in injury or loss of life. Do not proceed beyond a WARNING sign until the indicated conditions are fully understood and met.
Operation
WARNING
BEFORE THIS INSTRUMENT IS
SWITCHED ON, the oscilloscope mainframe protective earth terminal must be connected through the protective conductor of the ac power cable to a socket outlet provided with protective earth contact.
Failure to ground the instrument can result in personal injury.
WARNING
The 8558B Spectrum Analyzer should not be operated without protective covers (out of the mainframe). Adjustments,
Service and Adjustments performance tests, and service procedures which require operation of the 8558B out of the mainframe should be performed only by trained service personnel.
CAUTION
BEFORE THIS INSTRUMENT IS
SWITCHED ON, make sure that the oscilloscope mainframe is set to the voltage of the ac power source. Failure to set the ac power input to the correct voltage could cause damage to the instrument when the ac power cable is plugged in.
WARNING
There are voltages at many points in the instrument which can, if contacted, cause personal injury. Be extremely careful.
Service and adjustments should be performed only by trained service personnel.
WARNING
Any interruption of the protective
(grounding) conductor, inside or outside the instrument, or disconnection of the protective earth terminal may cause personal injury.
B
TM 11-6625-3061-14
This manual contains copyright material reproduced by permission of the Hewlett-Packard Company, Valley Forge, PA
19482.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Technical Manual )
)
No. 11-6625-3061-14)
OPERATOR'S ORGANIZATIONAL AND
DIRECT SUPPORT, AND GENERAL SUPPORT
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SPECTRUM ANALYZER HEWLETT-PACKARD MODEL 8558B
(Includes Option 001 and Option 002)
HEADQUARTERS
DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
Washington, DC, 1 January 1986
SERIAL NUMBERS
This manual applies directly to instruments with serial numbers prefixed 2147A.
With modifications described in Section VII, this manual also applies to instruments with the serial prefixes 1914A through
2145A.
For additional important information about serial numbers, see
INSTRUMENTS COVERED BY MANUAL in Section I.
REPORTING ERRORS AND RECOMMENDING IMPROVEMENTS
You can help improve this manual. If you find any mistakes or if you know of a way to improve the procedures, please let us know. Mail your letter, DA Form
2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms), or DA Form
2028-2 located in the back of this manual direct to Commander, US Army
Communications-Electronics Command and Fort Monmouth, ATTN: AMSEL-
ME-MP, Fort Monmouth, NJ 07703-5007.
In either case, a reply will be furnished direct to you.
i
Section
TM 11-6625-3061-14
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION
Scope......................................................................................................................
Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms .....................................
Maintenance Forms, Records, and Reports .............................................................
Reporting Equipment Improvement Recommendations (EIR) ..................................
Administrative Storage ............................................................................................
Destruction of Army Electronics Materiel .................................................................
ii
TM 11-6625-3061-14
CONTENTS
Section
Page
GENERAL INFORMATION..................................1-1
Section Page
IV PERFORMANCE TESTS................................4-1
Introduction ..........................................1-1
Introduction ........................................4-1
Description ...........................................1-1
Manual Organization ............................1-1
Specifications.......................................1-2
Safety Considerations ..........................1-2
Instruments Covered by Manual...........1-2
Serial Numbers ....................................1-2
Manual Changes Supplement ..............1-2
Manual Backdating Changes ................1-2
Options ................................................1-9
Option 001 ...........................................1-9
Option 002 ...........................................1-9
Option 910 ...........................................1-9
Accessories Supplied ...........................1-9
Termination..........................................1-9
Instruments Tested .............................4-1
Equipment Required...........................4-1
Test Record........................................4-1
Calibration Cycle ................................4-1
Frequency Span Accuracy..................4-2
Tuning Accuracy.................................4-7
Residual FM .......................................4-10
Noise Sidebands ................................4-13
Resolution Bandwidth
Accuracy ......................................4-15
Resolution Bandwidth
Selectivity ....................................4-20
Average Noise Level ..........................4-25
Spurious Responses ...........................4-27
Residual Responses ...........................4-34
Frequency Response..........................4-37
Bandwidth Switching
(Amplitude Variation)....................4-41
Input Attenuator Accuracy ..................4-43
Reference Level Accuracy..................4-46
Display Fidelity ...................................4-51
Calibrator Accuracy ............................4-55
Cable Adapter ......................................1-9
Side Stop Kit ........................................1-9
Graticule Overlays ...............................1-9
Equipment Required But .....................
Not Supplied ..................................1-10
Display Mainframe ...............................1-10
Extender Cable Assembly ....................1-10
Measurement Accessories ...................1-10
AC Probe .............................................1-10
Modification Kit ...................................
(Option 807 Connections) ..............1-10
Oscilloscope Camera ...........................1-10
Service Accessories .............................1-10
Recommended Test Equipment ...........1-11
......................................................
II INSTALLATION ...................................................2-1
Introduction ..........................................2-1
Initial Inspection ...................................2-1
Preparation for Use ..............................2-1
Installation............................................2-1
Side Stop Kit ........................................2-1
Graticule Overlays ...............................2-2
Mainframe Interconnections .................2-2
Operating Environment ........................2-2
Modifications........................................2-2
......................................................
III OPERATION ......................................................3-1
Introduction ..........................................3-1
Controls, Indicators, and Connectors ....3-1
Storage and Shipment..........................2-3
Environment ........................................2-3
Packaging ............................................2-3
Control Grouping..................................3-1
Variable Persistence and .....................
Storage Functions..........................3-2
Persistence and Intensity .....................3-2
Photographic Techniques .....................3-2
Operating Precautions..........................3-2
V ADJUSTMENTS .............................................5-1
Introduction ........................................5-1
Equipment Required...........................5-1
Adjustment Tools .........................5-1
Extender Cable Installation...........5-1
Related Adjustments ..........................5-1
Factory-Selected Components............5-2
Second Converter LO and
Bandpass Adjustments .................5-12
Third Converter LO and
CAL OUTPUT Adjustment............5-15
Slope Adjustment ...............................5-18
Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and
Bandpass Filter Adjustment..........5-21
Crystal and LC Bandwidth
Filter Adjustments ........................5-23
3-dB Bandwidth Adjustment................5-29
Step Gain Assembly RF
Gain Adjustment ..........................5-33
Step Amplifier Gain
Adjustments .................................5-35
+19.5V Adjustment .............................5-39
Log Amplifier Log and
Linear Adjustment ........................5-40
Sweep Time Per Division
Adjustment ...................................5-45
Frequency Control and
DPM Adjustments ........................5-48
1-dB Offset Adjustment ......................5-51
iii
TM 11-6625-3061-14
CONTENTS
Section Page Section
VI REPLACEABLE PARTS ......................................6-1
Schematic Symbols, Terminology,
Introduction ..........................................6-1
Replaceable Parts List .........................6-1
Ordering Information ............................6-1
......................................................
VII MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES ...................7-1
Introduction ..........................................7-1
Manual Change....................................
SERVICE
Instructions ....................................7-2
......................................................8-1
Introduction ..........................................8-1
Service Information Index ....................8-1
Schematic, block and component location
diagrams are listed under ILLUSTRATIONS.
Page
and Voltage Levels.......................8-1
Test Equipment ..................................8-1
Troubleshooting..................................8-1
General ........................................8-1
Troubleshooting Hints...................8-1
General Principles of Operation..........8-4
Front Switch Assembly A2,
Disassembly and Repair...............8-107
NOTE
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
Page Figure Figure
HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer
with Accessories Supplied........................... 1-0
Typical Serial Number Label............................ 1-2
Service Accessories .......................................1-12
Location of Side Stops..................................... 2-3
HP 8558B Installed in HP 182T
Display Mainframe ...................................... 3-5
Rear Panel Controls and Connectors ............... 3-7
Frequency Span Accuracy Test Setup ............. 4-3
Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for
Ninth Spectral Line...................................... 4-5
Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for
Seventeenth Spectral Line .......................... 4-5
Tuning Accuracy Test Setup ............................ 4-9
Residual FM Test Setup .................................4-13
Example of Residual FM ................................4-14
Noise Sideband Test Setup ............................4-17
Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup,
3 MHz to 100 kHz ......................................4-19
Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup,
1 kHz to 30 kHz .........................................4-21
Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup,
1 kHz to 30 kHz .........................................4-25
Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup,
100 kHz to 3 MHz ......................................4-28
Average Noise Level Measurement ................4-32
Harmonic Distortion Test Setup ......................4-33
Intermodulation Distortion Test Setup .............4-36
Intermodulation Distortion Products ................4-37
Residual Responses Test Setup .....................4-41
Frequency Response Test Setup ....................4-45
Input Attenuator Accuracy Test Setup.............4-51
Reference Level Accuracy Test Setup ............4-55
Amplitude Log Display Accuracy Test Setup...4-61
Calibrator Accuracy Test Setup ......................4-65
Second Converter LO and
Bandpass Adjustment Test Setup...............5-13
Page
Special Adapter Used in Second Converter
LO and Bandpass Test Setup................5-14
Third Converter LO and CAL OUTPUT
Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-17
Slope Adjustment Test Setup.....................5-21
Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and Bandpass
Filter Adjustment Test Setup .................5-25
Crystal and LC Bandwidth Filter
Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-27
Crystal Short Configuration........................5-28
Adjusting Crystal Symmetry and
Crystal Centering ..................................5-29
3- dB Bandwidth Adjustment Test Setup..........5-33
Step Gain Assembly RF Gain
Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-37
Step Amplifier Gain Adjustment
Test Setup ............................................5-39
+19.5V Adjustment Test Setup ..................5-43
Log Amplifier and Linear Adjustment
Test Setup ............................................5-45
Sweep Time Per Division Adjustment
Test Setup ............................................5-51
Frequency Control and DPM Adjustments
Test Setup ............................................5-55
l-dB Offset Adjustment Test Setup.............5-59
Cable Assembly W1 (08558-60038 or
08558-60031) Replaceable Parts ..........6-29
Mechanical Chassis Parts ..........................6-31
Front Switch Assembly ..............................6-33
Mechanical Chassis Parts (CHANGE A) ......7-8
Front Panel Assembly (CHANGE A) ..........7-11
Front Switch Assembly A2,
Schematic (CHANGE A) .......................7-13
Log Amplifier Log and Linear Adjustment
Test Setup (CHANGE B).......................7-15
A14 Log Amplifier, Component and Test
Point Locations (CHANGE B)................7-24
iv
TM 11-6625-3061-14
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
Page Figure Figure
A14 Log Amplifier Assembly Schematic
(CHANGE B)..............................................7-25
A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,
Component Locations (CHANGE C)...........7-27
P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,
Schematic Diagram (CHANGE C)..............7-28
A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,
Component Locations (CHANGE F) ...........7-29
P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,
Schematic Diagram (CHANGE F) ..............7-30
Symbols Used in Schematics and
Block Diagrams........................................... 8-5
Conditions for Schematic Diagram
Measurements ............................................ 8-9
CRT Displays for Residual FM
Troubleshooting .........................................8-13
Baseline Step Caused by Failure of A7Q18 ....8-13
Simplified Block Diagram ...............................8-15
Troubleshooting Block Diagram ......................8-17
A1A2U1 Clock ................................................8-20
Integrator and EOC Waveforms for FRE-
QUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz..........8-20
A1A2U1 Outputs for FREQUENCY MHz
Display of 1296 MHz ..................................8-21
A1A2 DPM Driver Component Locations ........8-22
A1A2 DPM Driver (and DPM Display),
Schematic..................................................8-23
Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1,
Component Locations ................................8-26
A2 Front Switch, Schematic Diagram .............8-27
A3 Input Attenuator.........................................8-31
A6 YIG Oscillator............................................8-31
A4 First Converter, Component
Locations ...................................................8-32
A5 Second Converter Assembly,
Component Locations ................................8-33
A3 Input Attenuator, A4 First Converter,
A5 Second Converter, and A6 YIG
Oscillator, Schematic .................................8-35
A7 Frequency Control Assembly,
Component and Test Point Locations.........8-42
A7 Frequency Control, Schematic ..................8-43
Page
Simplified Schematic of Sweep Generator
in AUTO Mode ......................................8-46
A8 Sweep Generator Assembly,
Component and Test Point Locations....8-52
A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic ...............8-53
Bandpass Amplifier Tank Circuit,
Simplified Schematic ............................8-59
A9 Third Converter Assembly, and
A10 Second IF Assembly, Component
Locations ..............................................8-60
A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,
Schematic.............................................8-61
Crystal Pole, Simplified Schematic ............8-65
LC Pole, Simplified Schematic ..................8-66
A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly,
Component and Test Point Locations....8-68
A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1, Schematic.....8-69
Equivalent Circuit for
Step Gain Amplifiers .............................8-72
A12 Step Gain Assembly, Component and
Test Point Locations..............................8-74
A12 Step Gain, Schematic.........................8-75
A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly,
Component and Test Point Locations....8-78
A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2, Schematic.....8-79
Simplified Log Amplifier Stage...................8-81
A14 Log Amplifier Assembly,
Component Locations ...........................8-84
A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic ...8-85
Simplified Vertical Driver Circuit ................8-91
Simplified Blanking Circuit .........................8-92
A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly,
Component and Test Point Locations....8-94
A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking,
Schematic.............................................8-95
A16 Motherboard Assembly, Components
and Test Point Locations.......................8-97
A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram ......8-97
A17 Inverter Assembly, Component
Locations ............................................ 8-102
A17 Inverter, Schematic .......................... 8-103
Locations of Major Assemblies ................ 8-105
LIST OF TABLES
Page Table Table
HP Model 8558B Specifications....................... 1-3
Model 8558B/180-Series
Supplemental Characteristics...................... 1-6
Parts Included in Modification
Kit 00180-69503.........................................1-10
Page
Recommended Test Equipment.................1-14
Side Stop Kit (08558-60131)........................2-1
HP Model 8558B Mainframe
Interconnections......................................2-4
Performance Tests ......................................4-1
V
C.
E.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
LIST OF TABLES
Page Table Table
Narrow Span Width Error Measurement .......... 4-7
Tuning Accuracy Measurement.......................4-11
Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity ....................4-29
Frequency Response, 5 MHz to 1500 MHz. ...4-48
Frequency Response, 100 kHz to 5 MHz ........4-48
Amplitude Accuracy, Switching Between ..............
Bandwidths ................................................4-50
Input Attenuator Accuracy...............................4-52
IF Gain Accuracy in LOG Mode ......................4-57
IF Gain Accuracy in Linear Mode....................4-58
Conversion Table, Deviation in .............................
Linear Mode...............................................4-58
Vernier Accuracy ............................................4-59
Amplitude Log Display Accuracy.....................4-63
Sample Computations of Amplitude......................
Log Display Accuracy.................................4-63
Performance Test Record...............................4-69
Adjustable Components ................................... 5-3
Factory Selected Components in ..........................
Alpha-Numeric Order .................................. 5-7
HP Part Numbers of Standard Value ....................
Replacement Components .......................... 5-8
Page
Related Adjustments..................................5-11
REF LEVEL FINE Control Check ...............5-41
REFERENCE LEVEL Control Check .........5-42
Log Fidelity Check .....................................5-47
Linear Gain Adjustments............................5-48
Log Gain Adjustment Limits .......................5-48
Log Amplifier Output Limits .......................5-49
Reference Designations and Abbreviations..6-2
Manufacturers Code List ..............................6-4
Replaceable Parts .......................................6-5
Manual Change Requirement by
Serial Number.........................................7-1
Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)..................7-6
Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)..................7-7
Linear Gain Adjustment Limits ...................7-17
Log Fidelity Check .....................................7-18
Log Gain Adjustment Limits .......................7-19
Replaceable Parts (CHANGE B)................7-20
Service Information .....................................8-2
Residual FM Troubleshooting
Procedure .............................................8-11
Truth Table for A2DSI Display ...................8-20
APPENDICES
APPENDIX
REFERENCES ....................................................................... A-1
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM LIST ...................................... B-1
ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION LIST(Not Applicable)
MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION............................................... D-1
EXPENDABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIAL LIST(Not Applicable) vi
TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION 0.
INTRODUCTION
0-1. SCOPE
This manual describes Spectrum Analyzer, Hewlett-Packard Model 8558B and provides instructions for operation and maintenance.
0-2. CONSOLIDATED INDEX OF ARMY PUBLICATIONS AND BLANK FORMS
Refer to the latest issue of DA Pam 310-1 to determine whether there are new editions, changes or additional publications pertaining to the equipment.
0-3. MAINTENANCE FORMS, RECORDS, AND REPORTS a. Reports of Maintenance and Unsatisfactory Equipment. Department of the Army forms and procedures used for equipment maintenance will be those prescribed by DA Pam 738-750, as contained in Maintenance Management
Update.
b. Report of Packaging and Handling Deficiencies. Fill out and forward SF 364 (Report of Discrepancy (ROD)) as prescribed in AR 735-11-2/DLAR 4140.55/ NAVMATINST 4355.73A/AFR 400-54/MCO 4430.3F.
c. Discrepancy in Shipment Report (DISREP)(SF 361). Fill out and forward Discrepancy in Shipment Report
(DISREP)(SF 361) as prescribed in AR 55-38/ NAVSUPINST 4610.33C/AFR 75-18/MCO P4610.19D/DLAR 4500.15.
0-4. REPORTING EQUIPMENT IMPROVEMENT RECOMMENDATIONS (EIR)
If your equipment needs improvement, let us know. Send us an EIR. You, the user, are the only one who can tell us what you don't like about your equipment. Let us know why you don't like the design. Put it on an SF 368 (Quality
Deficiency Report). Mail it to Commander, US Army Communications-Electronics Command and Fort Monmouth,
ATTN: AMSEL-ME-MP, Fort Monmouth, NJ 07703-5007. We'll send you a reply.
0-5. ADMINISTRATIVE STORAGE
Administrative storage of equipment issued to and used by Army activities will have preventive maintenance performed in accordance with the PMCS charts before storing. When removing the equipment from administrative storage the
PMCS should be performed to assure operational readiness. Disassembly and repacking of equipment for shipment or limited storage is covered in paragraph 2-23.
0-6. DESTRUCTION OF ARMY ELECTRONICS MATERIEL
Destruction of Army electronics materiel to prevent enemy use shall be in accordance with TM 750-244-2.
0-1
Model 8558B
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 1-1. HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer with Accessories Supplied
1-0
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
1-1. INTRODUCTION
1-2. This Operation and Service manual contains information required to install, operate, test, adjust, and service the Hewlett-Packard Model 8558B Spectrum
Analyzer. Figure 1-1 shows the standard instrument and
accessories supplied. This section covers instrument identification, description, options, accessories, specifications, and other basic information.
1-3. DESCRIPTION
1-4. The HP 8558B displays the amplitude and frequency of each component of an input signal on a
CRT. This display gives quantitative information often not available from a conventional oscilloscope. The HP
8558B is capable of measuring signals from -117 dBm to +30 dBm over a frequency range of 100 kHz to 1500
MHz.
001: 110 dBm to + 30 dBm
002: 63 dBmV to + 80 dBmV
1-5. The complete measuring system includes the HP
8558B Spectrum Analyzer plugged into a compatible
Hewlett-Packard display mainframe.
1-6. MANUAL ORGANIZATION
1-7. This manual is divided into eight sections as follows:
SECTION I, GENERAL INFORMATION, contains the
instrument description and specifications, explains accessories and options, and lists recommended test equipment.
SECTION II, INSTALLATION AND OPERATION
VERIFICATION, contains information concerning initial mechanical inspection, preparation for use, operating environment, packaging and shipping, and operation verification.
SECTION I.
GENERAL INFORMATION
SECTION III, OPERATION, contains detailed
instructions for operation of the instrument.
SECTION IV, PERFORMANCE TESTS, contains the
necessary tests to verify that the electrical operation of the instrument is in accordance with published specifications.
SECTION V, ADJUSTMENTS, contains the necessary
adjustment procedures to properly adjust the instrument after repair.
SECTION VI, REPLACEABLE PARTS, contains the
information necessary to order parts and/or assemblies for the instrument.
SECTION VII, MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES,
contains backdating information to make this manual compatible with earlier equipment configurations.
SECTION VIII, SERVICE, contains schematic diagrams,
block diagrams, component location illustrations, circuit descriptions, and troubleshooting information to aid in repair of the instrument.
1-8. On the title page of this manual, below the manual part number, is a microfiche part number. This number may be used to order 4-by 6-inch microfilm transparencies of the manual. Each microfiche contains up to 60 photo-duplicates of the manual pages. The microfiche package also includes the latest Manual
Changes supplement.
1-9. Where text changes are required to reflect Options
001 and 002, these changes are shown in bold type immediately following applicable text. Notes are also included in tables and illustrations where users of
Options 001 and 002 need to be informed of differences from the standard instrument. Users of the standard instrument should ignore references to Options 001 and
002.
1-1
Model 8558B
1-10. SPECIFICATIONS
1-11. Instrument specifications are listed in Table 1-1.
These specifications are the performance standards or
limits against which the instrument is tested. Table 1-2
lists supplemental characteristics. Supplemental characteristics are not specifications but are typical characteristics included as additional information for the user.
NOTE
To ensure that the HP Model 8558B meets the specifications listed in
Table 1-1, performance tests (Section
IV) should be performed every six
months.
1-12. SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS
1-13. Before operating this instrument, you should familiarize yourself with the safety markings on the instrument and safety instructions in this manual. This instrument has been manufactured and tested according to international safety standards. However, to ensure safe operation of the instrument and personal safety of the user and service personnel, the cautions and warnings in this manual must be followed. Refer to the
Safety Considerations at the front of the manual. Refer also to individual sections of this manual for detailed safety notation concerning the use of the instrument as described in those individual sections.
1-14. INSTRUMENTS COVERED BY MANUAL
1-15. Serial Numbers
1-16. Attached to the rear of your instrument is a mylar serial number label. The serial number is in two parts.
The first four digits and letter are the serial number
prefix; the last five digits are the suffix (see Figure 1-2).
The prefix is the same for all identical instruments; it changes only when a change is made to the instrument.
The suffix, however, is assigned sequentially and is different for each instrument. The contents of this manual apply to instruments with the serial number prefix(es) listed under SERIAL NUMBERS on the title page.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 1-2. Typical Serial Number Label
1-17. Manual Changes Supplement
1-18. An instrument manufactured after the printing of this manual might have a serial number prefix that is not listed on the title page. This unlisted serial number prefix indicates that the instrument is different from those described in this manual. The manual for this newer instrument is accompanied by a yellow Manual
Changes supplement. This supplement contains change information that explains how to adapt the manual to the newer instrument.
1-19. In addition to change information, the supplement may contain information for correcting errors in the manual. To keep this manual as current and accurate as possible, Hewlett-Packard recommends that you periodically request the latest Manual Changes supplement. The supplement carries a manual identification block that includes the model number, print date of the manual, and manual part number.
Complimentary copies of the supplement are available from Hewlett-Packard. Addresses of Hewlett-Packard offices are located at the back of this manual.
1-20. Manual Backdating Changes
1-21. Instruments manufactured before the printing of this manual have been assigned serial number prefixes other than those for which this manual was written directly. Manual backdating information is provided in
Section VII to adapt this manual to earlier serial number
prefixes. For instruments with serial number prefixes
1829A and earlier, refer to the HP 8558B Operating and
Service Manual dated October 1977, HP part number
08558-90043, and to the Manual Changes supplement supplied with that manual.
1-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
FREQUENCY SPECIFICATIONS
FREQUENCY RANGE
100 kHz to 1500 MHz
FREQUENCY SPANS
Per Division (MHz/Div, kHz/Div)
14 frequency scale calibrations in 1-2-5 sequence from 5 kHz/div to 100 MHz/div. Start or center frequency is set with the TUNING control and indicated by the FREQUENCY MHz readout.
Zero Span (0)
Analyzer functions as a manually tuned receiver, at the frequency indicated by the FREQUENCY MHz readout, for time-domain display of signal modulation.
FREQUENCY ACCURACY
Tuning Accuracy
Frequency MHz readout (start or center frequency), after zeroing on the LO feedthrough and operating the
FREQUENCY CAL control, +10°C to +40°C: 0-195
MHz:
±
(1 MHz+20% of frequency span per division)
195-1500 MHz:
±
(5 MHz + 20% of frequency span per division)
Frequency Readout Resolution
0-195 MHz: 100 kHz
195-1500 MHz: 1 MHz
Frequency Span Accuracy
±
5% of displayed frequency separation
SPECTRAL RESOLUTION AND STABILITY
Resolution Bandwidths
Eight selectable resolution (3-dB) bandwidths in 1-3 sequence from 1 kHz to 3 MHz. Bandwidth may be selected independently or coupled with frequency span. Optimum ratio of frequency span to resolution bandwidth is indicated by alignment of markers ( > < ) on the two controls.
Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy:
Individual resolution bandwidth 3-dB points:
±
20% (+10°C to +40
°
C)
Selectivity:
60-dB: 3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio: <15:1
Stability
Residual FM:
<1 kHz p-p in 0.1 second
Noise Sidebands:
>65 dB down, >50 kHz from center of CW signal with 1 kHz resolution bandwidth and full video filtering.
Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (1 of 3)
Video Filter
Post-detection low-pass filter averages displayed noise for a smooth trace. The MAX (detent) position selects a video filter bandwidth of approximately 1.5 Hz for noise level measurement.
AMPLITUDE SPECIFICATIONS
AMPLITUDE RANGE
-117 dBm to +30 dBm
001: - 110 dBm to +30 dBm
002: -63 dBm V to +80 dBm V
Maximum Input (Damage) Levels
Total Power:
+30 dBm (1W, 7.1 Vrms)
001: +30 dBm (1W, 8.7 Vrms)
002: +80 dBm V (1.3W, 10 Vrms) dc or ac (<100 Hz):
±
50V
Peak Pulse Power:
+50 dBm (100W, <10 æsec pulse width, 0.01% duty cycle) with input attenuation >20 dB
002: + 100 dBm V (130W)
Average Noise Level
The displayed average noise level determines sensitivity (minimum discernible signal). Signals at this input level peak approximately 3 dB above the displayed noise.
Maximum average noise level with 10 kHz resolution bandwidth, 0 dB input attenuation, and maximum (MAX) video filtering:
<-107 dBm (1-1500 MHz)
001: <-100 dBm (1-1500 MHz)
002: <-53 dBmV (1-1500 MHz)
Calibrated Display Range
Log (from Reference Level):
70 dB with 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale
8 dB with 1 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale
Linear:
8 divisions with LIN Amplitude Scale
AMPLITUDE ACCURACY
With AUTO sweep time selected, amplitude accuracy is determined by one or more of the following factors, depending on the measurement technique.
Calibrator Output
-30 dBm +1 dB (into 50
Ω
)
280 MHz
±
300 kHz
001: -30 dBm + 1 dB (into 75
Ω
)
002: +20 dBm V + 1 dB (into 75
Ω
)
1-3
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (2 of 3)
Reference Level
10-dB steps and a 12-dB vernier for calibrated
Reference Level adjustment from -112 dBm to +60 dBm.
(002: -62 dBm V to + 1 10 dBm V) 1
Step Accuracy:
Steps referenced with 0 dB input attenuation.
-10 dBm to -80 dBm:
±
0.5 dB
-10 dBm to -100 dBm:
±
1.0 dB
Vernier Accuracy
±
0.5 dB
Frequency Response
Frequency response includes input attenuator, limiter, and mixer flatness:
6<
±
1.0 dB with 10 dB input attenuation
Input Attenuator
0 dB to 70 dB of input attenuation selectable in 10-dB steps
Step Accuracy:
0 dB to 70 dB: <
±
0.5 dB per 10-dB step
Maximum Cumulative Error:
0 dB to 70 dB: <
±
1.0 dB
Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude Variation)
Bandwidths 3 MHz to 300 kHz: <
±
0.5 dB
Bandwidths 3 MHz to 1 kHz: <
±
1.0 dB2
Display Fidelity
CRT linearity and log or linear fidelity affect amplitude accuracy at levels other than Reference Level.
Log Incremental Accuracy:
±
0.1 dB per dB from Reference Level
Log Maximum Cumulative Error:
<
±
1.5 dB over entire 70-dB range
Linear Accuracy:
±
3% of Reference Level
SPURIOUS RESPONSES
Second Harmonic Distortion:
>70 dB3 below a -40 dBm input signal with 0 dB input attenuation.
001: -35 dBm input signal
002: + 15 dBm V input signal
Third Order Intermodulation Distortion:
>70 dB3 below two -30 dBm input signals, separated by >50 kHz, with 0 dB input attenuation.
001: two -25 dBm input signals
002: two +25 dBm V input signals
Image and Multiple Responses:
>70 dB3 below a -40 dBm input level with 0dB input attenuation.
001: -35 dBm input level
002: + 15 dBm V input level
RESIDUAL RESPONSES
<-100 dBm (1-1500 MHz) with 0 dB input attenuation and no signal present at input.
001: <-95 dBm (1--1500 MHz)
002: <-50 dBm V (1- 1500 MHz)
SWEEP SPECIFICATIONS
SWEEP TIME
Automatic (AUTO):
Sweep time adjusted automatically to maintain absolute amplitude calibration for any combination of frequency span, resolution bandwidth, and video filter bandwidth.
Calibrated Sweep Times (sec/Div, mSec/Div):
16 selectable sweep times in 1-2-5 sequence from
0.1 msec/div to 10 sec/div, provided primarily for time-domain calibration in zero span (0).
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
TEMPERATURE RANGE
Operating: 0°C to +55°C
Storage: -40°C to +75°C.
HUMIDITY RANGE
Type-tested from 50% to 95% relative humidity (-
<+40°C) per requirements of MIL-STD-810C, Method
507.1, Procedure IV.
EMI
Conducted and radiated interference is in compliance with MIL-STD 461A, Methods CE03 and RE02, CISPR
Publication 11 (1975) and Messempfaenger
Postverfuegung 526/527/79 (Kennzeichnung Mit F-
Nummer/Funkschutzzeichen).
1 Input level not to exceed +30 dBm (002: +80 dBm V) damage level.
2 100 kHz bandwidth limited to < 80% relative humidity. Amplitude variation is < +2.5 at 95% relative humidity, +40°C.
3 > 60 dB for 100 kHz to 5 MHz input signals. k,
1-4
Model 8558B
Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (3 of 3)
POWER REQUIREMENTS
HP Model 182T/180TR Display with HP Model
8558B Spectrum Analyzer:
48440 Hz, 115 or 230 volts (
±
10%), 200VA maximum, convection cooled.
HP Model 181T/181TR Display with HP Model
8558B Spectrum Analyzer:
48440 Hz, 115 or 230 volts (
±
10%), 225 VA maximum, convection cooled.
WEIGHT
HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer:
Net: 5.5 kg (12 lbs)
Shipping: 10.5 kg (23 lbs)
HP Model 182T Display:
Net: 12.5 kg (27 lbs)
Shipping: 16.5 kg (36 lbs)
HP Model 181T Display:
Net: 11.0 kg (24 lbs)
Shipping: 15.5 kg (34 lbs)
HP Model 181TR Display:
Net: 12.0 kg (26 lbs)
Shipping: 17.5 kg (38 lbs)
HP Model 180TR Display:
Net: 12.0 kg (26 lbs)
Shipping: 17.5 kg (38 lbs)
DIMENSIONS
HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer:
TM 11-6625-3061-14
1-5
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (1 of 3)
SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS
NOTE:
Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.
FREQUENCY CHARACTERISTICS
FREQUENCY ACCURACY
FREQUENCY ZERO
Adjusts digital FREQUENCY MHz readout. FRE-
QUENCY ZERO control may be used to calibrate the frequency readout on a known signal or on the
LO feedthrough.
FREQUENCY CAL
Removes tuning hysteresis from first LO (YIG oscillator). FREQUENCY CAL button should be pressed to maintain FREQUENCY MHz readout accuracy whenever TUNING is changed by more than 50 MHz.
FREQUENCY RANGE
OUT-OF-RANGE BLANKING
The CRT trace is automatically blanked whenever the spectrum analyzer is swept or tuned beyond its frequency range (approximately -50 MHz and 1600
MHz).
SPECTRAL RESOLUTION AND STABILITY
FREQUENCY DRIFT
At fixed start/center frequency, after 2-hour warmup:
<50 kHz in 10 minutes.
With temperature changes: <200 kHz/°C
RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SHAPE
Approximately gaussian (synchronously-tuned,
4-pole filter).
SPECTRAL RESOLUTION
The following graph shows typical spectrum analyzer resolution for different resolution bandwidths.
present at the input that may be measured within the limits of specified accuracy, sensitivity, and distortion
(i.e. spurious responses): >70 dB
FREQUENCY RESPONSE AND AVERAGE
NOISE LEVEL
The following graphs show typical frequency response and average noise level versus frequency.
Signal Resolution vs. Frequency Separation
AMPLITUDE CHARACTERISTICS
AMPLITUDE RANGE AND ACCURACY
DYNAMIC RANGE
Maximum power ratio of two signals simultaneously
1-6
(Option 002)
Average Noise Level and Frequency Response
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (2 of 3)
SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS
NOTE:
Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.
GAIN COMPRESSION
Gain compression is typically less than 1 dB for a -
10 dBm input level with 0 dB input attenuation.
001: -5 dBm input level
002: +45 dBmV input level
AMPLITUDE SCALE SWITCHING
Reference Level variation is typically less than
±
1 dB for any change in Amplitude Scale.
SPURIOUS RESPONSES
SECOND HARMONIC AND THIRD ORDER
INTERMODULATION DISTORTION
The graphs below illustrate typical second harmonic and third order intermodulation distortion.
SWEEP CHARACTERISTICS
SWEEP TIME
CALIBRATED SWEEP TIME ACCURACY
(Sec/DIV, mSec/DIV)
Sweep times are typically
±
10% of indicated value.
MANUAL
Spectrum analyzer may be swept manually, in either direction, with front panel control.
SWEEP TRIGGER
FREE RUN
End of each sweep triggers new sweep.
LINE
Sweep triggered at ac line frequency.
VIDEO
Sweep triggered on post-detection video waveform.
One-half major division of vertical deflection required to trigger sweep.
SINGLE
Single sweep started or reset by turning SWEEP
TRIGGER clockwise momentarily.
FRONT PANEL INPUT AND OUTPUT
CHARACTERISTICS
SIGNAL INPUT
INPUT IMPEDANCE
50 ohms nominal; Precision Type N female connector.
001 and 002: 75 ohms nominal; 75-ohm BNC female connector.
INPUT SWR
<1.5 SWR with >10 dB input attenuation
001 and 002: <1.5 SWR
Distortion vs. Mixer Level
1-7
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (3 of 3)
SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS
NOTE:
Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.
CAL OUTPUT
-30 dBm at 280 MHz with second through fourth harmonics greater than -70 dBm (into 50 ohms).
001:-30 dBm at 280 MHz (into 75 ohms)
002: +20 dBm V at 280 MHz (into 75 ohms)
1ST LO OUTPUT
+10 dBm nominal into 50 ohms, 2.05-3.55 GHz.
Terminate with a 50-ohm load when not in use.
PROBE POWER
+15V, -12.6V, and GND (150 mA maximum) for use with HP High-Impedance Probes (i.e. HP 1120A,
1121A, 1123A, 1124A). The HP 1121A is recommended for its low noise characteristics.1'
REAR PANEL OUTPUT CHARACTERISTICS2
VERTICAL, PENLIFT/BLANKING, AND HORIZONTAL
OUTPUTS (AUX A, B, D)
These outputs are compatible with and may be used to drive HP X-Y Recorders (using positive pencoils or TTL penlift input) and CRT monitors.
1See Section II for details regarding use with 001 and
002 75ohm inputs.
2Rear panel outputs refer to 180T-series display mainframes and other 180-series mainframes with
Option 807 installed. Horizontal, vertical, and blanking outputs, attenuated and shifted in dc level, are available on other 180-series mainframes at the MAIN SWEEP,
MAIN GATE, and DELAYED GATE outputs, respectively. DO NOT connect an X-Y recorder to the
DELAYED GATE OUTPUT, or damage will result.
AUX A VERTICAL OUTPUT
BNC output provides detected video signal from a
50-ohm output impedance. Typical 0-800 mV range corresponds to full 8-division CRT vertical deflection.
AUX B PENLI FT/BLANKING OUTPUT
BNC output provides a +15V penlift/blanking signal from a 10K-ohm output impedance when CRT trace is blanked. Otherwise, output is low at OV (low impedance, 150 mA max.) for an unblanked trace.
AUX C 21.4 MHz IF OUTPUT
BNC output provides 21.4 MHz IF signal (linearly related to spectrum analyzer RF input) from a 50ohm output impedance. Output bandwidth controlled by spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW setting; output amplitude controlled by INPUT
ATTEN, REFERENCE LEVEL FINE, and first six
REFERENCE LEVEL positions (i.e. -10 through -60 dBm with 0 dB input attenuation). Output level is approximately -10 dBm into 50 ohms with a signal displayed at Reference Level.
002: (i.e. +40 to -10 dBmV with 0 dB input attenuation).
AUX D HORIZONTAL OUTPUT
BNC output provides horizontal sweep voltage from a 5K-ohm output impedance. -5V to +5V range corresponds to full 10-division CRT horizontal deflection.
1-8
Model 8558B
1-22. This information should not be confused with information contained in the yellow Manual Changes supplement, which is intended to adapt this manual to instrument changes that are accomplished after its printing.
1-23. OPTIONS
CAUTION
The two 75-ohm BNC connectors on
Option 001 and Option 002 instruments are not compatible with
50ohm BNC connectors. Direct use of 50-ohm BNC connectors with these instruments might damage the
INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.
1-24. Option 001
1-25. Option 001 provides direct-measurement capability in a 75-ohm system. The BNC input and calibration-output connectors have 75
Ω
impedance
(nominal). Option 001 is calibrated in dBm, providing a measurement range from -110 dBm to +30 dBm.
Throughout the manual, differences between the standard instrument and Option 001 are given in boldface type following applicable text references and as necessary in tables and illustrations.
1-26. Option 002
1-27. Option 002 provides direct-measurement capability in a 75-ohm system. The BNC input and calibration-output connectors have 75Q impedance
(nominal). Option 002 is calibrated in dBmV, providing a measurement range from -63 dBmV to + 80 dBmV.
Throughout the manual, differences between the standard instrument and Option 002 are given in boldface type following applicable text references and as necessary in tables and illustrations.
1-28. Option 910
1-29. One additional Operation and Service manual is provided for each Option 910 ordered. To obtain additional manuals after initial shipment, order by the manual part number, which appears on the title page and on the back cover.
1-9
1-30. ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED
TM 11-6625-3061-14
1-31. The following accessories, supplied with the
instrument, are shown in Figure 1-1:
•
•
BNC termination
Cable adapter
•
•
Side stop kit
Graticule overlays
1-32. Termination
1-33. A BNC, 50-ohm termination, HP Model 11593A, is supplied for the front-panel 1ST LO OUTPUT.
1-34. Cable Adapter
1-35. A Type N male to BNC female adapter, HP part number 1250-0780, is supplied with the standard instrument for the use of lightweight cables with BNC connectors.
1-36. Side Stop Kit
1-37. A side stop kit, HP part number 08558-60131, is supplied to prevent the spectrum analyzer from sliding out of the mainframe. When the side stops are installed, the plug-in cannot be removed from the
mainframe. Refer to Section II for installation or
removal of the side stops.
1-38. Graticule Overlays
Three graticule overlays provide the operator with reference-level labels for the CRT. HP Part Number
5020-8565 is the overlay for 180-series display mainframes. HP Part Number 5020-8566 is the overlay for 181-series display mainframes. HP Part Number
5020-8567 is the overlay for 182- series display mainframes. For proper installation of the graticule
Model 8558B
1-39. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED BUT NOT
SUPPLIED
1-40. Display Mainframe
1-41. A 180T-series display mainframe (180TR, 181T,
181TR, or 182T) is recommended for use with the HP
Model 8558B. In the 180T-series mainframe, the rearpanel auxiliary output connectors (AUX A, AUX B, AUX
C, and AUX D) provide, respectively, Vertical Output,
Pen Lift Output, 21.4 MHz IF Output, and Horizontal
Output.
1-42. A standard 180-series Display mainframe
(180A/AR, 180C/D, 181A/AR, 182A/C, or 184A/B) provides only horizontal, vertical, and blanking rear panel outputs. Furthermore, these outputs are attenuated and shifted in dc level. Unbuffered rear panel outputs (similar to the 180T-series) are provided only if Option 807 is installed.
1-43. Extender Cable Assembly connector.
CAUTION
TM 11-6625-3061-14
The 75-ohm BNC input connector on
ANT Option 001 and 002 instruments is not compatible with 50-ohm BNC connectors. Direct connection of an
AC probe might damage the input
001 and 002: The AC probes have a 50-ohm output impedance. Use of a probe with the 75-ohm Option 001 or 002 without proper impedance matching causes a +
1.58 dB error in displayed signal levels.
1-48. Modification Kit (Option 807 Connections)
1-49. A modification kit, HP part number 00180-69503, provides the materials and information necessary to install unbuffered rear panel connections (formerly included in Option 807) in the following display mainframes: 180A/AR, 180C/D, 181A/AR, 182A/C, and
184A/B. Refer to Table 1-3 for a description of parts
included in the modification kit.
1-50. Oscilloscope Camera
1-44. An Extender Cable Assembly (Figure 1-3), HP
Part Number 5060-0303, allows operation of the HP
8558B outside the display mainframe. This provides access to the HP 8558B for necessary adjustments and some performance tests. This cable is also useful for troubleshooting.
1-45. MEASUREMENT ACCESSORIES
1-51. The HP Model 197B, Option 002, General
Purpose Camera can be used with 180- and 181-series display mainframes to make a permanent record of measurements. The HP 10367A adapter allows the camera to be used with 182-series mainframes.
1-46. AC Probe
1-47. The HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer has a front-panel PROBE POWER connector for the use of high-impedance active probes such as the HP 1120A,
HP 1121A, HP 1123A, and HP 1124A. High-impedance probes permit testing of high-frequency circuits without significant loading effects. The low-noise, AC-coupled
HP 1121A is preferred for use with the HP 8558B.
1-52. SERVICE ACCESSORIES
1-53. Service accessories are shown in Figure 1-3.
Table 1-3. Parts Included in Modification Kit 00180-69503
Quantity
1
1
2
1
Description
Output Amplifier Assembly (Auxiliary Output
Board)
Label
3/4 inch pieces of shrink tubing
Service Note
HP Part Number
00180-66551
7120-3116
0890-0720
180A/AR-10, 180C/D-2, 181A/AR8
182A/C-1, or 184/B-1 (modification is similar for all instruments listed)
1-10
Model 8558B
1-54. RECOMMENDED TEST EQUIPMENT
1-55. Equipment required for operation verification, performance tests, adjustments, and
TM 11-6625-3061-14
troubleshooting of the HP Model 8558B is listed in Table
1-4. Other equipment may be substituted if it meets or
exceeds the critical specifications listed in the table.
1-11
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 1-3. Service Accessories (1 of 2)
1-12
Model 8558B
(6)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Item
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Description
Board Puller, 2 prongs to lift PC boards
Extender Board, 6 pin, 12 contacts
Extender Board, 10 pin, 20 contacts
Extender Board, 22 pin, 44 contacts
Extender Cable Assembly, for plug-in operation out of display mainframe
Tuning Tool, modified 5/16 inch nut driver with modified No. 10 Allen driver
Alignment tool, metal tip in plastic
Alignment tool, non-metallic
Wrench, No. 2 Bristol
Wrench, 15/64 inch, combination
Wrench, 1/4 inch, open end
Wrench, 5/16 inch, slotted box end/open end
Figure 1-3. Service Accessories (2 of 2)
1-13
9
8
2
9
4
0
6
7
CD
1
2
2
8
TM 11-6625-3061-14
HP Part Number
03950-4001
08559-60042
85680-60028
08565-60107
5060-0303
08555-60107
8710-0630
8710-0033
8710-0055
8710-0946
8720-0014
08555-20097
Model 8558B
Equipment
Display Mainframe
Oscilloscope
Frequency Counter
Timer/Counter
Digital Voltmeter
Power Meter
Power Sensor
Amplifier
Signal Generator
(2 required)
Tracking Generator
Sweep Oscillator
RF Plug-In
Spectrum Analyzer
Comb Generator
Function Generator
Crystal Detector
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (1 of 4)
Critical Specifications
Recommended
Model Use*
HP 180T Series with variable persistence
Time Base: 1 ms/cm to 10 ms/cm
Vertical Sensitivity: 1 mV/cm to 20 V/cm
Frequency Range: 150 MHz to 1.5 GHz
Sensitivity: -30 dBm
Time base: 10 us
Accuracy:
±
(.05% Rdg
±
digit)
Power Range: -20 dBm to +10 dBm
Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz
Maximum SWR: 1.1,0.1 to 1 GHz
Frequency Range: 200 MHz to 300 MHz
Gain: > 20 dB
Impedance: 50
Ω
Frequency Range: 4 MHz to 305 MHz
Drift: Less than 50 ppm (or 5 Hz, whichever is greater)
Harmonic Distortion: > 30 dB below fundamental
Noise Sidebands: > 80 dB down, 50 kHz away, 1 kHz BW
Frequency Range: 5 MHz to 1500 MHz
Manual Sweep
Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz
Flatness (external leveling): <
±
0.1 dB
Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz
HP 181T/TR
HP 1741A
HP 5342A
HP 5308A
HP 3455A
HP 435A/B
HP 8482A
HP 8447D
HP 8640B
HP 8444A Opt. 059
HP 8350A
HP 83522A
Accuracy: 0.01%
Frequency Range: 5 kHz to 5 MHz
Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz
Frequency Response:
±
0.2 dB/octave to 2 GHz;
±
0.5 dB overall
*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting
HP 141T/8552B/
8555A
HP 8406A
HP 3310A
HP 423B
P, A, T
A, T
P, A, T
A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, T
A
A
T
P, A, T
P, T
A, T
1-14
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Equipment
Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (2 of 4)
Critical Specifications
300 MHz LPF Rejection: > 50 dB for signals above
300 MHz
Power Splitter Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz
Input SWR: <, 1.15
10 dB Attenuator
(2 required)
Step Attenuator
Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz
Accuracy:
±
0.5 dB
Frequency Range: 20 MHz to 305 MHz
Attenuation: 12 dB in l-dB steps calibrated at 30 MHz by a standards lab
Accuracy:
±
0.25 dB
Step Attenuator
Termination
Type N Cable
Frequency Range: 20 MHz to 305 MHz
Attenuation: 80 dB in 10-dB steps calibrated at 30 MHz and 280 MHz by a standards lab
Accuracy:
±
0.01 dB
±
0.02/10 dB step at calibrated frequencies
Impedance: 50
Ω
50
Ω
coaxial cable with Type N (m) connectors on both ends
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) 50
Ω
coaxial cable with BNC (m) connectors on both ends
BNC Cable, 120 cm
(48 in) (2 required)
50
Ω
coaxial cable with BNC (m) connectors on both ends
Cable BNC to Banana Plug
Cable
Cable
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
SMC (f) to BNC (m)
Banana Plug to Alligator Clips
Banana plugs to BNC (f)
N (m) to BNC (f) (3 required)
SMC (m) to BNC (m)
Adapter BNC (f) to BNC (f)
Adapter BNC Tee
*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting
1-15
Recommended
Model
Telonic
TPL 3004AB
HP 11667A
HP 8491A Opt. 010
HP 355C Opt. H80
HP 355D Opt. H82
HP 908A/11593A
HP 11500A
HP 10502A
HP 10503A
HP 11001A
HP 11592-60001
HP 11102A
HP 10111 A
HP 1250-0780
HP 1250-0831
HP 1250-0080
HP 1250-0781
Use*
P, A, T
P, A
P, A
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A
P, A
P, A, T
P, A, T
P
A, T
A
P, T
P, A
P
P
A
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (3 of 4)
Critical Specifications
Recommended
Model Use* Equipment
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Adapter
Extender Board
N (m) to N (m)
BNC (m) to BNC (m)
N (f) to BNC (m)
SMC (m) to SMC (m)
Type N (m) to SMC (m)
BNC (f) to Alligator Clips
SMC (f) to SMC (f)
Type N (m) to SMA (f)
BNC (f) to SMA (m)
SMA (f) to SMA (f)
6 pin, 12 contacts with 51.1
Ω
resistor from pin 1 to pin 5
Termination
Power Sensor
NOTE
The following equipment is required for Option 001 and Option 002.
Impedance: 75
Ω
Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 2 GHz
Maximum SWR: 1.18, 10 MHz to 2 GHz
75
Ω BNC (m) to 75Ω Type N (f)
75
Ω BNC (f) to 50Ω SMA (m)
Adapter
Minimum Loss Adapter
5.72 dB attenuation
Adapter
Adapter
BNC (f) to SMA (m)
SMA (f) to SMA (f)
*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting
1-16
HP 1250-1475
HP 1250-0216
HP 1250-0077
HP 1250-0827
HP 1250-1023
HP 8120-1292
HP 1250-1113
HP 1250-1250
HP 1250-1200
HP 1250-1158
HP 08505-60109
HP 0757-0394
HP 11652-60010
HP 8483A
A, T
A, T
P, A
P
P
P
P
A, T
A, T
P
A, T
P
T
HP 1250-1534
HP 08558-60031
HP 1250-1200
HP 1250-1158
T
P, A, T
T
P, T
Model 8558B
Adapter
Cable
Cable
Cable
Adapter
Adapter
Equipment
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (4 of 4)
Critical Specifications
Recommended
Model Use*
N (f) to N (f)
BNC, 30 cm (12 in), 75
Ω
BNC, 60 cm (24 in), 75
Ω
BNC, 90 cm (37 in), 75
Ω
BNC (m) to BNC (m)
Type N (m) to SMA (f)
HP 1250-0777
HP 11652-60012
HP 11652-60013
HP 11652-60014
HP 1250-1288
HP 1250-1250
A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
P, A, T
*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting
1-17/1-18
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION II.
INSTALLATION
2-1. INTRODUCTION
2-2.
This section includes information on initial inspection, preparation for use, and storage and shipping requirements for the HP Model 8558B.
2-3. INITIAL INSPECTION
2-4.
Inspect the shipping container for damage. If the shipping container or cushioning material is damaged, it should be kept until the contents of the shipment have been checked for completeness and the instrument has been checked mechanically and electrically. The
contents of the shipment should be as shown in Figure
1-1. The electrical performance is checked with the
procedures in Section IV. If the contents are
incomplete, if there is mechanical damage or defect, or if the instrument does not pass the Performance Test procedures, notify the nearest Hewlett-Packard office. If the shipping container is damaged, or if the cushioning material shows signs of stress, notify the carrier as well as the Hewlett-Packard office. Keep the shipping materials for inspection by the carrier. The Hewlett-
Packard office will arrange for repair or replacement without waiting for a claim settlement.
2-5. PREPARATION FOR USE
2-6. Installation
2-7.
When properly installed, the spectrum analyzer obtains all necessary power from the display mainframe.
The rear panel connector provides the interface.
CAUTION
BEFORE SWITCHING ON THIS
INSTRUMENT, make sure it is adapted to the voltage of the ac power source to be used and the proper fuse is installed. Failure to set the ac power input of the instrument for the correct voltage level could cause damage to the instrument when plugged in. Refer to the display mainframe Operation and
Service Manual for line voltage and fuse selection.
2-8.
To install the spectrum analyzer in the mainframe:
1. Set display mainframe LINE switch to OFF.
2. Pull out lock knob and slide plug-in toward rear of compartment until it is seated firmly in place.
3. Push in lock knob to secure spectrum analyzer in mainframe.
2-9. Side Stop Kit
2-10. Installation of a Side Stop Kit, HP part number
08558-60131, prevents the removal of the analyzer from the 180-series mainframe without the use of hand tools.
This kit contains two side stops, mounting hardware,
label, and installation instructions. (Refer to Table 2-1
for part numbers of individual items.)
Table 2-1. Side Stop Kit (08558-60131)
HP Part C
Quantity Description Number D
2 SIDE STOP 08558-00094 7
4 MACHINE SCREW, 2200-0168 9
440 .438-IN-LG
82 DEG FLATHEAD
1 LABEL, FRONT-PANEL 7120-8131 7
1 LABEL, INSTRUCTIONS 7120-8215 8
2-1
Model 8558B
2-11. To install side stops:
WARNING
Before removing covers from the display mainframe, disconnect line power by removing the ac power cord.
1. Remove side covers from bottom section of mainframe. (Remove only right side cover if mainframe is a rack-mounted model.)
2. Use flathead machine screws to install side stops as
3. Reinstall side covers on mainframe.
4. Place caution label on front panel of spectrum analyzer (upper right-hand corner) to indicate that plug-in is secured with side stops.
2-12. To remove side stops:
WARNING
Before removing covers from the display mainframe, disconnect line power by removing the ac power cord.
1. Remove side covers from bottom section of mainframe. (Remove only right side cover if mainframe is a rack-mounted model.)
2. Remove side stops. (See Figure 2-1.)
3. Reinstall side covers on display mainframe.
2-13. Graticule Overlays
2-14. To install a graticule overlay:
1. Select proper overlay. HP part number 5020-8565 is for 180TR display mainframes, HP part number
5020-8566, for 181T/TR display mainframes, and
HP part number 5020-8567, for 182T display mainframes.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
2. For 180TR and 181T/TR mainframes, remove
CRT bezel and metallic-mesh contrast filter. Insert proper overlay and replace contrast filter and CRT bezel.
3. For 182T mainframes, grasp top portion of CRT bezel and pull straight up. Remove metallic-mesh contrast filter and insert proper overlay and contrast filter. (Either the metallic-mesh contrast filter or a light blue contrast filter may be used.)
4. Slide bezel back into place to retain overlay and filter.
2-15. Mainframe Interconnections
2-16. When the HP 8558B is properly installed in the display mainframe, the interconnections are as listed in
Table 2-2.
2-17. Operating Environment
2-18. Temperature. The instrument may be operated in temperatures from 0°C to + 55 o
C.
2-19. Humidity. The instrument may be operated in environments with relative humidity from 5 percent to 95 percent, 0°C to +40 o
C. The recommended long-term operating environment is 5 percent to 80 percent relative humidity. The instrument should also be protected from abrupt temperature changes that cause internal condensation.
2-20. Altitude. The instrument may be operated in altitudes up to 4572 meters (15,000 feet).
2-21. Modifications
2-22. A Modification Kit, HP part number 00180-69503, provides materials and information necessary to add
Option 807 rear-panel connections to the standard HP
180-series display. Refer to Table 1-3 in Section I.
Option 807 is factory-installed in 180T, 181T, 181TR, and 182T mainframes. The modification kit is required for use with other mainframes if all four rear-panel outputs are needed.
2-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
* Only one side stop and two screws are used for rackmount models.
2-23. STORAGE AND SHIPMENT
2-24. Environment
Figure 2-1. Location of Side Stops
2-26. Packaging
2-25. The instrument may be stored or shipped in environments within the following limits:
Temperature: -40°Cto +75°C
Humidity: 5% to95o (0°Cto +400C)
Altitude: Up to 15240 meters (50,000 feet)
The instrument should also be protected from temperature extremes which cause condensation within the instrument.
2-27. Original Packaging. Containers and materials identical to those used in factory packaging are available through Hewlett-Packard offices. If the instrument is being returned to Hewlett-Packard for servicing, attach a tag indicating the type of service required, return address, model number, and full serial number. A supply of these tags is provided at the end of this section. Mark the container FRAGILE to assure careful handling. In any correspondence, refer to the instrument by model number and full serial number.
2-3
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Pin on P1 Signal or Voltage
2
5
6
7
3
4
8
9
10
11
12
1
13
14
CRT HORIZ (adjusted horizontal signal)
GROUND from mainframe
(jumpered to pin 8)
NC
L NORM
YNORM
NC
SING SWP
GROUND from mainframe
(jumpered to pin 2)
MAN SWP
NC
AUX D Horizontal Output
(to mainframe rear panel)
AUX C 21.4 MHz IF Output
(to mainframe rear panel)
AUX B Penlift/Blanking Output
(to mainframe rear panel)
AUX A Vertical Output
GROUND
NC
(to mainframe rear panel)
15
16
2-28. Other Packaging. The following general instructions should be used for repackaging with commercially available materials:
1. Wrap instrument in heavy paper or plastic. If shipment is to a Hewlett-Packard office or service center, attach a tag indicating type of service required, return address, model number, and full serial number. A supply of these tags is provided at end of this section.
2. Use a strong shipping container. A double-wall carton made of 350-pound test material is adequate.
Table 2-2. HP Model 8558B Mainframe Interconnections
Pin on P1 Signal or Voltage
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
W10P3
(2 contacts)
BLANKING
NC
GROUND from mainframe
(jumpered in pin 24)
AUTO SWP
BEAM FINDER
NC
NC
GROUND from mainframe
(jumpered to pin 19)
NC
NC
NC
-12.6 VDC from mainframe
+15 VDC from mainframe
+100 VDC from mainframe
30V p-p from mainframe
(for LINE TRIGGER)
NC
+VERT (top contact, yellow wire)
-VERT (bottom contact, orange wire)
3. Use enough shock-absorbing material (3- to 4-inch layer) around all sides of the instrument to provide firm cushion and prevent movement inside container. Protect control panel with cardboard.
4. Seal shipping container securely.
5. Mark shipping container FRAGILE to assure careful handling.
2-4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
3-1. INTRODUCTION
3-2.
This section provides operating information for the
Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer. It also provides a brief description of display mainframe controls. For a detailed description of the display mainframe, refer to its manual.
3-3. CONTROLS, INDICATORS, AND CONNECTORS
3-4.
The spectrum analyzer is used with one of the
180-series display mainframes. The 180T-series display mainframes, or the 180-series mainframes with Option
807, have the correct rear-panel connections for spectrum analyzer horizontal, vertical, penlift, and IF
outputs. Figure 3-1 shows the front-panel features of
the HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer and the display
mainframe. Figure 3-2 shows the rear-panel features of
the HP 8558B. The rear panels of all 180T-series mainframes, and 180-series mainframes with Option
807, are basically the same.
3-5. Control Grouping
3-6.
The spectrum analyzer and display mainframe front-panel controls fall into three general groups: those that deal with the display, those that deal with frequency, and those that deal with amplitude.
3-7. Display. The display group consists of:
SWEEP TIME/DIV
SWEEP TRIGGER
VERTICAL POSN
VERTICAL GAIN
MAN SWEEP
HORIZ GAIN (rear panel of 8558B)
VIDEO FILTER
BASELINE CLIPPER
HORIZONTAL POSITION
INTENSITY
FOCUS
TRACE ALIGN
ASTIG
SECTION III.
OPERATION
3-8.
The display group enables the operator to calibrate the display and to select a variety of scan and display conditions. The controls are explained in
Figures 3-1 and 3-2. However, when the SWEEP
TIME/DIV control is placed in the AUTO position, sweep time is controlled by the RESOLUTION BW, FREQ
SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER controls.
3-9. Frequency. The frequency group consists of:
TUNING
RESOLUTION BW
FREQ SPAN/DIV
3-10. The frequency group enables the operator to control how the spectrum analyzer displays the frequency domain. The RESOLUTION BW and FREQ
SPAN/DIV controls when pushed in are coupled together, and moving either control moves the other.
When the SWEEP TIME/DIV control is in the AUTO position varying the RESOLUTION BW or the FREQ
SPAN/DIV (coupled or uncoupled) will change the sweep time to maintain calibration. With the two controls coupled together in the OPTIMUM position,
RESOLUTION BW's of 3 MHz to 1 kHz will be automatically selected as the FREQ SPAN/DIV is narrowed from 100 MHz to 0. TUNING controls coarse and fine (coarse is larger knob) set the center frequency of the displayed spectrum. RESOLUTION BW control determines the resolution of the signals on the CRT.
3-11. Amplitude. The amplitude group consists of:
REFERENCE LEVEL
INPUT ATTEN
REF LEVEL FINE
REF LEVEL CAL
10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN (Amplitude
Scale)
3-12. The amplitude group enables the operator to measure signal amplitude in units of either voltage or dBm.
3-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
3-13. Variable Persistence and Storage Functions
3-14. With the 181T/TR Display Mainframe, the operator can set trace persistence for a bright, steady trace that does not flicker, even on the slow sweeps required for narrow band analysis. The variable persistence also permits the display of low repetition rate pulses without flickering; and using the longest persistence, intermittent signals can be captured and displayed. The storage capability allows side-by-side comparison of changing signals.
3-15. Persistence and Intensity
CAUTION
Excessive INTENSITY may damage the CRT storage mesh.
3-16. These controls determine the appearance of the
CRT trace. Specifically, PERSISTENCE controls the rate at which a signal is erased and INTENSITY controls the trace brightness as the signal is written. With a given PERSISTENCE setting, the actual time of trace visibility can be increased by greater INTENSITY.
Since the PERSISTENCE control sets the rate of trace erasure, a brighter trace requires more time to be erased. Conversely, a display of low intensity disappears more rapidly. The same principle applies to a stored display of high or low intensity.
3-17. Storage. These controls select the storage mode in which the CRT functions. In ERASE mode,
STORE, WRITE, and MAX WRITE are disconnected and all written signals are removed from the CRT. The
STORE selector disconnects the WRITE, MAX WRITE, and ERASE functions and implements signal retention at reduced intensity. In the STORE mode,
PERSISTENCE and INTENSITY have no function.
3-18. Writing Speed. In the MAX WRITE mode, the
CRT storage surface is primed to allow much faster writing on the storage surface. Since the erasing rate is decreased, the entire screen becomes illuminated more rapidly and the display is obscured. The effective persistence and storage times are thus considerably reduced. For this reason, MAX WRITE is not normally used with a spectrum analyzer plug-in.
3-19. Photographic Techniques
3-20. The HP Model 197A Oscilloscope Camera attaches directly to the spectrum analyzer's CRT bezel without adapters. Flood guns in the CRT provide background lighting of the display. When photography of stored traces (181T/TR) is required, a double exposure is needed. (Flood guns are turned off when
STORE is pressed.) See Application Note AN 150-5 for full details.
OPERATING PRECAUTIONS
The spectrum analyzer is a sensitive measuring instrument. To avoid damage to the instrument, do not exceed the following Absolute Maximum Inputs:
Overloading the input with too much power, peak voltages, or dc voltages will damage the input circuit and require expensive repairs.
Total Power: + 30 dBm (1W, 7.1 Vrms)
Option 001: + 30dBm(1W, 8.7 Vrms)
Option 002: +80dBmV(1.3W, 9.9 Vrms) dc or ac (< 100 Hz):
±
50V
Peak Pulse Power:
+ 50 dB, (100W, < 10
µ s pulse width,
0.01% duty cycle) with ò20 dB INPUT ATTEN
Option 002: + 100 dBmV (130W), <10
µs
CAUTION
While the analyzer's reference level may be set for power levels up to +60 dBm, the total input power must not exceed the absolute maximum limits listed.
FRONT PANEL ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE
Whenever an HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer plug-in is reinstalled in a different mainframe, the spectrum
3-2
Model 8558B analyzer should be calibrated to ensure proper correlation between plug-in and display. It is good practice to execute this adjustment procedure periodically (recommended daily) to correct for changes in calibration which may occur over a period of time.
These adjustments are also an excellent way for the new user to become acquainted with the spectrum analyzer. For reference, a front panel view appears in
If an HP 181 Variable Persistence Display is being used, begin by setting the PERSISTENCE maximum counterclockwise and pushing in the WRITE button.
Make the following spectrum analyzer settings.
Function Setting
10 dB INPUT ATTEN
(push knob to engage)
REFERENCE LEVEL
REF LEVEL FINE
Amplitude Scale
FREQ SPAN/DIV
(uncoupled)
RESOLUTION BW
(uncoupled)
SWEEP TIME/DIV
SWEEP TRIGGER
START - CENTER
TUNING
BASELINE CLIPPER
VIDEO FILTER
0 dBm
002: +50 dBmV
0
LIN
10 MHz
1 MHz
AUTO
FREE RUN
CENTER
> 60 MHz
OFF
OFF
180-series mainframes:
DISPLAY
MAGNIFIER
SCALE (180TR, 182T)
PERSISTENCE (181T/TR)
Display Mode (181T/TR)
INT (out)
X1 (out)
OFF
MIN (ccw)
WRITE
DISPLAY ADJUSTMENTS
1. With an adjustment tool, adjust VERTICAL POSN to place the CRT trace on a horizontal graticule line near center of CRT.
2. Reduce the INTENSITY and set the SWEEP
TIME/DIV control to MAN. Adjust the MAN SWEEP knob to bring dot to center of CRT.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
CAUTION
Leaving a dot on the CRT for prolonged periods at high intensity may burn the phosphor.
3. Adjust the FOCUS and ASTIG controls for the smallest round dot possible.
4. Reset the SWEEL TIME/DIV control to AUTO and increase the INTENSITY for an optimum CRT trace.
Center the trace horizontally with the HORIZONTAL
POSITION control. If the horizontal deflection is not exactly 10 divisions, adjust the HORIZ GAIN control
(located on the spectrum analyzer rear panel) for a
10 division (wide) horizontal deflection.
NOTE
The analyzer must be removed from the mainframe to adjust the HORIZ
GAIN control.
5. Adjust the TRACE ALIGN so that the CRT trace is parallel with the horizontal graticule lines.
6. Adjust the VERTICAL POSN until the trace aligns with the bottom graticule line.
FREQUENCY ADJUSTMENTS
7. Center the LO feedthrough - the 'signal' at 0 MHz on the CRT with the TUNING control, pressing the
FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton two or three times to remove tuning hysteresis in the first LO (YIG oscillator).
8. Narrow the FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz and press the FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton once more.
Adjust the REF LEVEL FINE control as necessary to position the signal peak near the top CRT graticule line.
9. Re-center the LO feedthrough, if necessary, and adjust FREQUENCY ZERO to calibrate the
FREQUENCY MHz readout at 00.0 MHz.
3-3
Model 8558B
AMPLITUDE ADJUSTMENTS
10. Set the FREQ SPAN/DIV control to 1 MHz and the
REF LEVEL FINE control to 0. Adjust the TUNING control for a FREQUENCY MHz readout of approximately 280 MHz.
11. Press the 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale pushbutton, and set the REFERENCE LEVEL control to - 20 dBm (+ 30 dBmV for Option 002).
CAUTION
The HP 8558B Options 001 and 002 feature 75-ohm (female) INPUT and
CAL OUTPUT connectors. Standard
50-ohm BNC cables and adapters should not be used with these connectors since damage might result.
12. Connect the 280 MHz CAL OUTPUT to the spectrum analyzer input and center the signal on the CRT with the TUNING control, pressing the
FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton two or three times.
The FREQUENCY MHz readout will indicate 280
MHz + 5 MHz.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
13. Press the LIN Amplitude Scale pushbutton. Adjust the REF LEVEL FINE control to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.
14. Press the 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale pushbutton.
Adjust VERTICAL GAIN to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.
15. Repeat steps 12 and 13 until the signal peak remains at the top CRT graticule line when the
Amplitude Scale is alternated between 10 dB/DIV and LIN.
16. Set the REF LEVEL FINE control to 0 and the
REFERENCE LEVEL control to -30 dBm (+ 20 dBmV for Option 002).
17. Press the LIN Amplitude Scale pushbutton and adjust REF LEVEL CAL to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.
Once the Front Panel Adjustment Procedure is completed, the spectrum analyzer is calibrated for absolute amplitude and frequency measurements.
During normal operation, the FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton should be pressed whenever the tuning is changed by more than 50 MHz. This removes tuning hysteresis and ensures maximum frequency accuracy.
3-4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 3-2. Rear Panel Controls and Connectors (2 of 2)
3-7/3-8 (blank)
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION IV.
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-3. INSTRUMENTS TESTED 4-1. INTRODUCTION
4-2.
The procedures in this section test the electrical performance of the instrument against the specifications
in Section I. The performance tests included in this
section are listed in Table 4-1. Most of the tests can be
performed without access to the interior of the instrument. If a test measurement is marginal, perform
the appropriate adjustment procedures in Section V.
4-4.
Since a 180-series Display mainframe is required for operation of the HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer
plug-in, the specifications listed in Table 1-1 apply when
both instruments are functioning together.
Consequently, the performance tests in this section verify the proper operation of both the HP 8558B and the 180-series Display mainframe.
Table 4-1. Performance Tests
Paragraph Test
4-15 Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy
4-16 Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity
4-21 Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude
Variation)
4-22 Input Attenuator Accuracy
4-5. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
4-6.
The equipment required for the performance tests is listed under Recommended Test Equipment in
Section I. Any equipment that satisfies the critical
specifications given in the table may be substituted for the recommended model.
4-7. TEST RECORD
4-8.
Results of the performance tests may be tabulated in the Performance Test Record at the end of this section. The test record lists test specifications and acceptable limits.
4-9. CALIBRATION CYCLE
4-10. This instrument requires periodic calibration.
Calibration should be verified every six months by means of the performance tests.
4-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
NOTE
Perform the Front Panel Adjustment Procedure in Section III before proceeding
with the performance tests. Allow at least 30 minutes warmup time.
4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
Fourteen calibrated spans from 100 MHz/div to 5 kHz/div in a 1, 2, 5 sequence. Frequency error between any two points on the display is less than - 5 % of the indicated frequency separation.
DESCRIPTION
Wide span widths are checked by using the 100-, 10-, and 1-MHz outputs from a comb generator. Narrow span widths are checked by using the output from a comb generator modulated by a function generator. Since the comb generator produces frequency components separated by a precisely determined frequency interval, the resultant spectral lines displayed on the CRT are evenly spaced when no span error exists in the instrument. Thus, span error is the cumulative variance of distance among the spectral line intervals displayed across the CRT. The amount of span error is determined by comparing the distance of the first nine graticule divisions to the display distance of the corresponding spectral line intervals.
Figure 4-1. Frequency Span Accuracy Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A
Timer/Counter ....................................................................................................... HP 5308A
Function Generator ............................................................................................... HP 3310A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................. HP 10503A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Tee ......................................................................................................... HP 1250-0781
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ............................................................. HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω .................................................................. HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f).............................................................................. HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ............................................................................ HP 1250-1200
4-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1. Set equipment controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING .................................................................................................................. 800 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................... 100 MHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................... OPTIMUM, coupled (pushed in)
INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................... -20 dBm
002: + 30 dBmV
Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER..................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER.............................................................................................................. OFF
Comb Generator:
COMB FREQUENCY- MHz........................................................................................ 100 MC
INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF
OUTPUT AMPLITUDE ............................................................................................ 10 o'clock
Function Generator:
FUNCTION ................................................................................................................... SINE
RANGE .......................................................................................................................... 10K
Frequency ................................................................................................................ 200 kHz
DC OFFSET LEVEL............................................................................................................ 0
2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-1 but do not connect function generator to comb generator.
3. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to position one spectral line (from comb generator) at first graticule line
Error should be no greater than - 0.4 division.
__________ div
4. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than i 0.4 division.
__________ div
4-3
Model 8558B
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 4-2. Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for Ninth Spectral Line
Figure 4-3. Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for Seventeenth Spectral Line
4-4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)
5.
Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 10-MHz comb. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20
MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between 17th
spectral line and ninth graticule line as shown in Figure 4-3. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
6.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 10 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line.
Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
7.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
8.
Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 1-MHz comb. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 2
MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between 17th spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
9.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
10. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line.
Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than
±
0.4 division.
__________ div
11. Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 10-MHz comb. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to position a spectral line at center graticule line. Turn on comb generator INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz.
12. Set function generator frequency to 200 kHz (
±
0.5%) using frequency counter. Connect function generator output to comb generator MODULATION input. Set function generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a clean 200-kHz comb on the spectrum analyzer display.
4-5
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY (Cont'd)
NOTE
To obtain a clean comb on the spectrum analyzer display, use the LOW or HIGH output of the function generator as necessary. Readjust the function generator
OUTPUT LEVEL and the comb generator INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE - 1 MHz as necessary.
13.Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than 4
0.4 division.
__________ div
14. Using procedure of NOTE in step 12, vary spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV and Function Generator Output
first graticule line. Measure span error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line.
Table 4-2. Narrow Span Width Error Measurement
Spectrum Analyzer
FREQ SPAN/DIV RESOLUTION BW
Function Generator
Output Frequency*
Allowable Error
(Max.)
100 kHz
50 kHz
20 kHz
10 kHz
5 kHz
OPTIMUM
OPTIMUM
OPTIMUM
OPTIMUM
OPTIMUM
100 kHz
50 kHz
20 kHz
10 kHz
5 kHz
+0.4 Division
+0.4 Division
+0.4 Division
+0.4 Division
+0.4 Division
* Check function generator output frequency using a frequency counter. Frequency readout should be within +0.5% of desired audio frequency.
4-6
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-12. TUNING ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
0 to 195 MHz:
±
(1 MHz
±
20% of FREQ SPAN/DIV setting), 10°C to 40°C
195 to 1500 MHz:
±
(5 MHz
±
20% of FREQ SPAN/DIV setting), 10°C to 40°C.
DESCRIPTION
A comb generator is used to provide 1-, 10-, or 100-MHz frequency components that produce spectral lines on the CRT at 1-, 10-, or 100-MHz intervals, respectively. The spectrum analyzer TUNING control is adjusted until the desired test frequency is shown on the FREQUENCY MHz readout of the Digital Panel Meter. The FREQUENCY CAL switch is pressed and the amount of readout (or tuning) error is found by measuring the distance of the spectral line offset from the center graticule line.
Figure 4-4. Tuning Accuracy Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200
4-7
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-12. TUNING ACCURACY (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER
FREQ SPAN/DIV ..................................................................................................... 200 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ................................................................................................ OPTIMUM
INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF
2.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to position LO feedthrough signal at center graticule line of display.
Press FREQUENCY CAL switch and reposition LO feedthrough signal at center graticule line, as required. Adjust
FREQ ZERO control for zero indication on FREQUENCY MHz readout. LO feedthrough signal should still be positioned at center graticule line of display.
3.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-4.
4.
Set comb generator controls as follows:
COMB FREQUENCY - MHz....................................................................................... 10 MC
INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF
OUTPUT AMPLITUDE .......................................................................................... 10 o'clock
5.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control until FREQUENCY MHz readout indicates 10.0 MHz. Press
FREQUENCY CAL switch. Comb generator spectral line, displayed on CRT, should be within 5.2 divisions ( - 1.04
MHz) of center graticule line.
__________ div
NOTE
If the spectral line is off screen, set FREQ SPANIDIV to 500 kHz and check that the spectral line is within 2.2 divisions of the center graticule line.
6.
TUNING accuracy. After tuning to each FREQUENCY MHz readout, press FREQUENCY CAL switch before measuring TUNING accuracy.
4-8
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-12. TUNING ACCURACY (Cont'd)
Spectrum Analyzer
FREQUENCY
MHz
Readout
(MHz)
FREQ
SPAN/DIV.
Setting
20.0
40.0
60.0
80.0
100.0
120.0
140.0
160.0
180.0
200
400
600
800
1000
1200
1400
1500
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
200 kHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
Table 4-3. Tuning Accuracy Measurement
Comb Generator
COMB
FREQUENCY-MC
Setting
(MHz)
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
-5.2
Specification
(Spectral line limits referenced
Min.
to center graticule line)
(Divisions)
Max.
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
+5.2
4-9
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-13. RESIDUAL FM
SPECIFICATION
Less than 1 kHz peak-to-peak for time < 0.1 second
FM DESCRIPTION
This test measures the inherent short-term instability (residual FM) of the LO system in the spectrum analyzer. A stable signal applied to the input of the spectrum analyzer is slope-detected on the linear portion of the 10 kHz bandwidth filter
mixing process. As the IF signal moves in relation to the center of the IF filter, the attenuation of the signal changes in accordance with the skirt characteristics of the filter. If the signal stays on the linear portion of the IF filter skirt, the amplitude of the IF signal applied to the final detector (and thus the level on the display) is linearly related to the
to variations in LO frequency.
Figure 4-5. Residual FM Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200
4-10
Model 8558B
4-13. RESIDUAL FM (Cont'd)
PERFORMANCE TESTS
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 4-6. Example of Residual FM
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer and comb generator controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER
FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV ......................................................................................... 100 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ...................................................................................................... 10kHz
INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................
LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF
Comb Generator:
COMB FREQUENCY - MHz....................................................................................... 100 MC
INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF
OUTPUT AMPLITUDE .................................................................................. Fully clockwise
4-11
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-13. RESIDUAL FM (Cont'd)
2.
Connect OUTPUT of comb generator to spectrum analyzer INPUT connector as shown in Figure 4-5.
NOTE
The HP 8558B is sensitive to vibration. Be sure the instrument is in a vibrationfree environment.
3.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to display 500-MHz signal produced by comb generator. Adjust
REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to position peak of signal at top graticule line.
4.
Keep 500-MHz signal centered on CRT while reducing FREQ SPAN/DIV to zero.
5.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz and SWEEP TIME/DIV to .1 SEC.
6.
Slightly readjust fine TUNING control of spectrum analyzer until trace appears between fourth and seventh graticule lines. Peak-to-peak variation of trace should not exceed one major vertical division for each major horizontal
__________ div
4-12
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-14. NOISE SIDEBANDS
SPECIFICATION
More than 65 dB below CW signal, 50 kHz or more away from signal with a 1-kHz resolution bandwidth and full video filtering.
DESCRIPTION
A stable 400-MHz CW signal is applied at a - 20 dBm level to the spectrum analyzer and is displayed on the CRT. The test is designed to measure the amplitude of noise-associated sidebands and unwanted responses.
Figure 4-7. Noise Sideband Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ................................................................................................... HP 8640B
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200
4-13
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-14. NOISE SIDEBANDS(Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ................................................................................................................... 400MHz
FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV .........................................................................................
1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW ..................................................................................................... 30 KHz
INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................
10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
Amplitude Scale ......................................................................................................10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF
Signal Generator
FREQUENCY.......................................................................................................... 400 MHz
RF OUTPUT ........................................................................................................... - 20 dBm
RF ..................................................................................................................................
ON
AM ................................................................................................................................. OFF
FM ................................................................................................................................. OFF
2.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-7.
3.
Adjust TUNING control to locate 400-MHz signal on CRT.
4.
Adjust REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to position peak of 400-MHz signal at top graticule line.
5.
Decrease FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Adjust TUNING to keep signal centered.
6.
Position signal at center of display. Turn VIDEO FILTER control fully clockwise (not in detent). Measure noise sidebands existing more than 2.5 division (50 kHz) from 400-MHz signal. Noise sidebands should be greater than
65 dB (6.5 divisions) down from top graticule line.
_________ div down
4-14
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
Individual resolution bandwidth 3-dB points calibrated to 20%o (10°C to 400C)
DESCRIPTION
Resolution bandwidth accuracy is measured in the linear mode to eliminate log amplifier errors. Since signal level at the
3-dB points (half-power points) is related to peak signal level by a voltage ratio of 0.707:1.0, a peak level of 7.1 vertical divisions on the spectrum analyzer display gives a half-power level of 5 vertical divisions:
0.707 (voltage ratio) = X div/7.1 div
X div = (7.1)(0.707)
≈
5 div
In the 30-, 10-, and 1-kHz bandwidths, a 301.4-MHz signal (second IF) is injected into A9 Third Converter Assembly to provide the stability required for measurement of narrow resolution bandwidths.
Figure 4-8. Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup, 3 MHz to 100 kHz
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Extender Cable Assembly ............................................................................... HP 5060-0303
Adapter, SMC (m) to BNC (m)......................................................................... HP 1250-0831
Adapter, BNC (f) to BNC (f) ............................................................................. HP 1250-0080
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200
4-15
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd) ,
PROCEDURE
WARNING
This test must be performed with power supplied to the instrument and with protective covers removed. The test should be performed only by service-trained personnel who are aware of the hazards involved.
1.
Set equipment controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ................................................................................................................... 10 MHz
FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................... 0
RESOLUTION BW ...................................................................................................... 3 MHz
INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................. 20 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................. 0 dBm
002: +30dBmV
Amplitude Scale ............................................................................................................... LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV .....................................................................................................5 mSEC
SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF
Signal Generator
COUNTER MODE................................................................................... INT, EXPAND X10
AM ................................................................................................................................ OFF
FM ................................................................................................................................ OFF
FREQUENCY TUNE .................................................................................................. 10 MHz
RF .................................................................................................................................... ON
OUTPUT LEVEL ........................................................................................................ 0 dBm
2.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-8.
3.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to locate peak of 10-MHz signal on CRT. Reduce signal generator output if necessary.
4.
Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at 7.1 divisions above graticule baseline.
5.
Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
__________ MHz
4-16
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd)
6.
Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 5 until trace peaks (7.1 divisions above graticule baseline) and then drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
__________ MHz
7.
Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 3-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 5 and
6).
Min.
Actual Max.
2.40 MHz ________________ 3.60 MHz
8.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.
Min.
Actual Max.
800 kHz _________________ 1200 kHz
9.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.
Min.
Actual Max.
240 kHz _________________ 360 kHz
10. Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.
Min.
Actual Max.
80 kHz __________________ 120 kHz
Figure 4-9. Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup, 1 kHz to 30 kHz
4-17
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd)
WARNING
In the following procedure, the plug-in must be removed from the display mainframe and connected through the extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. This test should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.
11. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to approximately -12 dBm and tune frequency to 301.4 MHz. Set COUNTER
MODE to EXPAND X100.
12. Set spectrum analyzer INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to -10 dBm. Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Leave FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0.
002: REFERENCE LEVEL, + 40 dBmV.
adapters to W7P1.
14. Adjust signal generator frequency until spectrum analyzer trace is at peak. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at 7.1 divisions above graticule baseline.
15. Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
__________ MHz
16. Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 15 until trace peaks and then drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
__________ MHz
17. Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 3-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 15 and
16).
Min.
Actual Max.
24 kHz __________________ 36 kHz
18. Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.
Min.
Actual Max.
8 kHz ___________________ 12 kHz
4-18
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd) ,
19. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.
Min.
Actual Max.
2.4 kHz__________________ 3.6 kHz
20. Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.
Min.
Actual Max.
0.8 kHz__________________ 1.2 kHz
21. Reconnect W7P1 to A10J2 unless continuing on with next performance test.
4-19
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY '
SPECIFICATION
60-dB:3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio < 15:1.
DESCRIPTION
The 60-dB bandwidth is measured for all resolution bandwidths. The 60- to 3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio (shape factor) is then computed for each bandwidth by dividing the 3-dB value (from the Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy test) into the 60-dB value.
In the 30-, 10-, and 1-kHz bandwidths, a 301.4-MHz signal (second IF) is injected into A9 Third Converter assembly to provide the stability required for the measurement of narrow resolution bandwidths.
Figure 4-10. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup, 1 kHz to 30 kHz
WARNING
In the following procedure, the plug-in must be removed from the display mainframe and connected through the extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. This test should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.
4-20
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY(Cont'd)
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Extender Cable Assembly...................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
Adapter, SMC (m) to BNC (m) ............................................................................................... HP 1250-0831
Adapter, BNC (f) to BNC (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-0080
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω
to 50
Ω
...................................................................................HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω
....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................50 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV........................................................................................................................................ 0
RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................. 1 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-10 dBm
002: + 40 dBm V
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV...........................................................................................................................5 mSEC
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF
Signal Generator
COUNTER MODE ...........................................................................................................INT, EXPAND X10
AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FREQUENCY TUNE ................................................................................................................... 301.4 MHz
RF ...........................................................................................................................................................ON
OUTPUT LEVEL..............................................................................................................................-20 dBm
2.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-10. Remove W7P1 from A10J2. Connect signal generator through
adapters to W7P1.
3.
Adjust signal generator frequency until spectrum analyzer trace is at peak. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at top graticule line.
4-21
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-16.
RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY(Cont'd)
4.
Tune signal generator until trace drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
MHz
5.
Tune signal generator in direction opposite to that of step 4 until trace peaks and then drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
MHz
6.
Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 60-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 4 and
5).
kHz
7 Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.
kHz
8.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.
kHz
9.
Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.
kHz
10. Reconnect W7P1 to A10J2. Set display LINE power to OFF and remove extender cable assembly. Install plug-in in mainframe and set LINE power to ON.
11. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to 0 dBm.
12. Set spectrum analyzer INPUT ATTEN to 20 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to 0 dBm. Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0.
002: REFERENCE LEVEL, +50 dBmV.
13. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-11.
14. Set signal generator frequency to 50 MHz. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to locate peak of 50-MHz signal on
CRT.
15. Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at top graticule line.
4-22
Model 8558B
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY (Cont'd)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 4-11. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup, 100 kHz to 3 MHz
16. Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
MHz
17. Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 16 until trace peaks and then drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.
MHz
18. Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 60-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 16 and
17).
kHz
19. Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through
18.
kHz
20. Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 18.
MHz
21. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 18.
MHz
22. In Table 4-4, record 3-dB bandwidths computed in Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy test.
23. In Table 4-4, record 60-dB bandwidths recorded in this procedure.
24. For each resolution bandwidth, divide 60-dB bandwidth by 3-dB bandwidth to obtain Resolution Bandwidth Ratio.
Each ratio should be less than 15:1.
4-23
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY (Cont'd)
Table 4-4. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity
RESOLUTION
BW Setting
3 MHz
1 MHz
300 kHz
100 kHz
30 kHz
10 kHz
3 kHz
1 kHz
MEASURED
3 db BW
MEASURED
60 db BW
Resolution Bandwidth
Ration (60 db BW):
(3 dB BW)
4-24
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-17. AVERAGE NOISE LEVEL
SPECIFICATION
Less than - 107 dBm with a 10-kHz resolution bandwidth (0 dB input attenuation), 1 MHz to 1500 MHz.
001: Less than - 100dBm
002: Less than - 53 dBm V
DESCRIPTION
The average noise level is checked by observing the average noise power level displayed on the CRT when no input signal is applied to the instrument. The test is performed with a 10-kHz resolution bandwidth.
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER..................................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING .................................................................................................................................................. 500 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV..................................................................................................................................... 100 MHz
RESOLUTION BW ..................................................................................................................................... 10 kHz
INPUT ATTEN................................................................................................................................................. 0dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................................. - 60 dBm
002:-10 dBm V
Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.................................................................................................................................. 10 mSEC
SWEEP TRIGGER .............................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER....................................................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER.......................................................................................................................................12 o'clock
2.
Adjust TUNING until LO feedthrough is not on screen. Set VIDEO FILTER to MAX (not in detent) and observe CRT
001: Change '- 107 dBm' to '- 100 dBm' throughout procedure and in Figure 4-12.
002: Change '- 107 dBm' to '- 53 dBmV' throughout procedure and in Figure 4-12.
< - 107 dBm
3.
Set START-CENTER switch to START. Observe average noise level from 500 MHz to 1500 MHz. Noise level should be less than - 107 dBm.
< - 107 dBm
4-25
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-17. AVERAGE NOISE LEVEL(Cont'd)
4.
Set START-CENTER switch to CENTER and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz. Adjust TUNING for a FREQUENCY MHz readout of 6 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch.
5.
Observe average noise level from I MHz to 11 MHz. Noise level should be less than - 107 dBm.
< - 107 dBm
Figure 4-12. Average Noise Level Measurement
4-26
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES
SPECIFICATION
Image and multiple responses and second harmonic distortion products are > 70 dB* below a - 40 dBm in-put signal with
0 dB input attenuation.
001: - 35 dBm input signal
002: + 15dBmV input signal
Third order intermodulation distortion products are >70 dB* below two -30 dBm input signals, separated by
≥
50 kHz, with
0 dB input attenuation.
001: two - 25 dBm input signals
002: two + 25 dBm V input signals
* > 60 dB for 100 kHz to 5 MHz input signals.
DESCRIPTION:
A signal source with a lowpass filter is used to measure harmonic distortion. The LPF is required to ensure that the signals displayed on the CRT are due to harmonic distortion in the spectrum analyzer rather than to the harmonic content of the signal generator.
In measuring spurious responses due to image frequencies, out-of-band responses, and intermodulation distortion, signals from two separate sources are applied to the spectrum analyzer.
Figure 4-13. Harmonic Distortion Test Setup
4-27
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator (2 required) ....................................................................................................... HP 8640B
10 dB Attenuator (2 required).........................................................................................HP 8491A Opt. 010
300 MHz LPF...............................................................................................................Telonic TLP 300-4AB
BNC Tee................................................................................................................................ HP 1250-0781
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (3 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) (2 required) ...................................................................................... HP 10503A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω
to 50
Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75
Ω ......................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200
PROCEDURE
Harmonic Distortion
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-40 dBm
001: -30 dBm
002: + 20 dBm V
REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0
001: -5
002: -5
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock
2.
Set signal generator frequency to 280 MHz and OUTPUT LEVEL to - 30 dBm.
3.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-13.
4.
Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generator to center signal on spectrum analyzer display.
4-28
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)
5.
Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for -40 dBm displayed at top graticule line of spectrum analyzer CRT.
001: -35 dBm
002: + 15 dBm V
6.
Increase signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.
7.
Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to approximately 560 MHz and identify second harmonic.
8.
Center signal on spectrum analyzer display and reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.
9.
Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz. Harmonics should be more than 70 dB below input signal
(below first graticule line from bottom).
2nd Harmonic: dB
3rd Harmonic: dB
10. Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Increase signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.
11. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to approximately 840 MHz and identify third harmonic.
12. Repeat steps 8 and 9.
Intermodulation Distortion
13. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm
001: -20dBm
002: +30dBm V
REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0
001: -5
002: -5
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock
4-29
Model 8558B
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)
14. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-14.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 4-14. Intermodulation Distortion Test Setup
15. Set both signal generators for approximately 30 MHz output at - 24 dBm.
16. Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generators until signals are 2 divisions apart and centered on display.
17. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL controls of both signal generators for - 30 dBm displayed on spectrum analyzer.
001: -25 dBm
002: + 25 dBm V
18. Reduce spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and check for third order intermodulation distortion products at approximately 3 divisions to either side of center graticule line (see NOTE below). They should be more than 70
dB below input signals (-100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display). (See Figure 4-15.)
001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 50 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display
dB
NOTE
If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.
4-30
Model 8558B
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)
PERFORMANCE TESTS
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 4-15. Intermodulation Distortion Products
19. Set INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB, REFERENCE LEVEL to -40 dBm, and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Adjust OUTPUT
LEVEL of each signal generator to - 43 dBm as displayed on CRT.
001: REFERENCE LEVEL - 35 dBm; output level of - 38 dBm displayed on CRT
002: REFERENCE LEVEL + 15 dBmV; output level of + 12 dBmV displayed on CRT
20. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 1 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f2 fl) near center of display (see NOTE below). Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 60 dB below the total applied signal (- 100 dBm on spectrum analyzer
001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 45 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display
dB
NOTE
If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.
4-31
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)
21. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 60 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Momentarily press FREQUENCY
CAL switch.
22. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f
1
+ f
2
) between 2f
1 and 2f
2
signals (see NOTE below).
Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range.
Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 70 dB below total applied signal (- 110 dBm on
spectrum analyzer display). (See Figure 4-15.)
001: - 105 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 60 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display
dB
NOTE
If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.
23. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING .............................................................................................................................................4 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm
001: - 20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0
001: -5
002: -5
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock
24. Set both signal generators for approximately 4 MHz at - 24 dBm.
25. Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generators until signals are 2 divisions apart and centered on display.
26. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator for - 30 dBm as displayed on CRT.
001: - 25 dBm
002: + 25 dBm V
4-32
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)
27. Check for third order intermodulation distortion products at approximately 3 divisions from either side of center graticule line. Third order intermodulation distortion products should be more than 60 dB below input signals (- 90 dBm on spectrum analyzer display).
001: - 85 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 35 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display
dB
NOTE
If signal generators other than HP 8640's are used, intermodulation distortion might be in the generators themselves because of crosstalk between the two sources.
28. Set INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to -40 dBm. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator for - 43 dBm as displayed on CRT.
001: REFERENCE LEVEL, - 35 dBm; output level of - 38 dBm displayed on CRT
002: REFERENCE LEVEL, + 15 dBmV; + 12 dBmV as displayed on CRT
29. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 1 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f
2
- f
1
) near center of display (see NOTE below). Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 60 dB below total applied signal (-100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display).
001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 45 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display
dB
NOTE
If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.
30. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 8 MHz and check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f
1
+ f
2
) between 2f
1
and 2f
2
signals. (See figure 4-15.) Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than
60 dB below total applied signal (- 100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display). (See NOTE above.)
001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display
002: - 45 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display
dB
4-33
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES
SPECIFICATION
< - 100 dBm (1-1500 MHz) with 0 dB input attenuation and no signal present at input.
001: < - 95 dBm
002: < - 50 dBmV
DESCRIPTION
The spectrum analyzer is tested for residual responses with no signal applied to the INPUT 509 connector. The input attenuation is set to 0 dB.
001 and 002: INPUT 75
Ω
Figure 4-16. Residual Responses Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Variable Persistence/Storage Display ............................................................................................. HP 181T
50-Ohm Termination................................................................................................................... HP 11593A
001 and 002: 75-Ohm Termination, HP 11652-60010
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 500 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................ 100 MHz
RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 60 dBm
002: - 10 dBm V
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................... Fully clockwise (not in detent)
4-34
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES (Cont'd)
2.
Terminate INPUT 501 connector with 50-ohm coaxial termination (see Figure 4-16).
001 and 002: 75
Ω; 75-ohm
3.
With variable persistence display in NORM mode, set LO feedthrough to far left vertical graticule line. Set
BASELINE CLIPPER to 3 o'clock.
4.
Set HP 181T to WRITE mode. Set PERSISTENCE control to MAX and INTENSITY control to approximately 12 o'clock.
5.
Set spectrum analyzer SWEEP TRIGGER to SINGLE sweep mode and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Momentarily press ERASE pushbutton.
NOTE
When the ERASE pushbutton is pressed, the spectrum analyzer sweep might be triggered. To stop the sweep, turn SWEEP TRIGGER control clockwise.
6.
Turn SWEEP TRIGGER control clockwise to initiate sweep.
7.
Slowly turn BASELINE CLIPPER control until peaks of trace begin to appear on display. It might be necessary to increase baseline clipping slightly near end of sweep to reduce blooming.
8.
Trigger sweep at least one more time and check for residual responses from 1 to 1000 MHz. Record frequency at which residual response of greatest amplitude appears.
MHz
9.
Set display to NORM mode. Set spectrum analyzer BASELINE CLIPPER fully counterclockwise and SWEEP
TRIGGER to FREE RUN.
10. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and TUNING to center frequency of residual recorded in step 8.
11. Narrow FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW, using TUNING control to keep signal centered. Use SWEEP
TIME/DIV control to reduce sweep speed until signal level does not rise when sweep speed is further reduced.
Residual response must be less than - 100 dBm.
dBm
001: < - 95 dBm
002: < - 50 dBmV
12. Repeat steps 1 through 5.
13. Set START-CENTER switch to START and repeat steps 6 and 7.
4-35
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES(Cont'd)
14. Trigger sweep at least one more time and check for residual responses from 500 MHz to 1500 MHz. Record frequency at which residual response of greatest amplitude appears.
MHz
15. Repeat step 9.
16. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and TUNING to center frequency of residual recorded in step 14.
17. Narrow FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW, using TUNING control to keep signal centered. Use SWEEP
TIME/DIV control to reduce sweep speed until signal level does not rise when sweep speed is further reduced.
Residual response must be less than - 100 dBm.
dBm
001: < - 95 dBm
002: < - 50 dBm V
4-36
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE
SPECIFICATION
≤ ±
1.0 dB with 10 dB input attenuation
DESCRIPTION
Signals from 0.1 to 1500 MHz are applied to the input of the spectrum analyzer. The amplitude of each signal is adjusted to a reference set on the analyzer display. The power level, measured with a power meter, determines the frequency response of the spectrum analyzer.
Figure 4-17. Frequency Response Test Setup
4-37
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE(Cont'd)
EQUIPMENT
Tracking Generator........................................................................................................HP 8444A Opt. 059
Power Meter ................................................................................................................................... HP 435B
Power Sensor ............................................................................................................................... HP 8482A
Function Generator....................................................................................................................... HP 3310A
Power Splitter ............................................................................................................................. HP 11667A
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A
Type N cable, 180 cm (72 in) ...................................................................................................... HP 11500A
10 dB Attenuator............................................................................................................HP 8491B Opt. 010
Adapter, Type N (m) to Type N (m)........................................................................................ HP 1250-1475
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ............................................................................................. HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, Type N (m) to SMA (f), 50
Ω ..................................................................................... HP 1250-1250
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031
PROCEDURE
1.
Set controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer:
START- CENTER .......................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ..................................................................................................................................................... 0
FREQ SPAN/DIV........................................................................................................................................ 0
RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................... 100 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .....................................................................................................................................10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-10 dBm
002: + 40 dBmV
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF
2.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to peak LO feedthrough signal on display. Press FREQUENCY CAL and readjust
TUNING for peak. Repeat. Adjust TUNING for peak and adjust FREQUENCY ZERO for a FREQUENCY MHz reading of 00.0.
3.
Adjust TUNING for a FREQUENCY MHz reading of 5.0 MHz. Press FREQUENCY CAL. Set up equipment as
4.
Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to 1 dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE to bring the trace on the display.
Peak the trace using tracking generator TRACK ADJ.
4-38
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE(Cont'd)
5.
Set power meter CAL FACTOR according to chart on power probe (5 MHz). Set RANGE to - 10 dBm.
6.
Adjust tracking generator LEVEL to set a reference of - 12 dBm on the power meter.
7.
Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to position trace to fourth graticule line.
8.
For each setting in Table 4-5:
a.
Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING and press FREQUENCY CAL.
b.
Set power meter CAL FACTOR.
c.
Adjust tracking generator TRACK ADJ to peak signal on display and adjust LEVEL to place signal on reference graticule.
d.
Record Power Meter Reading.
9.
Disconnect Type N cable from power splitter. Connect function generator LOW output to power splitter.
10. Set controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................... 50 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 10 kHz
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV
Function Generator:
RANGE ........................................................................................................................................... 100 kHz
Frequency ..........................................................................................................................................5 MHz
FUNCTION...........................................................................................................................................SINE
DC OFFSET ............................................................................................................................................... 0
11. Set power meter CAL FACTOR according to chart on power sensor (5 MHz). Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to center 5 MHz signal on display. Set amplitude scale to 1 dB/DIV.
12. Adjust function generator OUTPUT LEVEL to - 12 dB on power meter.
13. Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to bring the peak of the 5 MHz signal to fourth graticule from bottom.
center screen. Adjust function generator OUTPUT LEVEL to bring signal peak to reference graticule on the display.
Set the power meter CAL FACTOR and record the power indicated by the power meter.
15. Find the overall maximum power reading from both Table 4-5 and Table 4-6.
dBm
4-39
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE (Cont'd)
16. Find the overall minimum power reading from both Table 4-5 and Table 4-6.
dBm
17. The difference between the overall maximum power in step 15 and the overall minimum power in step 16 should be less than 2 dB.
dB
Table 4-5. Frequency Response, 5 lMHz to 1500 MHz
Spectrum Analyzer TUNING
(MHz)
600
700
800
900
1000
1100
1200
5
100
200
300
400
500
1300
1400
1500
Power Meter Reading
(dBm)
-12(Ref.)
Table 4-6. Frequency Response, 100 kHz to 5 MHz
Spectrum Analyzer/Function Generator
Frequency
5 MHz
3 MHz
1 MHz
500 kHz
100 kHz
Power Meter Reading
(dBm)
-12 (Ref.)
4-40
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-21. BANDWIDTH SWITCHING (AMPLITUDE VARIATION)
SPECIFICATION
3 MHz to 300 kHz:
≤ ±
0.5 dB
3 MHz to I kHz:
≤ ±
1.0 dB (100 kHz bandwidth limited to < 80o R.H.)
DESCRIPTION
The spectrum analyzer 280 MHz CAL OUTPUT signal is applied to the INPUT connector and displayed on the CRT. The peak of the displayed 280 MHz signal is centered on the CRT and adjusted for a vertical deflection of seven divisions.
The amplitude variation of the 280 MHz signal is measured for each RESOLUTION BW control setting. The overall variation between RESOLUTION BW settings of 3 MHz to 300 kHz should be equal to or less than 1 dB (
±
0.5 dB). The overall variation between RESOLUTION BW settings of the 3 MHz to 1 kHz should be equal to or less than 2 dB (
±
1.0
dB).
EQUIPMENT
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ............................................................................................. HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ....................................................................................HP08558-60031
Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75
Ω ......................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START- CENTER .......................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV................................................................................................................................1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................3 MHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-20 dBm
002: + 30 dBm
REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................-10
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF
2.
Connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT signal to INPUT 50
Ω
connector.
001 and 002: 75
Ω
4-41
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-21. BANDWIDTH SWITCHING (AMPLITUDE VARIATION) (Cont'd)
3.
Set TUNING control, as required, to center 280 MHz signal on CRT.
4.
Set REF LEVEL FINE control to position peak of 280 MHz signal seven divisions above graticule baseline.
5.
Vary the RESOLUTION BW and FREQ SPAN/DIV controls in accordance with Table 4-7. Record the change in
amplitude for each RESOLUTION BW setting. Changes in amplitude above reference level set in step 4 are positive
(+). Changes below reference level are negative (-).
Table 4-7. Amplitude Accuracy, Switching Between Bandwidths
RESOLUTION
BW
Setting
FREQ
SPAN/DIV
Setting
Change in
Amplitude
(dB)
Overall Variation Between
3 MHz and 300 kHz
RESOLUTION BW Settings (dB)
Overall Variation
Between 3 MHZ and
1 HZ RESOLUTION
BW Settings (dB)
3 MHz
1 MHz
300 kHz
1 MHz
500 kHz
100 KH
0 (Ref)
100 kHz
30 kHz
10 kHz
3 kHz
1 kHz
50 kHz
10 KHz
5 kHz
5 kHz
5 kHz
6.
greatest positive change in amplitude. If all changes in amplitude are of the same sign, the overall variation is the largest positive or largest negative change in amplitude. The overall variation between 3 MHz and 300 kHz
RESOLUTION BW settings should be
≤
1.0 dB (
±
5.0 dB). The overall variation between 3 MHz and 1 kHz
RESOLUTION BW settings should be
≤
2.0 dB (
±
1.0 dB).
4-42
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-22. INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
Accuracy
±
0.5 dB for each 10 dB step but not more than
±
1.0 dB over full 70 dB range.
DESCRIPTION
The input attenuator accuracy is tested over its full 70 dB range using an RF substitution method. A step attenuator that has been calibrated by a Standards Laboratory at 30 MHz is used for substitution. The known error of the calibrated attenuator is taken into account when computing the 8558B input attenuator accuracy.
Figure 4-18. Input Attenuator Accuracy Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Step Attenuator................................................................................................................HP 355D Opt. H82
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m) ............................................................................................... HP 1250-0216
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m)................................................................................................ HP 1250-0216
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
BNC Cable, 30cm (12 in), 75
Ω............................................................................................HP 11652-60012
4-43
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-22 INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
START - CENTER ......................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 200 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .....................................................................................................................................70 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL..........................................................................................................................0 dBm
001 -10dBm
002: +40dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................... 2 o'clock
Signal Generator
COUNTER MODE .................................................................................................................................. INT
AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FREQUENCY TUNE ..................................................................................................................... 30.0 MHz
OUTPUT LEVEL.................................................................................................................................0 dBm
RF ...........................................................................................................................................................ON
2.
generator OUTPUT LEVEL until signal peak is 6 divisions above graticule baseline.
3.
sixth division reference set in step 2 for each setting.
Table 4-8. Input Attenuator Accuracy
INPUT ATTEN
Setting (dBm)
Step Attenuator
Setting (db)
Deviation from 6
Division (db) th
Step Attenuator Error
(Calibration)
Corrected Deviation
(db)
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
0 (Ref.) Ref.
0 (Ref.)
*Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-). For example, 9.99 dB calibration for a 10 dB attenuator setting represents an error of -0.01 dB.
4-44
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-22. INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)
4.
To compute Corrected Deviation, add Step Attenuator Error to Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.
Corrected Deviation should not differ more than 0.5 dB between any two adjacent settings of input attenuator.
Error Between Adjacent Settings
5.
Record maximum positive and maximum negative Corrected Deviation values. Difference between these two values (total deviation) should not exceed 2.0 dB (
±
1.0 dB).
dB Maximum Positive Corrected Deviation
dB Maximum Negative Corrected Deviation
dB Total Corrected Deviation
4-45
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
Step Accuracy:
Steps referenced with 0 dB input attenuation
-10 dBm to - 80 dBm:
±
0.5 dB
-10 dBm to - 100 dBm:
±
1.0 dB
Vernier Accuracy:
±
0.5 dB
DESCRIPTION
The reference level accuracy is tested over the range of - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm by checking the IF gain steps in 1 dB/DIV (Log) and in LIN. The resulting maximum deviation in each case must be less than 1.0 dB (
±
0.5 dB) from - 10 dBm to - 80 dBm and less than 2.0 dB (+ 1.0 dB) from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm.
002: Change range to + 40 dBm V to - 50 dBm V.
Figure 4-19. Reference Level Accuracy Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
1 dB Step Attenuator ......................................................................................................HP 355C Opt. H80
10 dB Step Attenuator.....................................................................................................HP 355D Opt. H82
Adapter (2 required)............................................................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200
4-46
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
Step Accuracy in Log Mode
1.
Set controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
START - CENTER ......................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV................................................................................................................................. 5 kHz
RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................. 3 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL dBm ..............................................................................................................-10 dBm
002: +40dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF
VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................... 2 o'clock
Signal Generator
COUNTER MODE .................................................................................................................................. INT
AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF
FREQUENCY TUNE ........................................................................................................................30 MHz
OUTPUT LEVEL..............................................................................................................................-10 dBm
2.
Connect equipment in Figure 4-19 with step attenuator set at 0 dB. Locate signal on CRT.
NOTE
If signal is difficult to locate, press RESOLUTION BW control to couple with FREQ SPANIDIV control and turn the coupled controls clockwise until signal appears on display. Momentarily depress FREQ CAL switch and center the signal, using TUNING control. Return controls to positions called out in step 1, adjusting TUNING control as necessary to keep signal centered.
3.
Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule baseline. Set the 8558B
6th Division (reference set in step 2) for each setting.
4.
To compute the Corrected Deviation, add the Step Attenuator Error to the Deviation from 6th Division for each setting. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from -10 dBm to -80 dBm should not exceed 1.0 dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm should not exceed 2.0 dB.
- 10 dBm to - 80 dBm dB
- 10 dBm to - 100 dBm dB
002: Change ranges to +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V and +40 dBm V to -50d BmV
4-47
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY (Cont'd)
Table 4-9. IF Gain Accuracy in LOG Mode
REFERENCE
LEVEL Setting
(dBm)
Step Attenuator
Setting
(db)
Deviation from
6 th
Division
(db)
Step Attenuator
Error (Calibration)*
(dB)
Corrected
Deviation
(db)
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
0 (Ref.) Ref.
0 (Ref.)
002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBm V) from top to bottom: 40, 30, 20, 10, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40, -50.
*Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-). For example, 9.99 dB calibration for a 10 dB attenuator setting represents an error of -0.01 dB.
Step Accuracy in Linear Mode
5.
Set the spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale switch to LIN. Set REFERENCE LEVEL control to - 10 dBm and set step ttenuator to 0 dB. Readjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule baseline.
6.
Deviation from the 6th Division in Linear Mode (reference set in step 5) for each setting.
7.
8.
To compute the Corrected Deviation, add the Step Attenuator Error to the Deviation from the 6th Division in dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to -
80 dBm should not exceed 1.0 dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative
Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm should not exceed 2.0 dB.
002: Change ranges to + 40 dBm V to -30 dBm V and +40 dBm V to -50 dBm V.
- 10 dBm to - 80 dBm dB
- 10 dBm to - 100 dBm _ dB
4-48
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY(Cont'd)
Table 4-10. IF Gain Accuracy in Linear Mode
REFERENCE
LEVEL
Setting (dBm)
Step Attenuator
Setting
(db)
Deviation from
6 th
Division in
Linear Mode (div.)
Deviation from
6 th
Division in db*
Step Attenuator
Error (Calibration)** (dB)
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
50
60
70
80
90
0
10
20
30
40
0 (Ref.) 0 (Ref.) Ref.
002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBmV) from top to bottom: 40, 30, 20, 10, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40, -50.
*Use Table 4-11 to convert deviation in linear mode to deviation in dB.
**Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-).
Table 4-11. Conversion Table, Deviation in Linear Mode
Corrected
Deviation
(dB)
0 (Ref.)
POSTIVE DEVIATIONS (Above 6 th
division from graticule baseline)
Liner (Divisions)I dB
0
+.1
+.2
+.3
+.4
+.5
+.6
+.7
+.8
+.9
+1.0
+1.1
+1.2
+1.3
+1.4
+1.5
0
+0.14
+0.28
+0.42
+0.56
+0.70
+0.82
+0.96
+1.09
+1.21
+1.34
+1.46
+1.58
+1.70
+1.82
+1.94
NEGATIVE DEVIATIONS (Below 6 th
division from graticule baseline)
Linear (Divisions) dB
-.4
-.5
-.6
-.7
-.8
-.9
-1.0
-1.1
-1.2
0
-.1
-.2
-.3
0
-0.15
-0.29
-0.45
-0.60
-0.76
-0.92
-1.08
-1.24
-1.41
-1.58
-1.76
-1.94
4-49
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY(Cont'd)
Vernier Accuracy
9.
Replace 10 dB step attenuator with 1 dB step attenuator. Set spectrum analyzer as follows:
REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 10 dBm
REFERENCE LEVEL FINE......................................................................................................................... 0
Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................dB/DIV
FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................... 50 kHz
RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................... 300 kHz
10. Center the signal on the CRT and adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule
Record Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.
11. To compute Corrected Deviation, add Step Attenuator Error to Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.
Corrected Deviation should not exceed + 0.5 dB or -0.5 dB for each setting.
Table 4-12. Vernier Accuracy
Step Attenuator
Setting
(dB)
0
10
11
8
9
12
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
REFERENCE
LEVEL FINE
Setting
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
-9
-10
-11
-12
Deviation From
6 th
Division
(dB)
0 (Ref.)
Step Attenuator
Error (Calibration)*
(dB)
Ref.
* Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-).
Corrected
Deviation
(dB)
0 (Ref.)
4-50
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-24. DISPLAY FIDELITY
SPECIFICATION
Log Incremental Accuracy:
± 0.1 dB per dB from Reference Level
Log Maximum Cumulative Error:
< ± 1.5 dB over entire 70-dB range
Linear Accuracy:
± 3% of Reference Level
DESCRIPTION
The amplitude log display amplifier is tested by connecting a DVM to the rear panel AUX A connector (vertical output) of the mainframe. The widest analyzer bandwidth possible is selected so the signal appears as a straight horizontal line on the CRT display. The DVM is used to provide good resolution when checking for ±1 dB per 10 dB step (0.1 dB/dB).
Figure 4-20. Amplitude Log Display Accuracy Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ............................................................................................................................. HP 8640B
Digital Voltmeter.............................................................................................................................. HP 3455A
10 dB Step Attenuator ....................................................................................................... HP 355D Opt. H82
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .............................................................................. HP 1250-0780
Cable, BNC to Banana Plug ...........................................................................................................HP 11001A
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ...........................................................................................HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)....................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ..................................................................................................... HP 1250-1200
4-51
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-24.
DISPLAY FIDELI TY (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
Log Display Accuracy
1.
Set controls as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
START - CENTER............................................................................................................................. CENTER
TUNING .............................................................................................................................................. 30 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ................................................................................................................................500 kHz
RESOLUTION BW ..............................................................................................................................300 kHz
INPUT ATTEN........................................................................................................................................ 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................................ 0 dBm
002: + dBm V
REF LEVEL FINE.......................................................................................................................................... 0
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER........................................................................................................................ FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER................................................................................................................................ OFF
VIDEO FILTER......................................................................................................................................... OFF
Digital Voltmeter
RANGE ......................................................................................................................................................100
FUNCTION ...........................................................................................................................................V (DC)
AUTO CAL .............................................................................................................................................AUTO
TRIGGER....................................................................................................................................... INTERNAL
MATH....................................................................................................................................................... OFF
Signal Generator
FREQUENCY...................................................................................................................................... 30 MHz
COUNTERMODE.......................................................................................................................................INT
OUTPUT LEVEL ................................................................................................................................... 0 dBm
AM ........................................................................................................................................................... OFF
FM ........................................................................................................................................................... OFF
2.
3.
4.
5.
With no signal at INPUT, measure and record the vertical output (AUX A) offset of the spectrum analyzer.
_______ mV
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4 20. Tune signal generator to 30 MHz and set power output for approximately 0 dBm. Set step attenuator to 0 dB.
Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to 10 dB/DIV and adjust TUNING control to center the signal on CRT display.
Set the FREQ SPAN/DIV control to zero (0) and RESOLUTION BW control to 100 kHz. Tune the signal generator frequency for maximum reading on DVM.
4-52
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-24.
DISPLAY FIDELITY(Cont'd)
6.
Set the signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL so the DVM reads + 800 mV plus the offset (step 2) ± 0.5 mV. The trace should be approximately at the top graticule line.
Table 4-13. Amplitude Log Display Accuracy
AUX A
Theoretical
Reading
(mV)
AUX A Theoretical
Reading Subtracted
From Corrected
DMV Reading
(mV)
Difference
Between
Adjacent
Readings
(mV)
Attenuator
Setting
(dB)
DVM
Reading
(mV)
Corrected
DMV
Reading*
(mV)
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
*DVM Reading minus offset recorded in step 2.
+800 (Ref.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
+800
+700
+600
+500
+400
+300
+200
+100
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Example (+ 5 mV offset):
Table 4-14. Sample Computations of Amplitude Log Display Accuracy
Attenuator
Setting
(dB)
DVM
Reading
(mV)
Corrected
DMV
Reading*
(mV)
AUX A
Theoretical
Reading
(mV)
AUX A Theoretical
Reading Subtracted
From Corrected
DMV Reading
(mV)
Difference
Between
Adjacent
Readings
(mV)
7.
8.
0
10
20
30
40
+805
+811
+599
+497
+406
*DVM Reading minus offset recorded in step 2.
+800
+703
+594
+492
+401
+800
+700
+600
+500
+400
0
+3
-6
-8
+1
-3
+9
+2
-9
Record the DVM Reading for each 10 dB step of the step attenuator, up to 70 dB, in Table 4-13.
Having recorded the DVM readings for all of the attenuator settings from 0 to 70 dB, subtract the AUX A
Theoretical Reading from the Corrected DVM Reading (DVM reading minus offset) in each case and record
mV (± 1.5 dB).
4-53
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
11.
12.
13.
4.24.
DISPLAY FIDELITY (Cont'd)
9.
Subtract each converted reading (AUX A Theoretical Reading Subtracted From Corrected DVM Reading) from
(see Example).
10.
The difference between adjacent readings (Table 4-13) should not exceed 10 mV (4 0.1 dB/dB).
Linear Display Accuracy
14.
15.
Replace 10 dB step attenuator with 1 dB step attenuator. Set step attenuator to 0 dB.
Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to LIN and RESOLUTION BW control to 1 MHz.
Peak the signal on the CRT display using the TUNING control. Set the signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to place the trace at the top graticule line.
Set the step attenuator to 6 dB. Trace should be at 4th division above graticule baseline (center horizontal graticule line) 1.2 minor divisions.
_______ div
Set the step attenuator to 12 dB. Trace should be at 2nd division above graticule baseline 1.2 minor divisions.
_______ div
4-54
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-25.
CALIBRATOR ACCURACY
SPECIFICATION
Amplitude: -30 dBm ± 1 dB.
002: +20dBmV ± 1 dB.
Frequency: 280 MHz ±300 MHz.
DESCRIPTION
The amplitude accuracy and frequency accuracy of the CAL OUTPUT signal are checked for -30 dBm ± 1 dB and 280
MHz ± 300 kHz, respectively.
002: +20dBmV ±1 dB.
Figure 4-21. Calibrator Accuracy Test Setup
4-55
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-25.
CALIBRATOR ACCURACY (Cont'd)
EQUIPMENT
Amplifier.......................................................................................................................................... HP 8447D
Signal Generator ............................................................................................................................. HP 8640B
10 dB Step Attenuator (Calibrated at 280 MHz) ................................................................. HP 355D Opt. H82
Power Meter ...................................................................................................................................... HP 435B
300 MHz LPF ............................................................................................................. TELONIC TLP 300-4AB
Power Sensor .................................................................................................................................. HP 8482A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .............................................................................. HP 1250-6780
Adapter, Type N (f) to BNC (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-0077
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) (2 required)..........................................................................................HP 10503A
Additional Equipment for Options 001 and 002:
Power Sensor, 750 .......................................................................................................................... HP 8483A
Adapter, GR Type 874 to BNC (m), 75
Ω.................................................................. General Radio 0874-9754
Adapter, GR Type 874 to N (f), 75
Ω ........................................................................ General Radio 0874-9751
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75Q to 50
Ω ...................................................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-0216
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)....................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC(f) to SMA (m) ...................................................................................................... HP 1250-1200
BNC Cable 30 cm (12 in), 75
Ω .............................................................................................. HP 11652-60012
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
2.
3.
START - CENTER............................................................................................................................. CENTER
TUNING ............................................................................................................................................ 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................................................. 1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW ................................................................................................................................ 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN........................................................................................................................................ 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ......................................................................................................................... -20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER........................................................................................................................ FREE RUN
BASELINE CLIPPER................................................................................................................................ OFF
Set signal generator COUNTER MODE to EXT, 0-550, and EXPAND-X10. Connect spectrum analyzer CAL
OUTPUT to signal generator COUNTER INPUT connector through amplifier. Frequency counter should indicate
280 MHz ± 300 kHz.
__________ MHz
Set signal generator COUNTER MODE to INT and tune frequency to 280 MHz. Connect output of signal generator to calibrated step attenuator through 300 MHz low pass filter. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to
0 dBm.
4-56
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4.
5.
6.
7.
4-25.
CALIBRATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)
4.
5.
Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL power for a 10 dBm reading on power meter. Leave signal generator set at this level.
Set step attenuator to 30 dB and connect output of step attenuator to spectrum analyzer INPUT connector.
Set spectrum analyzer TUNING control to center signal on CRT display. Peak amplitude of reference signal should be one division down from top graticule line.
8.
9.
PROCEDURE FOR OPTIONS 001 and 002:
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as indicated above.
2.
Set Amplitude Scale switch to I dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE control so peak amplitude of reference signal is one division down from top graticule line.
Disconnect reference signal and connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT to the INPUT connector. Signal peak amplitude should be one division down from top graticule line ±1 division.
- 31 dBm _______ 29 dBm
3.
Connect CAL OUTPUT to 8640B counter input connector through amplifier. Frequency counter should indicate
280 MHz ±300 kHz. (Use EXPAND X10 COUNTER MODE, EXT 0-550.)
Set signal generator frequency to 280 MHz. Connect output of signal generator to calibrated step attenuator and
75-ohm minimum loss adapter (approximately 5.7 dB attenuation). Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to 5 dBm.
6.
7.
Set the step attenuator to 0 dB. Connect minimum loss adapter through power sensor to power meter.
Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a 10 dBm (Option 001) or -8.75 dBm (Option 002) reading on power meter. Leave the signal generator set at this level.
Set step attenuator to 20 dB and connect -30 dBm (+20 dBm V) reference signal from signal generator through step attenuator, minimum loss adapter, and 75 ohm cable to HP 8558B INPUT 75
Ω connector.
With Amplitude Scale switch set to 10 dB/DIV, adjust TUNING control to center signal on CRT display. Peak amplitude of reference signal should be one division down from the top graticule line.
4-57
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PERFORMANCE TESTS
4-25.
CALIBRATOR ACCURACY (Cont'd)
8.
Set Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE control so peak amplitude of reference signal is on seventh graticule line (one division down from top).
9.
Disconnect the reference signal and connect HP 8558B CAL OUTPUT through 75-ohm cable to INPUT 75g connector. Signal peak amplitude should be one division down from top, plus or minus one division.
002:
001: -31 dBm
+ 19 dBm V
_______ 29 dBm
______21 dBm V
4-58
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (1 of 4)
Hewlett-Packard Company Tested by: __________
Model 8558B
Spectrum Analyzer 0.1-1500 MHz
Serial No. _________________ Date: ______________
Paragraph Results
Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.
3.
100 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
4.
50 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
5.
20 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV .-0.4 div - +0.4 div
6.
10 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
7.
5 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
8.
2 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
9.
1 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
10. 500 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
13. 200 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
14. 100 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
50 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
20 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
10 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
5 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div
5.
10.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(8.96 MHz) (11.04 MHz)
6.
20.0MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(18.96 MHz) (21.04 MHz)
40.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(38.96 MHz) (41.04 MHz)
60.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(58.96 MHz) (61.04 MHz)
80.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(78.96 MHz) (81.04 MHz)
100.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(96.96 MHz) (101.04 MHz)
120.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(118.96 MHz) (121.04 MHz)
140.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(138.96 MHz) (141.04 MHz)
160.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(158.96 MHz) (161.04 MHz)
180.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(178.96 MHz) (181.04 MHz)
200 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(194.8 MHz) (205.2 MHz)
4-59
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (2 of 4)
Paragraph Results
Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.
400 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(394.8 MHz) (405.2 MHz)
600 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(594.8 MHz) (605.2 MHz)
800 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(794.8 MHz) (805.2 MHz)
1000 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(994.8 MHz) (1005.2 MHz)
1200 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(1194.8 MHz) (1205.2 MHz)
1400 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(1394.8 MHz) (1405.2 MHz)
1500 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div
(1494.8 MHz) (1505.2 MHz)
6.
Peak-to-Peak Variation of Trace - 1.0 div
(1 kHz/0.1 sec)
6.
Noise Sidebands - 6.5 div down
(-65 dB)
4-15 Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy
7.
3 MHz Resolution BW 2.40 MHz - 3.60 MHz
8.
1 MHz Resolution BW 800 kHz - 1.20 MHz
9.
300 kHz Resolution BW 240 kHz - 360 kHz
10. 100 kHz Resolution BW 80 kHz - 120 kHz
17. 30 kHz Resolution BW 24 kHz - 36 kHz
18. 10 kHz Resolution BW 8 kHz - 12 kHz
19. 3 kHz Resolution BW 2.4 kHz - 3.6 kHz
20. 1 kHz Resolution BW 0.8 kHz - 1.2 kHz
4-16 Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity
24. 3 MHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
1 MHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
300 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
100 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
30 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
10 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
3 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
1 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1
4-60
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (3 of 4)
Paragraph Results
Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.
2 Average Noise Level 1 MHz to 1000 MHz - -107 dBm
3 Average Noise Level 500 MHz to 1500 MHz - -107 dBm
5 Average Noise Level 1 MHz to 11 MHz - -107 dBm
001: Max. is -100 dBm
002: Max. is -53 dBm V
9.
Harmonic Distortion
2nd Harmonic -70 dB -
3rd Harmonic -70 dB -
18. Third Order Intermodulation Distortion,
30 MHz input signals -70 dB -
20. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,
30 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -70 dB -
22. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,
30 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -70 dB -
27. Third Order Intermodulation Distortion,
4 MHz input signals -60 dB -
29. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,
4 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -60 dB -
30. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,
4 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -60 dB -
11. Residual Responses 1 MHz to 1000 MHz - -100 dBm
17. Residual Responses 500 MHz to 1500 MHz - -100 dBm
001: Max. is <-95 dBm
002: Max. is <-45 dBm V
17. Frequency Response - 2.0 dB
4-21 Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude Variation)
6.
3 MHz to 300 kHz (overall variation) -0.5 dB - +0.5 dB
3 MHz to 1 kHz (overall variation) -1.0 dB - +1.0 dB
4-22 Input Attenuator Accuracy
4.
Error Between Adjacent Settings - ±0.5 dB
(1.0 dB)
5.
Error Over Full 70 dB Range - ±1.0 dB
(2.0 dB)
4-61
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (4 of 4)
Paragraph Results
Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.
4.
Step Accuracy in Log
-10 dBm to -80 dBm ±0.5 dB
(1.0 dB)
-10 dBm to -100 dBm ±1.0 dB
(2.0 dB)
002: +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V
+40 dBm V to -50 dBm V
8.
Step Accuracy in LIN
-10 dBm to 80 dBm ±0.5 dB
(1.0 dB)
-10 dBm to -100 dBm ±1.0 dB
(2.0 dB)
002: +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V
+40 dBm V to -50 dBm V
11. Vernier Accuracy
REF LEVEL FINE:
-1 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-2 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-3 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-4 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-5 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-6 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-7 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-8 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-9 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-10 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-11 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
-12 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB
Log Display Accuracy
8.
Maximum Error Over Full 70 dB Display Range ±1.5 dB
(±15 mV)
10. Error Between Adjacent Readings ±1.0 dB
(±10 mV)
Linear Display Accuracy
14. Error at 4th division 3.76 div 4.24 div
15. Error at 2nd division 1.76 div 2.24 div
2.
CAL OUTPUT Frequency 279.7 MHz 280.3 MHz
9.
CAL OUTPUT Amplitude -31 dBm -29 dBm
002: Min. is + 19 dBm V, Max. is +21 dBm V
4-62
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
4-63 through 4-69
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION V.
ADJUSTMENTS
5-7. Adjustment Tools 5-1. INTRODUCTION
5-2. The adjustments in this section are required to optimize spectrum analyzer performance after repair.
Table 5-1 lists adjustable components by adjustment
name, reference designation, adjustment paragraph, and description.
5-3. Data taken during adjustment should be recorded in the spaces provided. Comparison of initial data with data taken during periodic adjustments is useful for preventive maintenance and troubleshooting.
WARNING
5-8. For adjustments requiring a non-metallic tuning tool, use fiber tuning tool, HP Part Number 8170-0033.
Never try to force an adjustment control in the analyzer.
This is especially critical when tuning slug-tuned inductors and variable capacitors.
5-9. Extender Cable Installation
WARNING
The adjustments in this section require the spectrum analyzer to be removed from the display mainframe and connected through an extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. The adjustments in this section should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.
NOTE
Before performing any adjustments, allow 1 hour warmup time.
5-4. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
5-5. The table of Recommended Test Equipment in
Section I lists the test equipment and test accessories
required in the adjustment procedures. In addition, the table lists the required minimum specifications and suggested manufacturers' model numbers.
5-6. Required service accessories, with part
numbers, are illustrated in Section I.
Disconnect mainframe line cord before installing extender cable assembly.
5-10. Pull out the lock knob and slide the spectrum analyzer out of the display mainframe. If side stops are
installed, refer to Section II for removal.
5-11. Carefully slide the extender cable assembly,
HP part number 5060-0303, into the display mainframe, aligning the metal guide plate with the slotted side rails of the mainframe. Firmly seat the extender cable assembly to ensure good contact.
5-12. Connect the opposite end of the cable to the spectrum analyzer. The plug is keyed so it will go on correctly and will not make contact upside down.
Remove the orange and the yellow leads from pins 3 and 4 on the A15 board at the rear of the spectrum analyzer. Connect the corresponding leads from the extender cable assembly to these pins by means of the insulated alligator clips.
5-13. RELATED ADJUSTMENTS
5-14. These adjustments should be performed
whenever troubleshooting information in Section VIII
indicates that an adjustable circuit is not operating properly. Perform the adjustments after repair or replacement of the circuit. The troubleshooting
procedures and Table 5-1 specify the required
adjustments.
5-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
5-15.
FACTORY-SELECTED COMPONENTS
5-16.
Table 5-2 provides a list of factory-selected
components by reference designation, selection procedure paragraph number, range of values, and basis
5-2 of selection. Factory-selected components are designated by an asterisk (*) on the schematic diagrams
in Section VIII and in the table of Replaceable Parts,
Section VI. Part numbers for standard-value
components can be found in Table 5-3.
Model 8558B
+14.5V
FM
GAIN
RNG
OFS
2 ms
1 ms
+10V
Adjustment
Name
REF
2nd MIXER MATCH
Z1, Z2, Z3
2nd LO FREQUENCY
3.55 GHZ
3.55 FINE
2.0 GHZ
REF V
XTL
LC
LO FREQ
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (1 of 4)
Reference
Designator
Adjustment
Paragraph
A1A2R3
A5L2
A5Z1 A5Z3
A5Z4
A7R1
A7R2
A7R3
A7R4
A7R5
A7R6
A7R7
A7R8
A7R72
A8R13
A8R10
A8R7
A8R72
A8R85
A9L4
Description
Adjusts DPM reference voltage and adjusts frequency for correct FREQUENCY MHz readout at 1500 MHz.
Adjust for optimum match between second converter output and second IF input.
Adjust the bandpass of the 2050 MHz bandpass filter.
Adjusts second LO frequency to 1748.60 MHz.
Coarse adjustment of YIG upper frequency limit, 3.55
GHz.
Fine adjustment of YIG upper frequency limit, 3.55
GHz.
Adjusts YIG lower frequency limit, 2.05 GHz
Adjusts reference voltage to 6.0 volts and is fine adjustment of YIG lower frequency limit, 2.05 GHz.
Adjusts 14.5 volt supply to +14.5 volts.
Adjusts frequency span accuracy for frequency spans
<1 MHz per division.
Adjusts frequency for correct DPM frequency readout at 190.0 MHz.
Adjusts frequency control circuit for proper DPM ranging.
Adjusts frequency for correct FREQUENCY MHZ readout at 200 MHz.
Adjusts sweep ramp to calibrate 2 ms per division sweep time.
Adjusts sweep ramp to calibrate 1 ms per division sweep time.
Adjusts +10 volt supply. This adjustment must be performed while spectrum analyzer is still cold, during first five minutes after turn on.
Adjusts IF bandwidth between 3 dB points for
RESOLUTION BW setting of 3 kHz.
Adjusts IF bandwidth between 3 dB points for
RESOLUTION BW setting of 1 MHz.
Adjusts third converter 280 MHz crystal-controlled LO for maximum output.
5-3
Model 8558B
Adjustment
Name
SLOPE COMP
3rd LO PWR
C 1, C2, C3
2nd IF TUNING
SYM
LC CTR
CTR
SYM
LC CTR
CTR
C73
C74
LC
XTL
40 dB
10 dB
GAIN
0 dB
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (2 of 4)
Reference
Designator
A9R1
Adjustment
Paragraph
A9R5
A10C1 A10C3
A10L2
A11C15
A11C23
A11C25
A11C38
A11C45
A11C54
A11C73
A11C74
A11R26
A11R31
A12R1
A12R3
A12R4
A12R5
Description
Compensates for frequency response of input mixer, allowing flatness of less than 2 dB.
Adjusts CAL OUTPUT signal for -30 dBm power level.
002: +20 dBm V.
Adjust the bandpass of the Second IF assembly
Bandpass Filter (301.4 MHz).
Peaks second IF bandpass amplifier. Has very little effect on signal.
Adjust symmetry of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of first stage of LC bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts symmetry of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of second stage of LC bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Compensates for capacitance of CR3.
Compensates for capacitance of CR11.
Adjusts feedback in LC circuit of bandpass filter.
Adjusts feedback in crystal circuit of bandpass filter.
Adjust 40 dB step gain.
Adjusts 10 dB step gain.
Adjusts overall gain of Step Gain assembly.
Adjusts to calibrate 0 dB position of REF LEVEL FINE control.
5-4
Model 8558B
Adjustment
Name
-12 dB
+19.5V
SYM
LC CTR
CTR
SYM
LC CTR
CTR
C73
C74
LC
XTL
OFFSET
TC
SLOPE
G6
G5
G4
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (3 of 4)
Reference
Designator
A12R6
Adjustment
Paragraph
A12R7
A13C15
A13C23
A13C25
A13C38
A13C45
A13C54
A13C73
A13C74
A13R26
A13R31
A14R10
A14R21
A14R23
A14R27
A14R30
A14R33
Description
Adjusts to calibrate -12 dB position of REF LEVEL
FINE control.
Adjusts +19.5 volt supply.
Adjusts symmetry of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of first stage of LC bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts symmetry of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of second stage of LC bandwidth filter.
Adjusts centering of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.
Compensate for capacitance of CR3.
Compensates for capacitance of CR11 .
Adjusts feedback in LC circuit of bandpass filter.
Adjusts feedback in crystal circuit of bandpass filter.
Adjusts -8V temperature compensated supply.
Adjusts gain of +1V supply to provide temperature compensation for log mode temperature controlled variable gain amplifier. (Factory adjustable only.)
Adjusts gain of log mode temperature controlled gain amplifier.
Adjusts combined gain of 2nd and 3rd stages in linear mode.
Adjusts gain of 4th stage in linear mode.
Adjusts gain of 5th stage in linear mode.
5-5
Model 8558B
Adjustment
Name
LIN
-10 dB
-30 dB
1 VT
LOG GAIN
1 dB OFFSET
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (4 of 4)
Reference
Designator
A14R34
Adjustment
Paragraph
A14R39
A14R69
A14R88
A14R121
A15R1
Description
Adjusts combined gain of 6th and 7th stages in linear mode.
Adjusts shape of log fidelity curve at -10 dB.
Adjusts shape of log fidelity curve at -30 dB.
Adjusts voltage at A14TP1 for approximately +1V.
(Factory adjustable only.)
Adjusts dc offset circuitry at output of A14 Log
Amplifier Assembly for 10 dB steps in log mode.
Adjusts for equal amplitude displayed at full screen in
10 dB/DIV and 1 dB/DIV for a given input.
5-6
A8R30
A8R35
A8R74
A8R76
A8R78
A9R89
A8R92
A8R95
A8R105
A8R125
A9R4
A9R9
A9R12
A9R14
A11C20
A11C44
A11R23
A11R43
A11R48
A11R56
A13C20
A13C44
A13R19
A13R23
A13R43
A13R48
A13R56
A14R93
A14R101
A14R107
A15R26
A17R1
Model 8558B
Reference
Designator
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-2. Factory Selected Components in Alpha-Numerical Order
Selection
Procedure
Paragraph
Number
Basis of Selection
Selected to set start of sweep ramp to -5.OOOV ±30 mV.
Selected to set high end of sweep ramp to +5V.
Selected to optimize 1 kHz bandwidth.
Selected to optimize 3 kHz bandwidth.
Selected to optimize 10 kHz bandwidth.
Selected to optimize 300 kHz bandwidth.
Selected to optimize 1 MHz bandwidth.
Selected to optimize 3 MHz bandwidth.
Selected for OV at A8TP8 with START CENTER switch in START, 100 MHz/DIV, single scan mode (no sweep).
Selected for optimum automatic sweep time with VIDEO FILTER on (but not in detent).
Selected for proper Third Converter LO power.
Selected for proper CAL OUTPUT power.
Selected for proper gain of Third Converter.
Selected for proper REF LEVEL CAL range.
Selected to shift adjustment range of A11C23.
Selected to shift adjustment range of A11C45.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.
Selected to equalize feedback between LC stages (not field selectable).
Selected to shift adjustment range of A13C23.
Selected to shift adjustment range of A13C45.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.
Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.
Selected to equalize feedback between LC stages (not field selectable).
Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R34.
Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R34.
Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R23.
Selected to provide increased range adjustment for 1 dB offset circuit.
Selected for proper voltage offset of A17Q1 and A17Q2 to ensure initial turn-on of oscillator.
5-7
Model 8558B
RANGE: 1 to 24 pF
TYPE: Tubular
TOLERANCE:
1 to 9.1 pF = ±.25 pF
10 to 24 pF = ±5%
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (1 of 3)
CAPACITORS
RANGE: 27 to 680 pF
TYPE: Dipped Mica
TOLERANCE: ±5%
Value
(pF)
3.6
3.9
4.3
4.7
5.1
2.2
2.4
2.7
3.0
3.3
1.0
1.2
1.5
1.8
2.0
5.6
6.2
6.8
7.5
8.2
9.1
10.0
11.0
12.0
13.0
15.0
16.0
18.0
20.0
22.0
24.0
HP Part Number
0160-2236
0160-2237
0150-0091
0160-2239
0160-2240
0160-2241
0160-2242
0160-2243
0160-2244
0150-0059
0160-2246
0160-2247
0160-2248
0160-2249
0160-2250
0160-2251
0160-2252
0160-2253
0160-2254
0160-2255
OloO-2256
0160-2257
0160-2258
0160-2259
0160-2260
0160-2261
0160-2262
0160-2263
0160-2264
0160-2265
0160-2266
0
3
6
1
2
5
6
7
8
8
8
1
4
8
9
9
0
1
7
8
9
0
1
2
3
2
3
4
5
8
4
C
D
5-8
Value
(pF)
68
75
82
91
100
110
120
130
150
160
180
200
220
240
43
47
51
56
62
27
30
33
36
330
360
390
430
470
510
560
620
680
HP Part Number
0160-2306
0160-2199
0160-2150
0160-2308
0160-2200
0160-2307
0160-2201
0140-0191
0140-0205
0140-0192
0160-2202
0140-0193
0160-2203
0160-2204
0140-0194
0160-2205
0140-0195
0140-0196
0160-2206
0140-0197
0140-0198
0160-0134
0140-0199
0160-2208
0160-2209
0140-0200
0160-0939
0160-3533
0160-3534
0160-3535
0160-3536
0160-3537
1
2
3
2
0
1
0
9
9
8
1
6
4
5
6
4
7
8
5
5
5
3
2
C
D
0
3
4
1
2
4
5
0
4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (2 of 3)
RESISTORS
RANGE: 10 to 464 K Ohms
TYPE: Fixed-Film
WATTAGE: .125 at 125
°
C
TOLERANCE: ±1.0%
Value
(
Ω)
75.0
82.5
90.9
100
110
121
133
38.3
42.2
46.4
51.1
56.2
61.9
68.1
17.8
19.6
21.5
23.7
26.1
28.7
31.6
34.8
10.0
11.0
12.1
13.3
14.7
16.2
147
162
178
196
215
237
261
287
316
348
383
422
HP Part Number
0698-3435
0757-0316
0698-4037
0757-0394
0757-0395
0757-0276
0757-0397
0757-0398
0757-0399
0757-0400
0757-0401
0757-0402
0757-0403
0698-3437
0757-0346
0757-0378
0757-0379
0698-3427
0698-3428
0757-0382
0757-0294
0698-3429
0698-3430
0698-3431
0698-3432
0698-3433
0757-0180
0698-3434
0698-3438
0757-0405
0698-3439
0698-3440
0698-3441
0698-3442
0698-3132
0698-3443
0698-3444
0698-3445
0698-3446
0698-3447
C Value
D
2
2
0
1
4
5
9
7
3
0
1
0
6
0
2
9
7
8
5
6
9
2
0
1
6
2
0
1
2
3
0
1
4
9
4
7
8
3
4
4
(
Ω)
1.78K
1.96K
2.15K
2.37K
2.61K
2.87K
3.16K
3.48K
3.83K
4.22K
4.64K
5.11K
5.62K
6.19K
464
511
562
619
681
750
825
909
1.0K
1.1K
1.21K
1.33K
1.47K
1.62K
6.81K
7.50K
8.25K
9.09K
10.0K
11.0K
12.1K
13.3K
14.7K
16.2K
17.8K
19.6K
HP Part Number
0757-0278
0698-0083
0698-0084
0698-3150
0698-0085
0698-3151
0757-0279
0698-3152
0698-3153
0698-3154
0698-3155
0757-0438
0757-0200
0757-0290
0698-0082
0757-0416
0757-0417
0757-0418
0757-0419
0757-0420
0757-0421
0757-0422
0757-0280
0757-0424
0757-0274
0757-0317
0757-1094
0757-0428
0757-0439
0757-0440
0757-0441
0757-0288
0757-0442
0757-0443
0757-0444
0757-0289
0698-3156
0757-0447
0698-3136
0698-3157
5-9
C
D
4
8
2
2
3
7
5
1
3
8
9
0
7
0
6
0
9
8
9
9
1
5
7
3
7
4
5
9
0
3
7
7
8 o
1
1
9
4
7
8
Value
(
Ω)
21.5K
23.7K
26.1K
28.7K
31.6K
34.8K
38.3K
42.2K
46.4K
51.1K
56.2K
61.9K
68.1K
75.0K
162K
178K
196K
215K
237K
261K
287K
82.5K
90.9K
100K
110K
121K
133K
147K
316K
348K
383K
422K
464K
HP Part Number
0757-0463
0757-0464
0757-0465
0757-0466
0757-0467
0698-3451
0698-3452
0757-0470
0698-3243
0698-3453
0698-3454
0698-3266
0698-3455
0698-3456
0757-0199
0698-3158
0698-3159
0698-3449
0698-3160
0757-0123
0698-3161
0698-3450
0698-3162
0757-0458
0757-0459
0757-0460
0757-0461
0757-0462
0698-3457
0698-3458
0698-3459
0698-3460
0698-3260
4
5
3
5
3
8
2
0
1
7
8
4
5
6
6
7
8
1
9
2
3
8
1
0
7
9
9
6
8
3
3
4
5
C
D
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (3 of 3)
RESISTORS
RANGE: 10 to 1.47M Ohms
TYPE: Fixed-Film
WATTAGE: .5 at 125°C
TOLERANCE:
±
1%
HP Part
Number
0757-0984
0575-0985
0757-0986
0757-0001
0698-3388
0757-0989
0698-3389
0698-3390
0698-3391
0698-3392
0757-0003
0698-3393
0698-3394
0698-3395
0698-3396
0698-3397
0698-3398
0757-1000
0757-1001
0757-1002
0757-0794
0757-0795
0757-0796
0757-0797
0757-0198
0757-0798
0757-0799
0698-3399
0698-3400
0757-0802
0698-3334
0757-1060
Value
(
Ω)
68.1
75.0
82.5
90.0
100
110
121
34.8
38.3
42.2
46.4
51.1
56.2
61.9
17.8
19.6
21.5
23.7
26.1
28.7
31.6
10.0
11.0
12.1
13.3
14.7
16.2
133
147
162
178
196
8
9
7
2
4
5
6
8
9
4
7
1
2
3
5
8
5
9
9
9
0
8
8
3
6
7
2
9
6
6
4
5
C
D
Value HP Part
(
Ω)
Number
215 0698-3401 0
237 0698-3102 8
261 0757-1090 5
287 0757-1092 7
316 0698-3402 1
348 0698-3403 2
383 0698-3404 3
422 0698-3405 4
464 0698-0090 7
511 0757-0814 9
562 0757-0815 0
619 0757-0158 4
681 0757-0816 1
750 0757-0817 2
825 0757-0818 3
909 0757-0819 4
1.00K
0757-0159 5
1.10K
0757-0820 7
1.21K
0757-0821 8
1.33K
0698-3406 5
1.47K
0757-1078 9
1.62K
0757-0873 0
1.78K
0698-0089 4
1.96K
0698-3407 6
2.15K
0698-3408 7
2.37K
0698-3409 8
2.61K
0698-0024 7
2.87K
0698-3101 7
3.16K
0698-3410 1
3.48K
0698-3411 2
3.83K
0698-3412 3
4.22K
0698-3346 2
C Value
D (
Ω)
HP Part
Number
C
D
4.64K
0698-3348 4
5.11K
0757-0833 2
5.62K
0757-0834 3
6.19K
0757-0196 0
6.81K
0757-0835 4
7.50K
0757-0836 5
8.25K
0757-0837 6
9.09K
0757-0838 7
10.0K
0757-0839 8
12.1K
0757-0841 2
13.3K
0698-3413 4
14.7K
0698-3414 5
16.2K
0757-0844 5
17.8K
0698-0025 8
19.6K
0698-3415 6
21.5K
0698-3416 7
23.7K
0698-3417 8
26.1K
0698-3418 9
28.7K
0698-3103 9
31.6K
0698-3419 0
34.8K
0698-3420 3
38.3K
0698-3421 4
42.2K
0698-3422 5
46.4K
0698-3423 6
51.1K
0757-0853 6
56.2K
0757-0854 7
61.9K
0757-0309 7
68.1K
0757-0855 8
75.0K
0757-0856 9
82.5K
0757-0857 0
90.9K
0757-0858 1
100K 0757-0367 7
Value HP Part C
(
Ω)
Number D
110K 0757-0859 2
121K 0757-0860 5
133K 0757-0310 0
147K 0698-3175 5
162K 0757-0130 2
178K 0757-0129 9
196K 0757-0063 0
215K 0757-0127 7
237K 0698-3424 7
261K 0757-0064 1
287K 0757-0154 0
316K 0698-3425 8
348K 0757-0195 9
383K 0757-0133 5
422K 0757-0134 6
464K 0698-3426 9
51IK 0757-0135 7
562K 0757-0868 3
619K 0757-0136 8
681K 0757-0869 4
750K 0757-0137 9
825K 0757-0870 7
909K 0757-0138 0
1M 0757-0059 4
1.M
0757-0139 1
1.21M
0757-0871 8
1.33M
0757-0194 8
1.47M
0698-3464 5
5-10
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 5-4. Related Adjustments
Assembly Charged or Repaired Perform the Following Related Adjustments
Paragraph
Number
A1
A2
A3
A4
AS
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11,
A13*
A12
A14
A15
A16
A17
Digital Panel Meter A1A2R3
Front Switch A12RS, A12R6
Input Attenuator
First Converter
No related adjustments
A9R1
Second Converter A5Z1, A5Z2, A5Z3, A5Z4, A5L2
YIG Oscillator A1A2R3, A7R1, A7R2, A7R3, A7R4, A7R6, A7R7,
A7R8, A7R72
Frequency Control A5Z4
A1A2R3, A7R1, A7R2, A7R3, A7R4, A7R5, A7R6,
A7R7, A7R72
Sweep Generator A8R2, A8R10, A8R13, A8R72, A8R85
A9L4, A9R5, A9R1 Third Converter
Second IF
Bandwidth Filters
A10C1, A10C2, A10C3, A10L2
A11C15, A11C23, A11C25, A11C38, A11C45, A11C54, A11C73,
A11C74, A13C15, A13C23, A13C25, A13C38, A13C45, A13C54,
A13C73, A13C74, A8R72, A8R85
A12R1, A12R2, A12R3, A12R4, A12R5, A12R6, A12R7 Step Gain
Log Amplifier
Vertical Driver and Blanking
Motherboard
Inverter
A14R23, A14R27, A14R30, A14R33, A14R34, A14R39,
A14R69, A14R121
A15R1
No related adjustments
No related adjustments
*A11 and A13 bandwidth filter assemblies contain a matched set of crystals. These two assemblies must be treated as a matched pair when replacement is necessary.
5-11
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-17.
SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS
REFERENCE
A5 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
The second converter is adjusted for 1748.60 MHz and the bandpass filter is adjusted for a 2050 MHz Bandpass.
Figure 5-1. Second Converter LO and Bandpass Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Frequency Counter.................................................................................................................... HP 5342A
Comb Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8406A
Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001
Adapter, SMC (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................ HP 1250-0827
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f). .......................................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable 120 cm (48 in) .......................................................................................................HP 10503A
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω................................................................................ HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω ....................................................................................HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................ HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC(f) to SMA (m)................................................................................................ HP 1250-1200
5-12
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-17.
SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
NOTE
The special adapter in Figure 5-1 is made from a SMC (f) to SMC (f) adapter, HP Part No. 1250-
1113. The nuts must be soldered to the body of the subminiature RF adapter so they will both
turn with the body. Be sure to space the nuts properly before soldering (see Figure 5-2).
MAXIMUM SPACE
⇐ (PULL NUT TO END⇒
OF BODY, BOTH SIDES)
Figure 5-2. Special Adapter Used in Second Converter LO and Bandpass Test Setup
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 300 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz
RESOLUTION BW......................................................................................................... 1 MHz (optimum)
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -30 dBm
002: +20dBmV
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................ 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
Frequency Counter
10 Hz-500 MHz/500 MHz- 18 GHz ................................................................................ 500 MHz- 18 GHz
SAMPLE RATE........................................................................................................ Full counterclockwise
Comb Generator
COMB FREQUENCY ..................................................................................................................... 100MC
INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE ......................................................................................................... OFF
5-13
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
11.
12.
13.
6.
7.
8.
5-17.
SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
2.
3.
4.
at the top of A5 Converter Assembly. Connect comb generator to HP 8558B INPUT.
Adjust second LO FREQUENCY adjustment A5Z4 for 1748.60 40.2 MHz. Use Allen wrench through center of drilled-out 5/16-inch nut driver to enable nut to be tightened without shifting frequency.
Set comb generator for 100 MHz comb.
5.
Center a 100 MHz comb tooth using 8558B TUNING control. Turn FREQ SPAN/DIV control to 2 MHz and uncoupled RESOLUTION BW control to 300 kHz, keeping comb tooth centered on display.
Loosen lock nut on A5Z1 and A5Z2. Carefully turn tuning screws clockwise until they bottom on cavity.
Turn A5Z1 and A5Z2 one turn counterclockwise and lightly tighten lock nuts.
Loosen lock nut on A5Z3, and adjust A5Z3 for peak signal on display. Make final adjustment with Amplitude
Scale switch in LIN position. It might be necessary to increase gain to see signal in linear mode. Leave in LIN position.
9.
10.
Adjust A5Z1 for peak signal on display. Reduce REFERENCE LEVEL as necessary to keep signal on display.
Repeat A5Z1 and A5Z3 adjustments for maximum signal on display.
Adjust A5Z2 for maximum signal on display. Reduce REFERENCE LEVEL as necessary to keep signal on display.
Carefully tighten lock nuts on A5Z1, A5Z2, and A5Z3 so that signal does not change on display.
Adjust A5L2 2nd MIXER MATCH adjustment for maximum signal.
Check second LO frequency. If frequency error is greater than 4i0.5 MHz, repeat step 3.
5-14
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-18.
THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A9 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
The third converter LO frequency is adjusted for maximum output, and power is adjusted for -30 dBm
±
1.0 dB CAL
OUTPUT. The third LO frequency is checked for 280 MHz
±
300 kHz.
002: +20 dBmV
±1.0dB
Figure 5-3. Third Converter LO and CAL OUTPUT Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Amplifier ................................................................................................................................... HP 8447A
Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B
Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A
Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
10 dB Step Attenuator (calibrated at 280 MHz)........................................................... HP 355D, Opt. H82
300 MHz LPF ........................................................................................................... Telonic TLP 300-4AB
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ........................................................................ HP 1250-0780
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Power Sensor, 75
Ω, HP 8483A
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω to 50Ω................................................................................ HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75
Ω ......................................................................................HP 1250-1288
BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in), 75
Ω ....................................................................................... HP 11652-60012
5-15
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
5-18.
THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment as follows:
2.
9.
START- CENTER ....................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ..........................................................................................................................500 kHz
RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL dBm................................................................................................................... -20
002: + 30 dBm V
Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
Signal Generator:
OUTPUT LEVEL ........................................................................................................................ + 10 dBm
FREQUENCY ............................................................................................................................. 280 MHz
AM .................................................................................................................................................... OFF
FM .................................................................................................................................................... OFF
RF ...................................................................................................................................................... ON
COUNTER MODE................................................................................................................................INT
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-3. Connect CAL OUTPUT to INPUT 50( connector.
001 and 002: 75
Ω
Center the 280 MHz signal on the display.
Adjust A9L4 third converter LO FREQ adjustment for maximum signal amplitude.
Tune signal generator to frequency of third converter LO (280 MHz
±
300 kHz).
Connect signal generator through 300 MHz LPF to calibrated step attenuator. Set step attenuator to 10 dB.
Connect power sensor and power meter to step attenuator as shown in Figure 5-3.
Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a 0 dBm full scale reading on power meter. Leave signal generator set at this level.
001: +5.7 dBm
002: + 7.0
Set step attenuator to 40 dB and connect the reference signal set in step 8 (from signal generator through step attenuator) to the 8558B INPUT 50
Ω
connector.
001 and 002: INPUT 75
Ω connector using Minimum Loss Adapter and 75Ω BNC Cable.
5-16
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-18.
THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
10.
11.
12.
Set signal from signal generator to a convenient reference level on display with REFERENCE LEVEL and REF
LEVEL FINE controls.
Disconnect signal generator and connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT to the INPUT 500 connector.
001 and 002: 75
Ω
Adjust A9R5 3RD LO PWR adjustment, accessible from bottom of analyzer through motherboard, to the reference set in step 10. (If range is insufficient on A9R5, change value of factory-selected resistor A9R4*.)
13.
Connect CAL OUTPUT to amplifier input and connect amplifier output to COUNTER INPUT of 8640B. Set HP
8640B COUNTER MODE to EXT EXPAND X10. The third LO frequency should read 280 MHz
±
300 kHz.
5-17
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-19.
SLOPE ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A9 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
An externally leveled signal is applied to the INPUT of the spectrum analyzer. The signal is adjusted across the frequency range of the spectrum analyzer. A9R1 SLOPE COMP is adjusted for best flatness, compensating for first converter conversion loss over frequency.
Figure 5-4. Slope Adjustment Test Setup
5-18
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-19.
SLOPE ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
EQUIPMENT
Sweep Oscillator*...................................................................................................................... HP 8350A
RF Plug-In* ..............................................................................................................................HP 83522A
Power Splitter...........................................................................................................................HP 11667A
Crystal Detector .......................................................................................................................... HP 423B
10-dB Attenuator ........................................................................................................ HP 8491B Opt. 010
Adapter, Type N (m) to Type N (m) ..................................................................................... HP 1250-1475
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................HP 10503A
Type N Cable ...........................................................................................................................HP 11500A
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
*8620C/86222A may be substituted
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 752 to 50
Ω
................................................................................ HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω
..................................................................................... HP 1250-1288
Adapter, Type N (m) to SMA (f)........................................................................................... HP 1250-1250
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment as follows:
2.
Spectrum Analyzer
START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 500 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz
RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -10 dBm
002: +40dBmV
REF LEVEL FINE ................................................................................................................................... 0
Amplitude Scale .......................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
BASELINE CLIPPER ......................................................................................................................... OFF
VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF
Sweep Oscillator
START.......................................................................................................................................... 10 MHz
STOP........................................................................................................................................... 1.5 GHz
SWEEP .............................................................................................................................................MAN
POWER LEVEL .............................................................................................................................. 0 dBm
ALC MODE .........................................................................................................................................EXT
FREQUENCY/TIME .................................................................................................................... 500 MHz
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-4.
5-19
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
8.
9.
6.
7.
5-19.
SLOPE ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
3.
4.
5.
Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to bring signal peak on display.
Set spectrum analyzer START - CENTER to CENTER. Manually tune sweep oscillator for output frequencies from 10 MHz to 1.0 GHz. Set spectrum analyzer START - CENTER to START. Manually tune sweep oscillator for output frequencies from 1.0 GHz to 1.5 GHz.
Using procedure of step 4, locate highest displayed amplitude. Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to bring highest displayed amplitude to fifth CRT graticule line from bottom.
Using procedure of step 4, locate lowest displayed amplitude.
Adjust spectrum analyzer A9R1 SLOPE COMP for minimum difference between highest and lowest displayed amplitudes.
Repeat steps 5, 6, and 7 until no further adjustment is necessary.
With highest displayed amplitude set to fifth graticule line from bottom lowest displayed amplitude should be at or above third graticule line from bottom.
5-20
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
5-20.
SECOND IF BANDPASS AMPLIFIER AND BANDPASS FILTER ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A10 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
Tune bandpass amplifier output and bandpass filter.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 5-5. Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and Bandpass Filter Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780
Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
PROCEDURE
1.
2.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz
RESOLUTION................................................................................................................................. 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .................................................................................................................. - 10 dBm
002: +40 dBmV
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................ 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
Set signal generator frequency to 301.4 MHz and set output level to approximately - 35 dBm.
5-21
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
7.
8.
5-20.
SECOND IF BANDPASS AMPLIFIER AND BANDPASS FILTER ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
NOTE
3.
4.
5.
6.
9.
If 8640B is not used, adjust the signal generator for maximum signal on the display in step 3.
Remove W6P2 from Second IF A10J1. Connect signal generator through test cable to A10J1 as shown in
Figure 5-5.
Adjust bandpass filter capacitors A10C1, A10C2, and A10C3 on Second IF Assembly fully counterclockwise.
Adjust REFERENCE LEVEL if necessary for an on-screen display.
Adjust A10C1 for maximum signal amplitude. Make final adjustment with Amplitude Scale switch in LIN position.
Leave switch in LIN position. Use REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to keep signal on top half of display.
Adjust A10C3 for maximum signal amplitude. There may be a double peak; tune past first peak to second peak.
Signal on display will peak and fall off slightly and then peak again.
Repeat steps 5 and 6 adjusting A10C1 and A10C3 for maximum amplitude.
Adjust A10C2 for maximum signal amplitude. There may be a double peak; tune to second peak. Reduce input signal level to keep signal on display.
NOTE
The following adjustment of A10L2 has very little effect on the signal or performance of the spectrum analyzer. A10L2 need not be adjusted because the position of the core is not critical.
Adjust A10L2 2ND IF TUNING adjustment for maximum signal amplitude. L2 is adjusted through motherboard on bottom of analyzer. Reconnect W6P2 to A10J1.
5-22
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS
REFERENCE
A8, A11, and A13 Schematics
DESCRIPTION
The crystal and LC bandwidth filter circuits are adjusted for symmetry, center, and peak. Three-dB bandwidths are adjusted on the Sweep Generator Assembly A8 (paragraph 5-22).
Figure 5-6. Crystal and LC Bandwidth Filter Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ..........................................................................................................HP 10502A
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in), 75
Ω ................................................................................. HP 11652-60012
NOTE
A crystal short consists of a .01
µF capacitor (HP Part No. 0160-0161) and a 90.9 ohm resistor (HP
Part No. 0757-0400) connected in series. Two square-terminal connectors (HP Part No. 0362-
0265) are used to connect the crystal short across the test points.
5-23
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
3.
4.
Figure 5-7. Crystal Short Configuration
PROCEDURE
1.
NOTE
Allow 30 minutes warmup time before performing adjustments.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START- CENTER ....................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................. 5 kHz
RESOLUTION BW........................................................................................................................... 1 kHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -20 dBm
002: + 30 dBmV
Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ..................................................................................................................... 10 mSEC
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
Crystal Alignment
2.
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-6.
NOTE
If A8 Sweep Generator has been replaced or adjusted, perform steps 3 through 9. If not, proceed to step 10.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz.
Center the signal with TUNING control. Using REF LEVEL FINE control, place signal at 7.1 divisions (0.9
division from top graticule line).
5-24
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
8.
9.
10.
5.
6.
7.
11.
12.
Figure 5-8. Adjusting Crystal Symmetry and Crystal Centering
Adjust A8R85 LC until signal is two divisions wide at the fifth graticule line (1 MH4z. wide at; 3-dB points).
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz.
Using REF LEVEL FINE control, place signal at 7.1 divisions.
Adjust A8R72 XTL until signal is two divisions wide- at the fifth graticule line (10 kHz wide at 3-dB points).
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz.
Center signal with TUNING control. (It might be necessary to increase FREQ SPAN/DIV temporarily to find the signal.) Set REF LEVEL FINE control to place signal at sixth graticule line.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz.
NOTE
A non-metallic tuning tool is required for adjustments on the Al1 and A13 bandwidth filter assemblies.
Connect crystal shorts (through cover access holes) across A13TP1/TP2, A11TP1/TP2, and A11TP4/TP5.
5-25
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Co nt'd)
NOTE
Keep crystal spike centered during adjustments. The SYM and CTR adjustments for each crystal interact.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Adjust front-panel TUNING control to center bandpass spike (Figure 5-8) on the CRT display.
A13C54 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.
Remove crystal short from A13TP1/TP2 and connect it across A13TP4/TP5.
Adjust A13C15 SYM and A13C25 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A13C25 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.
Remove crystal short from A11TP4/TP5 and connect it across A13TP1/TP2.
Adjust A11C38 SYM and A11C54 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A11C54 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.
Remove crystal short from A11TP1/TP2 and connect it across A11TP4/TP5.
Adjust A11C15 SYM and A11C25 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A11C25 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.
21.
Remove the crystal shorts.
LC Alignment
22.
Perform preliminary LC filter adjustments as follows: a. Install A13 on extender board. Set RESOLUTION BW control to 100 kHz.
b. Short to ground the following test points: A13TP6, A11TP3, and A11TP6. Jumper A8TP1 to A8TP2.
c. Adjust A13C73 for minimum signal amplitude.
d. Disconnect short from A13TP6 and short to ground A13TP3.
e. Adjust A13C74 for minimum signal amplitude.
f. Reinstall A13 and install A11 on extender board.
g. Disconnect short from A11TP3 and short to ground A13TP6.
h. Adjust A11C73 for minimum signal amplitude.
i. Disconnect short from A11TP6 and short to ground A11TP3.
5-26
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd) j. Adjust A11C74 for minimum signal amplitude.
k. Disconnect shorts from test points and reinstall A11. Replace covers on A11 and A13 assemblies. Remove jumper from A8TP1/A8TP2.
NOTE
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
When A11 and A13 BW Filter Assemblies are installed with covers in place, midget copper alligator clips (HP Part No. 1400-0483) can be used to short test points to the cover.
Carefully center signal on CRT in 30 kHz RESOLUTION BW; then switch RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Adjust A13C45 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Adjust A13C23 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 KHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
33.
34.
35.
28.
Adjust A11C45 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
29.
30.
31.
Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Adjust A11C23 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.
Switch RESOLUTION BW between 100 kHz and 30 kHz to be sure the signal is centered at both bandwidth settings.
Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Center signal with TUNING control.
32.
Bandwidth Amplitude
Set A11R31 XTL and A13R31 XTL fully counterclockwise.
Set Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV.
Jumper A8TP1 to A8TP2. Short A11TP3, A11TP6, A13TP3, and A13TP6 to ground.
5-27
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
39.
40.
41.
5-21.
CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
36.
37.
38.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 kHz.
Adjust fine TUNING and REF LEVEL FINE for a centered signal at 7 divisions.
Remove shorts from A13TP3 and A13TP6 and center signal with fine TUNING control. Adjust A13R26 LC for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.
Remove shorts from Al1TP3 and Al1TP6. Adjust A11R26 LC for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.
Repeat steps 35 through 39 until no further adjustment is necessary.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz. Center signal with fine TUNING control. Adjust
A11 R31 XTL and Al3R31 XTL equally for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.
NOTE
Each potentiometer should be adjusted to accomplish half the necessary increase in signal amplitude.
42. Remove jumper from A8TP1 and A8TP2.
43. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 100 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz and push in to couple the two controls.
44. Turn coupled controls to set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz. Center signal with
TUNING control. Adjust REF LEVEL FINE for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.
45. With controls coupled, step down RESOLUTION BW from 1 MHz to 300 kHz. Variation in signal amplitude should be less than
±
0.4 dB.
46. Step down RESOLUTION BW from 100 kHz to 1 kHz. Variation of signal amplitude should be less than
±
0.5 dB.
47. Repeat steps 35 through 46 until variation in signal amplitude is within limits.
5-28
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-22.
3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A8 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
The 3-dB bandwidths for the 3 MHz, 1 MHz and 300 kHz RESOLUTION BW settings are adjusted using the CAL
OUTPUT as the signal source. The 3-dB bandwidths for the 10 kHz, 3 kHz, and 1 kHz RESOLUTION BW settings are adjusted by injecting a stable 301.4 MHz signal into the third converter of the spectrum analyzer.
Figure 5-9. 3-dB Bandwidth Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Frequency Counter.................................................................................................................... HP 5343A
10 dB Step Attenuator ................................................................................................................. HP 355D
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ..........................................................................................................HP 10502A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (3 requird).......................................................................... HP 1250-0780
BNC Tee ............................................................................................................................. HP 1250-0781
Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
5-29
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-22.
3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
2.
3.
4.
5.
START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ..........................................................................................................................200 kHz
RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -20 dBm
Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ....................................................................................................................... 1 mSEC
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF
analyzer INPUT 50(.
Set signal level of 7.1 divisions on display with REF LEVEL FINE control. (Signal should be 0.9 division from top graticule line.)
Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz. Adjust A8R85 LC to set bandwidth of 5 divisions at the fifth graticule line.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz. The bandwidth at the fifth graticule line should be between 5.4 and 6.6 divisions.
NOTE
6.
7.
A8R85 LC may be further adjusted to bring the 3 MHz and 300 kHz bandwidths within limits; however, the final measurement of the 1 MHz bandwidth must be between 4.5 and 5.5 divisions at the fifth graticule line. (If the 3 MHz bandwidth cannot be brought within limits by adjustment of
A8R85 LC, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R95*.)
Set RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 5.4 and
6.6 divisions at the fifth graticule line. (If the bandwidth cannot be adjusted within the specified limits, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R89*.)
Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 4.3 and
5.7 divisions at the fifth graticule line.
NOTE
If the 100 kHz bandwidth is not within the specified limits, change the values of factory-selected resistors A13R19*, A13R43*, and A11R43*. If the bandwidth is too wide, increase the value of the resistors; if the bandwidth is too narrow, decrease the value of the resistors. The three factoryselected resistors need not be of equal value, but each must be within one standard value of the others.
5-30
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
18.
19.
20.
12.
13.
14.
5-22.
3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd )
8.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 5.2 and 6.8
divisions at the fifth graticule line.
9.
NOTE
If the 30 kHz bandwidth is not within the specified limits, change the values of factory-selected resistors A11R23*, A11R48*, A13R23*, and A13R48*. If the bandwidth is too wide, decrease the value of the factory selected resistors; if the bandwidth is too narrow, increase the value of the resistors. The four factory-selected resistors need not be of equal value, but each must be within one standard value of the others.
Connect signal generator through the BNC Tee connector to the step attenuator and to the frequency counter as
COUNTER MODE to EXPAND X100.
Remove W7P2 from Third Converter A9J1. Connect step attenuator through test cable to A9J1.
10.
11.
Set HP 8558B RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display (near 301.4
MHz). Adjust the output level of signal generator to place the signal at 7.1 divisions.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.
Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.
15.
16.
17.
Note the counter frequency and tune the signal generator 1500 Hz below the center frequency noted. Record the new counter frequency.
Adjust A8R72 XTL to bring signal level to the fifth graticule line (three divisions from the top graticule line).
Increase signal generator frequency until signal on CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record counter frequency.
Compare new frequency with frequency recorded in step 14. The difference between the two frequencies should be 2800 to 3200 Hz. If the bandwidth is not within limits, repeat steps 12 through 17, slightly readjusting A8R72
XTL, until the specified limits are achieved.
Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.
21.
22.
Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.
Note the counter frequency and tune the signal generator 5 kHz below the center frequency noted. Record the new counter frequency.
Increase the signal generator frequency until the signal on the CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record counter frequency.
Compare new frequency with frequency recorded in step 20. The difference between the two frequencies should be 9.000 kHz to 11.000 kHz.
5-31
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
23.
24.
25.
5-22.
3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
26.
27.
NOTE
A8R72 XTL may be further adjusted to bring the 10 kHz and 1 kHz bandwidths within limits; however, the final measurement of the 3 kHz bandwidth must be between 2700 Hz and 3300 Hz.
(If the 10 kHz bandwidth cannot be brought within limits by adjustment of A8R72 XTL, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R78*.)
Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.
Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.
Note the counter frequency. Increase signal generator frequency until signal on CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record new counter frequency.
Compare new frequency with frequency originally noted in step 25. The difference between the two frequencies should be 450 Hz to 550 Hz.
Reconnect W7P2 to A9J1.
5-32
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-23.
STEP GAIN ASSEMBLY RF GAIN ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A12 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
The RF gain (sensitivity) of the Step Gain assembly is adjusted by injecting a 21.4 MHz signal at A16XA9. The Third
Converter Assembly A9 is removed and replaced with a special extender board for applying the 21.4 MHz signal from the signal generator.
Figure 5-10. Step Gain Assembly RF Gain Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Digital Voltmeter ....................................................................................................................... HP 3455A
Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B
Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A
Adapter, BNC (f) to alligator clips ........................................................................................ HP 8120-1292
Special Extender Board with 51.1-ohm resistor ..............................................HP 08505-60109/0757-0394
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................HP 10503A
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
NOTE
To make special extender board, solder 51.1 ohm resistor from pin 1 to pin 5 of standard extender board, HP Part No. 5060-0257. Leave resistor leads long for easy connection of clip leads.
5-33
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
2.
3.
4.
5-23.
STEP GAIN ASSEMBLY RF GAIN ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................ 1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ...................................................................................................................... 0 dBm
002: + 50 dBmV
REF LEVEL FINE ................................................................................................................................... 0
Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF
Digital Voltmeter
RANGE ............................................................................................................................................AUTO
FUNCTION ..................................................................................................................................DC Volts
TRIGGER ................................................................................................................................ INTERNAL
MATH ................................................................................................................................................ OFF
AUTO CAL.:......................................................................................................................................... ON
Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-10.
5.
6.
Set signal generator frequency to 21.4 MHz. Set OUTPUT LEVEL for approximately - 5 dBm.
Connect output of signal generator across 51.1 ohm resistor on special board using BNC to clip-lead adapter.
The red lead (center conductor) should be connected to pin 5 of extender board.
Set signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on CRT display. Connect output of signal generator to power meter through power sensor and set OUTPUT LEVEL to - 1 dBm. Reconnect signal generator output to clip-lead adapter.
001: -5 dBm
002: - 6 dBm
Adjust A12R4 GAIN adjustment for signal one division from top graticule line. DVM should indicate + 700 mV
±
30 mV. Remove special extender board and replace Third Converter Assembly A9.
NOTE
Front panel VERTICAL GAIN and VERTICAL POSN control settings can affect the voltage measured at A15TP1. Vertical calibration should be checked after adjusting A12R4 for 700 mV.
(Refer to Operator's Check, Section III).
5-34
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-24.
STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS
REFERENCE
A12 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
REF LEVEL FINE, 0 dB, and -12 dB adjustments are properly set and step gains of 10 dB, 20 dB, and 40 dB are adjusted.
Figure 5-11. Step Amplifier Gain Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
1-dB Step Attenuator................................................................................................... HP 355C Opt. H80
10-dB Step Attenuator................................................................................................. HP 355D Opt. H82
Digital Voltmeter ....................................................................................................................... HP 3455A
Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B
Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780
Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001
Adapter, SMC (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................ HP 1250-0827
Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303
5-35
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5.
6.
7.
5-24.
STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set equipment as follows:
2.
3.
4.
TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................ 1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL ...................................................................................................................... 0 dBm
002: + 50 dBm V
Amplitude Scale .......................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN
VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF
13 dBm output to one side of a 1 dB/step attenuator. Connect attenuator output to A9J1 through test cable.
Tune signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on display.
Set step attenuator to 12 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to - 12. Set signal generator level for a signal one division down from top graticule line.
Adjust A12R6 - 12 dB until signal stops rising on display, then adjust A12R6 counterclockwise until signal drops approximately one third to one half of a division.
8.
9.
10.
Set signal generator level so signal is one division down from top graticule line on display.
Set step attenuator to 0 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to 0.
Adjust A12R5 0 dB adjustment for a signal level one division from top graticule line.
Set step attenuator to 12 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to -12. Signal level on display should be
±
0.1 division from the reference one division down from top graticule line. If signal level is out of limits, repeat steps 3 through 8 until the signal level is within limits.
or measure voltage at A15TP1 with digital voltmeter.
NOTE
Be sure all covers in the IF section are secured by at least six screws before proceeding. If covers are left off or not secured by at least six screws, leakage between assemblies may occur.
This leakage causes erroneous adjustment.
Replace 1 dB/step attenuator with 10 dB/step attenuator set to 0 dB. Set REF LEVEL FINE control to 0.
5-36
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-24.
STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
Table 5-5. REF LEVEL FINE Control Check
REF LEVEL
FINE Setting
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
-9
-10
-11
-12
Step Attenuator
Setting (dB
0
1
2
5
6
7
3
4
8
9
10
11
12
Deviation From
Reference
Ref. mV (Ref.)
±
0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
±0.3 Div ±30 mV
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
Connect power sensor and power meter to attenuator output and adjust signal generator output level for a power meter reading of - 13 dBm. Connect test cable from attenuator to A9J1.
Tune signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on the display (near 301.4 MHz).
Set step attenuator to 10 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 10 dBm.
002: +40dBmV
Adjust A12R3 10 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.
Set step attenuator to 20 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 20 dBm.
002: + 30 dBmV
Adjust A12R2 20 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.
Set attenuator to 40 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 40 dBm.
002: +10dBmV
NOTE
Some video filtering might help reduce noise. Set VIDEO FILTER control so noise is reduced, but the signal amplitude remains unchanged.
Adjust A12R1 40 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.
5-37
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-24.
STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont' d)
19.
Check REFERENCE LEVEL control from 0 to - 50 dBm as shown in Table 5-6.
002: + 50 dBmV to 0 dBm V. REFERENCE LEVEL dBmV settings in Table 5-6 are, from top to bottom, + 50,
+ 40, + 30, + 20, + 10, 0.
20.
Reconnect W7P2 to A9JI.
Table 5-6. REFERENCE LEVEL Control Check
REFERENCE LEVEL
(dBm)
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
Attenuator
(dB)
0
10
20
30
40
50
Deviation From
Reference
Reference
±0.2 Div ±20 mV
±0.2 Div ±20 mV
±0.2 Div ±20 mV
±0.2 Div ±20 mV
±0.2 Div ±20 mV
5-38
Model 8558B
5-25. + 19.5V ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A12 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
+ 19.5V for YIG Oscillator is adjusted.
ADJUSTMENTS
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 5-12. +19.5VAdjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Digital Voltmeter........................................................................................................................... HP 3455A
Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clip ........................................................................................... HP 11102A
Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................................HP 5060-0303
PROCEDURE
1. Set Digital Voltmeter as follows:
RANGE .............................................................................................................................................. AUTO
FUCTION ............................................................................................................................................... dcV
AUTO CAL ..............................................................................................................................................ON
TRIGGER....................................................................................................................................INTERNAL
adjustment).
3. Adjust A12R7 + 19.5V adjustment for + 19.5
±
0.1 V.
5-39
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE:
A9, A12, A14, and A15 Schematics
DESCRIPTION
Step attenuators are used to change, in calibrated steps, the input signal level of the spectrum analyzer. The output of
Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15 is monitored, and adjustments are performed to calibrate Log Amplifier
Assembly A14.
Figure 5-13. Log Amplifier and Linear Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B
Digital Voltmeter........................................................................................................................... HP 3455A
10-dB Step Attenuator ................................................................................................... HP 355D, Opt. H82
1-dB Step Attenuator ..................................................................................................... HP 355C, Opt. H80
Adapter, Type N (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................HP 1250-1023
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ...........................................................................HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in)............................................................................................................. HP 18502A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)......................................................................................................... HP 18503A
Cable Assembly, Banana Plug to Alligator Clip........................................................................... HP 11102A
Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m) ......................................................................................... HP 11592-60001
Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................................HP 5060-0303
5-40
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1. Set equipment as follows:
Spectrum Analyzer
FREQ SPAN/DIV .............................................................................................................................. 0
RESOLUTION BW................................................................................................................. 300 kHz
INPUT ATTEN ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-50 dBm
002: 0 dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN
Digital Voltmeter
RANGE ........................................................................................................................................... 10
FUNCTION ................................................................................................................................... dcV
TRIGGER ..........................................................................................................................INTERNAL
MATH .......................................................................................................................................... OFF
AUTO CAL.....................................................................................................................................ON
to 301.4 MHz and OUTPUT LEVEL to -13 dBm. Remove W7 from A9J1. Connect signal generator output through step attenuators and test cable to A9J 1.
NOTE
The HP 355C 10 dB attenuation is included to compensate for the 10 dB of gain on Step Gain
Assembly A12 the TEST-NORM switch is in TEST.
3. Set the TEST-NORM switch on Step Gain Assembly A12 to the TEST position. Tune signal generator frequency for maximum signal amplitude on display with 10 dB step attenuator set to 0 dB. (It may be necessary to reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL slightly.)
4. Disconnect signal generator output from step attenuator. Measure offset at A15TP and record.
mV
5. Connect signal generator to step attenuator and adjust signal generator FINE TUNE control to peak signal on
CRT display.
6. Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL CAL and signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of
800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
7. Set Amplitude Scale to 10 dB/DIV.
8. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (I 1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
5-41
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
9. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 60 dB and adjust A14R10 OFFSET for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 200 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until no further adjustment is necessary.
11. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 30 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 500 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
12. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB and adjust A14R69 - 30 dB for DVM (
±
1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
13. Repeat steps 11 and 12 until no further adjustment is necessary.
14. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 10 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 700 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
15. Set 10-dB step attenuator to O dB and adjust A14R39 - 10 dB for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
16. Repeat steps 14 and 15 until no further adjustment is necessary.
17. Repeat steps 8 through 16 until limits in Table 5-7 are met.
Table 5- 7. Log Fidelity Check
Step Attenuator Setting (dB)
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
DVM Reading*
Ref: 800
±
1 mV
700
±
3 mV
600
±
4 mV
500
±
4 mV
400
±
5 mV
300
±
6 mV
200
±
7 mV
100
±
8 mV
*Plus offset
Linear Output and Linear Step Gain
18. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm
002: 0 dBmV
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN
5-42
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
19. Set 10-dB step attenuator to O dB and adjust A14R34 LIN for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
20. Make adjustments indicated in Table 5-8 .
Table 5-8. Linear Gain Adjustments
Adjustment
A14R34
A14R33
A14R30
A14R27
No Adjustment
*Plus offset
Step Attenuator
0
10
20
30
40
Reference Level
-50 dBm
-60 dBm
-70 dBm
-80 dBm
-90 dBm
DVM Reading*
Ref: 800
±
1 mV
800
±
5 mV
800
±
5 mV
800
±
5 mV
800
±
10 mV
Log Gain
21. Set spectrum analyzer control as follows:
REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm
002: 0 dBmV
Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV
22. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB. Adjust signal generator for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
23. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 40 dB. Set REF LEVEL dBm to -90 and adjust A14R121 LOG GAIN for DVM reading (
±
3 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.
002: - 40 dBmV
24. Check log gain steps according to Table 5-9.
Table 5-9. Log Gain Adjustment Limits
Step Attenuator
0
10
20
30
40
*Plus offset
Reference Level
-50 dBm
-60 dBm
-70 dBm
-80 dBm
-90 dBm
DVM Reading*
Ref: 800 +1 mV
800 +30 mV
800 +30 mV
800 +30 mV
800 +30 mV
5-43
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Error Check (1 dB/DIV)
25. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm
002: 0dBmV
Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 1 dB
26. Set both step attenuators to 0 dB. Reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until signal appears at top of display. Adjust signal generator FINE TUNE to peak trace on display and adjust OUTPUT LEVEL for DVM reading (
±
1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A 5TP 1. Increase attenuation in 1-
dB steps and take DVM readings to check log amplifier output. (Refer to Table 5-10.)
27. Return A12S1 TEST-NORM switch to NORM. Remove test cable and reconnect W7 to A9J1.
Table 5-10. Log Amplifier Output Limits
Step Attenuator
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
DVM Reading*
700
±
10 mV
600
±
20 mV
500
±
30 mV
400
±
30 mV
300
±
30 mV
200
±
30 mV
100
±
30 mV
*Plus offset
5-44
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A8 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
Sweep time per division is adjusted for proper sweep time and 'dead time.'
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 5-14. Sweep Time Per Division Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Oscilloscope........................................................................................................................ HP 1741A
Digital Voltmeter ................................................................................................................. HP 3455A
Timer/Counter ..................................................................................................................... HP 5308A
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ............................................................................................... HP 18503A
Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clips 150 cm (60 in) ........................................................ HP 11002A
Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303
5-45
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1. Set equipment as follows:
Oscilloscope
DISPLAY...........................................................................................................................................A
TRIGGER .........................................................................................................................................A
CHAN A .........................................................................................................................2 VOLTS/DIV
AC-GND-DC .................................................................................................................................. DC
WRITE...........................................................................................................................................ON
TIME/DIV ............................................................................................................................... 2 mSEC
MAG X5 ....................................................................................................................................... OFF
EXT TRIGGER.............................................................................................................................. INT
MODE........................................................................................................................................ MAIN
Digital Voltmeter
RANGE ..................................................................................................................................... AUTO
FUNCTION ................................................................................................................................... dcV
AUTO CAL.....................................................................................................................................ON
TRIGGER ..........................................................................................................................INTERNAL
MATH .......................................................................................................................................... OFF
TIMER/COUNTER
TIME BASE.................................................................................................................................10 µs
FUNCTION ...............................................................................................................................PER B
display mainframe, or to A8TP5 of HP 8558B. Connect digital voltmeter to A8TP6 (located to the left and below
A8TP4.)
3. Adjust A8R7 + 10lOV adjustment for 1OV 40.02 V.
NOTE
The + 10V must be adjusted while analyzer is still cold, during first five minutes after turn-on. If instrument has been operating, turn off mainframe and remove A8 Sweep Generator assembly.
Let A8 assembly cool on bench for 15 minutes. Replace A8 and proceed with adjustment of
A8R7 during the first five minutes after turn on.
4. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 1 ms
SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN
5. Check oscilloscope trace for approximately a - 5V to + 5V ramp.
5-46
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
6. Adjust A8R10 1 ms adjustment for a 10 ms ramp time. Measure dead time of ramp.
MIN.
ACTUAL MAX.
0.25 ms 0.40 ms
7. Set spectrum analyzer SWEEP TIME/DIV to 2 mSEC. Adjust A8R13 2 ms adjustment for a 20 ms ramp time.
Measure dead time of ramp.
MIN.
ACTUAL MAX.
6.0 ms 9.0 ms
8. Set SWEEP TIME/DIV to 1 mSEC. Frequency counter should read sweep time plus dead time (10 ms + dead time 40.05 ms). Adjust A8R10 if necessary to obtain an indication of 10 ms + dead time
±
0.05 ms.
9. Set SWEEP TIME/DIV to 2 mSEC. Frequency counter should read sweep time plus dead time (20 ms + dead time -0.10 ms). Adjust A8R13 if necessary to obtain an indication of 20 ms + dead time
±
0.10 ms.
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until the sweep time plus dead time (dt) for the 1 ms and 2 ms sweeps are within limits.
ACTUAL MIN
10 ms + dt - 0.05 ms
20ms + dt- 0.10ms
MAX.
10 ms + dt + 0.05 ms
20ms + dt + 0.10ms
5-47
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS
REFERENCE
A1 and A7 Schematics
DESCRIPTION
The + 14.5V and REF V voltages are adjusted and the - 10.0V voltage is checked. The frequency limits and linearity of the YIG oscillator are set. The FREQUENCY MHz readout is adjusted for proper voltage calibration and for correct ranging.
Figure 5-15. Frequency Control and DPM Adjustments Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
Digital Voltmeter ................................................................................................................. HP 3455A
Comb Generator ................................................................................................................. HP 8406A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ..................................................................HP 1250-0780
BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ............................................................................................... HP 18503A
Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clips 150 cm (60 in) ........................................................ HP 11002A
Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
Minimum Loss Adapter, 75
Ω
to 50
Ω
.......................................................................... HP 08558-60031
Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75
Ω
..............................................................................HP 1250-1288
Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ..........................................................................................HP 1250-1158
Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m).........................................................................................HP 1250-1200
5-48
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
Voltage Adjustments
and A7R5 + 14.5V adjustments).
2. Adjust A7R5 + 14.5V potentiometer for + 14.50
±
0.02 V.
3. Connect digital voltmeter to A7TP8 (located to the right of A7R5 + 14.5V adjustment) and check for -10.0
±
0.2
V.
4. Connect digital voltmeter to A7TP6 and adjust A7R4 REF V potentiometer for + 6.00
±
0.01 V.
YIG Oscillator Adjustment
NOTE
Check HORIZ GAIN and HORIZ POSN adjustments and perform voltage adjustments before continuing with the following procedure.
5. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
START - CENTER ................................................................................................................CENTER
FREQ SPAN/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 5 MHz
RESOLUTION BW................................................................................................................. 100 kHz
INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-10 dBm
002: +40dBmV
Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN
6. Turn FREQUENCY ZERO control fully counterclockwise.
7. Adjust TUNING for FREQUENCY MHz readout of approximately - 16.0.
NOTE
Press FREQUENCY CAL button to remove YIG oscillator hysteresis whenever the TUNING control is adjusted.
8. Adjust A7R3 2.0 GHZ to center LO feedthrough (within one division) on CRT.
NOTE
Disconnect comb generator whenever it is necessary to center the LO feedthrough.
5-49
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)
9. Couple FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW controls. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 100 MHz/DIV. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to approximately 500 MHz for full-screen display of comb teeth.
10. Adjust TUNING, A7R1 3.55 GHZ, and A7R2 3.55 FINE to align comb teeth on vertical graticule lines (one tooth per division).
11. Repeat steps 7 and 8. (A7R1 3.55 GHZ adjustment has a slight effect on A7R3 2.0 GHZ adjustment.)
12. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz and comb generator frequency to 1 MHz.
13. Adjust TUNING to approximately 750 MHz. Adjust A7R6 FM to align comb teeth on vertical graticule lines (one tooth per division).
Digital Panel Meter Adjustment
14. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz.
15. Center LO feedthrough. Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center LO feedthrough.
16. Adjust FREQUENCY ZERO control for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 00.0.
17. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 1500-MHz tooth (15th tooth from LO feedthrough). Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center comb tooth. Adjust A1A2R3 REF for
FREQUENCY MHz readout of 1500 + 1.
18. Adjust A7R8 RNG fully clockwise. Set comb generator frequency to 10 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 190-MHz comb tooth (19th tooth from LO feedthrough). Adjust A7R7 GAIN for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 190.0.
NOTE
Press FREQUENCY CAL frequently while counting the comb teeth to avoid miscounting.
19. Adjust TUNING for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 198.5. Slowly adjust A7R8 RNG counterclockwise until range switches (no decimal on FREQUENCY MHz display).
20. Center LO feedthrough. Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center LO feedthrough. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 200-MHz comb tooth (second tooth from LO feedthrough).
Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center comb tooth. Adjust A7R72 OFS for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 200.
21. Repeat steps 15 through 21 until 190.0 MHz, 200 MHz, and 1500 MHz readouts on FREQUENCY MHz display are calibrated.
5-50
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-29. 1 dB OFFSET ADJUSTMENT
REFERENCE
A15 Schematic
DESCRIPTION
Reference is set in 10 dB/DIV and 1 dB offset is adjusted in 1 dB/DIV for the same full display reference in 10 dB/DIV.
Figure 5-16. 1-dB Offset Adjustment Test Setup
EQUIPMENT
BNC Cable, 120 cm (9 in) ................................................................................................. HP 18502A
Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) .....................................................................................HP 1250-0780
Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303
Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:
BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in).......................................................................................... HP 11652-60012
PROCEDURE
1. Set Spectrum Analyzer controls as follows:
START - CENTER ................................................................................................................CENTER
TUNING ................................................................................................................................ 280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW.................................................................................................................... 1 MHz
INPUT ATTEN ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-20 dBm
002: +30dBmV
REF LEVEL FINE ..................................................................................................Approximately - 10
Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN
5-51
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
5-29. 1-dB OFFSET ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)
2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-16.
3. Set Amplitude Scale switch to LIN. Set TUNING control to center the trace on the display. Set REF LEVEL
FINE for a full-screen trace (signal at top graticule line).
4. Set Amplitude Scale switch to 10 dB/DIV. Adjust VERTICAL GAIN if necessary for full screen trace.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until the trace is full screen in both LIN and 10 dB/DIV.
NOTE
1 dB/DIV will read approximately 0.5 dB (0.5 division) low when using extender cable assembly.
Adjusting A15Ri 1 dB OFFSET for a trace 0.5 division down from top graticule line should place signal at top graticule line when 8558B is properly installed in 180-series mainframe.
6. Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV. Adjust A15R1 1 dB OFFSET for a trace 0.5 division down from top graticule line.
5-52
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
5-53 through 5-59
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
6-1. INTRODUCTION
SECTION VI.
REPLACEABLE PARTS
6-5.
The following information is listed for each part:
1. The Hewlett-Packard part number 6-2. This section contains information for ordering
replacement parts. Table 6-1 includes a list of reference
designations and a list of abbreviations used in the parts
list. Table 6-2 lists names and addresses that
correspond to the manufacturer code numbers in the
parts list. Table 6-3 lists all replaceable parts in alpha-
numerical order by reference designation.
2. The part number check digit (CD)
3. The total quantity (Qty) in the instrument. This quantity is given only once, at the first appearance of the part in the list.
4. The description of the part
6-3. REPLACEABLE PARTS LIST
6-4. Table 6-3, the list of replaceable parts, is organized
as follows:
5. A five-digit code indicating a typical manufacturer of the part
1. Electrical assemblies and their components in alpha-numerical order by reference designation
6. The manufacturer's part number
6-6. ORDERING INFORMATION
2. Miscellaneous parts, with appropriate electrical parts list assembly
3. Chassis-mounted electrical parts, in alphanumerical order by reference designation
4. Mechanical chassis parts, at end of
6-7. To order a part listed in the replaceable parts table, quote the Hewlett-Packard part number (with check digit), indicate the quantity required, and address the order to the nearest Hewlett-Packard office. The check digit will ensure accurate and timely processing of your order.
6-8. To order a part that is not listed in the replaceable parts table, include the instrument model number, instrument serial number, the description and function of the part, and the number of parts required.
Address the order to the nearest Hewlett-Packard office.
6-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (1 of 3)
A
REFERENCE DESIGNATIONS
A ........................................Assembly
F ............................................... Fuse
AT......... Attenuator, Isolator, Limiter, FL .............................................Filter
Termination H........................................Hardware
B ......................................Fan, Motor HY .....................................Circulator
BT..........................................Battery
J ..... Electrical Connector (Stationary
C........................................Capacitor
Portion), Jack
CP ....................................... Coupler K ..............................................Relay
CR ........Diode, Diode Thyristor, Step L .................................. Coil, Inductor
Recovery Diode (SCR), Varactor M .............................................Meter
DC ...................... Directional Coupler MP ....Miscellaneous Mechanical Part
DL .................................... Delay Line P ........ Electrical Connector (Movable
DS .............Annunciator, Lamp, Light Portion), Plug
Emitting Diode (LED), Signaling
Device (Audible or Visible
Q ............ Silicon Controlled Rectifier
(SCR), Transistor, Triode Thyristor
E .......... Miscellaneous Electrical Part R.......................................... Resistor
ABBREVIATIONS
D
A .................Across Flats, Acrylic, Air D................. Deep, Depletion, Depth,
(Dry Method), Ampere Diameter, Direct Current
ADJ..................... Adjust, Adjustment DA ....................................Darlington
ANSI .................... American National DAP-GL .........Diallyl Phthalate Glass
Standards Institute (formerly DBL .......................................Double
USASI-ASA) DCDR ..................................Decoder
ASSY .................................Assembly
DEG...................................... Degree
AWG................ American Wire Gage D-HOLE .................... D-Shaped Hole
DIA .................................... Diameter
B
DIP ................. Dual In-Line Package
DIP-SLDR ........................ Dip Solder
D-MODE .................. Depletion Mode
BCD ...............Binary Coded Decimal DO .......... Package Type Designation
BD ............... Deep, Depth, Diametric DP ............... Deep, Depth, Diametric
BE-CU ...................Beryllium Copper Pitch, Dip
BNC ..................... Type of Connector DP3TMINTR ........Double Pole Three
BRG..........................Bearing, Boring Throw, Miniature
BRS ......................................... Brass DPDTMINTR......Double Pole Double
BSC ......................................... Basic Throw, Miniature
BTN ........................................Button
DWL ....................................... Dowel
C E
E-R ........................................ E-Ring
C............... Capacitance, Capacitore, EXT .................Extended, Extension,
Center Tapped, Centistoke,
Cermet, Circular Mil Foot, Closed
External, Extinguish
Cup, Cold, Compression F
CCP .......Carbon Composition Plastic
CD .......................... Cadmium, Card, F ............ Fahrenheit, Farad, Female,
Cold-Drawn, Cord
CER .....................................Ceramic
Film (Resistor), Fixed, Flange,
Flint, Fluorine, Frequency
CHAM ................................. Chamfer FC.......... Carbon Film / Composition,
CHAR .............................. Character, Edge of Cutoff Frequency, Face
Characteristic, Charcoal FDTHRU ..................... Feed Through
CMOS............ Complementary Metal FEM...................................... Female
Oxide Semiconductor FIL-HD ......................... Fillister Head
CNDCT ...... Conducting, Conductive, FL ...........................Flash, Flat, Fluid
Conductivity, Conductor FLAT-PT ............................Flat Point
CONT .............. Contact, Continuous, FR.............................................Front
Control, Controller FREQ .............................. Frequency
CONV ............................... Converter FT ................Current Gain Bandwidth
CPRSN ........................ Compression Product (Transition Frequency);
CUP-PT ............................ Cup Point Feet, Foot
CW ..... Clockwise, Continuous Wave FXD ......................................... Fixed
RT .............................. Thermistor
S........................................ Switch
T ............................... Transformer
TB........................ Terminal Board
TC ......................... Thermocouple
TP................................ Test Point
U....Integrated Circuit, Microcircuit
V............................ Electron Tube
VR ....... Breakdown Diode(Zener),
Voltage Regulator
W. Cable, Transmission Path, wire
X........................................Socket
Y......... Crystal Unit (Piezoelectric,
Quartz)
Z .......Tuned Cavity, Tuned Circuit
GEN .............. General, Generator
GND .................................Ground
GP ......... General Purpose, Group
H............... Henry, Hermaphrodite,
High, Hole Diameter, Hot, Hub
Inside Diameter, Hydrogen
HDW........................... Hardware .
HEX ........ Hexadecimal, Hexagon,
Hexagonal
HLCL .................................Helical
HP .....Hewlett-Packard Company,
High Pass, Horsepower
I
H
IC......................Collector Current,
Integrated Circuit
ID... Identification, Inside Diameter
IF ....................... Forward Current,
Intermediate Frequency
IN.............................. Inch, indium
INCL .............................. Including
INT ...... Integral, Intensity, Internal
INTL ........... Internal, International
Transistor
Transistor
J
J-FET .......... Junction Field Effect
JFET............ Junction Field Effect
K
G
K...... Kelvin, Key, Kilo, Potassium
KNRLD ............................ Knurled
KVDC ...... Kilovolts Direct Current
6-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (2 of 3)
L PAN-HD ............................ Pan Head
PAR ........................... Parallel, Parity
LED................... Light Emitting Diode PB............ Lead (Metal), Push Button
LG................................ Length, Long PC .................... Picocoulomb, Piece,
LIN ..... Linear, Linear Taper, Linearity Printed Circuit ..............................
LK ..................................... Link, Lock PCB ................. Printed Circuit Board
LKG ...................... Leakage, Locking P-CHAN ........................... P-Channel
LOGO ................................ Logotype PD .................. Pad, Palladium, Pitch
LUM ...................................Luminous
Diameter, Power Dissipation
PF............... Picofarad; Pipe, Female
M Connection; Power Factor
PKG.................................... Package
M .......... Male, Maximum, Mega, Mil, PLSTC ................................... Plastic
Milli, Mode, Momentary, PNL .........................................Panel
Mounting Hole Centers, Mounting ..................................................PNP
Tapping
Hole Diameter Positive (Transistor)
MA ..................................Milliampere
POLYC ...................... Polycarbonate
MACH ................................Machined
POLYE............................... Polyester
MAX.................................. Maximum POT ............................ Potentiometer
MC ..................... Hot Molded Carbon POZI ........................Pozidriv Recess
Composition, Megacycle, PREC................................. Precision
PRP .........................Purple, Purpose Microcircuit, Molded Carbon
Composition PSTN ...................................... Piston
MET .......................... Metal, Metallic, PT..................... Part, Pint, Platinum,
Metallized, Metallurgical Point, Pulse Time
MHZ................................. Megahertz PW ..Power Wirewound, Pulse Width
MIT ...........................................Miter
MLD .............................Mold, Molded
Q
Q ............................... Figure of Merit
MM ................... Magnetized Material
(Restricted Articles Code);
Millimeter
MOM............................... Momentary
MTG .................................. Mounting
MTLC....................................Metallic
R
MUW .............................. Music Wire
MW ...................................... Milliwatt R................ Range, Red, Resistance,
N
Resistor, Right, Ring, Rosin,
Rubber-Resin, Run Torque
REF ..................................Reference
RES . Research, Resistance, Resistor
N..................Fan Out, Intrinsic Stand RF.......................... Radio Frequency
Off Ratio, Nano, Nanosecond,
Nitrogen, None
RGD .........................................Rigid
RND........................................Round
N-CHAN........................... N-Channel RR ............................................ Rear
NH ...................................Nanohenry
RVT ............................Rivet, Riveted
NMH ............ Nanometer Nonmetallic S
NO ..............Normally Open, Number
NOM ....................................Nominal
NPN ...................... Negative Positive
Negative (Transistor)
NS Nanosecond, Non-Shorting, Nose
SAWR.......... Surface Acoustic Wave
Resonator
NUM ..................Numeric, Numerical SEG....................................Segment
NYL...................... Nylon (Polyamide) SGL ........................................ Single
SI .......................Silicon, Square Inch
O SL ................................... Slide, Slow
SLT......................Slate, Slot, Slotted
OA .......................... Other Restricted SMA................ Subminiature, A Type
Articles, Group A (Restricted
Articles Code); Over-All
OD ......Olive Drab, Outside Diameter
(Threaded Connector)
SMC ...............Subminiature, C Type
(Threaded Connector)
OP AMP...........Operational Amplifier SPCG .................................. Spacing
OPT ........... Optical, Option, Optional SPDTSUBMIN .... Single Pole Double
Throw, Subminiature
P
PA...................... Picoampere, Power SST ...........................Stainless Steel
Amplifier, Pressure Angle,
Protactinium
SPST .........Single Pole Single Throw
SQ .........................................Square
STL...........................................Steel
SZ.............................................. Size
T
T ........... Tab Width, Taper, Teeth,
Temperature, Tera, Tesla,
Thermoplastic (Insulation),
Thickness, Time, Timed, Tooth,
Turns Ratio, Typical
TA............. Ambient Temperature,
Tantalum
TC ......................... Thermoplastic
THD ................. Thread, Threaded
THK .....................................Thick
TO .....Package Type Designation,
Troy Ounce
Positive Negative.................. TPG
TR-HD ....................... Truss Head
TRMR ............................. Trimmer
TRN ........................... Turn, Turns
TRSN................................Torsion
U
UCD........................ Microcandela
UF ...............................Microfarad
UH .............................. Microhenry
UL............Microliter, Underwriters'
Laboratories, Inc.
UNHDND .................. Unhardened
V
V........Vanadium, Variable, Violet,
Volt, Voltage
VAC ......................Vacuum; Volts,
Alternating Current
VAC/DC ...... Volts, Alternating and
Direct Current
VAR ................................ Variable
VDC..............Volts, Direct Current
W
W.............. Watt, Wattage, White,
Wide, Width, Wire
W/CP.... Wire / Conductive Plastic
W/SW........................With Switch
WW ..........................Wire Wound
X
X...... By (Used With Dimensions),
Reactance
XSTR............................Transistor
Y
YIG ................. Yttrium-ron-Garnet
Z
ZNR .................................... Zener
6-3
Model 8558B
Abbreviation f a n p c m
,U
T
G
M k da d
Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (3 of 3)
MULTIPLIERS
Prefix tera giga mega kilo deka deci centi milli micro nano pico femto atto
Table 6-2. Manufacturers Code List
Multiple
10
12
10
9
10
6
10
3
10
10
-1
10
-2
10
-3
10
-6
10
-9
10
-12
10
-15
10
-18
Mfr.
No.
24046
24546
28480
3L585
30983
33095
52763
56289
71041
72136
72982
74970
78707
9N171
92830
00000
01121
01295
02111
02660
03888
04713
06665
11236
13606
18736
19701
Manufacturer Name
ANY SATISFACTORY SUPPLIER
ALLEN-BRADLEY CO
TEXAS INSTR INC SEMICOND CMPNT DIV
SPECTROL ELECTRONICS CORP
BUNKER RAMO CORP AMPHENOL CONN DIV
K D I PYROFILM CORP
MOTOROLA SEMICONDUCTOR PRODUCTS
PRECISION MONOLITHICS INC
CTS OF BERNE INC
SPRAGUE ELECT CO SEMICONDUCTOR DIV
VOLTRONICS CORP
MEPCO/ELECTRA CORP
TRANSITRON ELECTRONIC CORP
CORNING GLASS WORKS (BRADFORD)
HEWLETT-PACKARD CO CORPORATE HQ
RCA CORP SOLID STATE DIV
MEPCO/ELECTRIC CORP
SPECTRUM CONTROL INC
STETTNER-TRUSH INC
SPRAGUE ELECTRIC CO
BOSTON GEAR WKS DIV OF NA ROCKWELL
ELECTRO MOTIVE CORP
ERIE TECHNOLOGICAL PRODUCTS INC
JOHNSON E F CO
TEK BEARING CO INC
UNITRODE COMPUTER PRODUCTS CORP
ASSOCIATED SPRING CORP
6-4
Address
MILWAUKEE, WI
DALLAS, TX
CITY OF IND, CA
BROADVILLE, IL
WHIPPANY, NJ
PHOENIX, AZ
SANTA CLARA, CA
BERNE, IN
CONCORD, NH
HANOVER, NJ
MINERAL WELLS; TX
WAKEFIELD, MA
BRADFORD, PA
PALO ALTO, CA
SOMERVILLE, NJ
SAN DIEGO, CA
FAIRVIEW, PA
CAZENOVIA, NY
NORTH ADAMS, MA
QUINCY, MA
FLORENCE, SC
ERIE, PA
WASECA, MN
NEW YORK, NY
METHUEN, MA
BRISTOL, CT
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Zip Codes
92121
16415
13035
01247
02171
06226
16512
56093
10013
06010
53204
75222
91745
60153
07981
85008
95050
46711
03301
07936
76067
01880
16701
94304
A2R1
A2R2
A2R3
A2R4
A2R5
A2R6
A2S1
A2S2
A1A2Q1
A1A2Q2
A1A2Q3
A1A2Q4
A1A2R1
A1A2R2
A1A2R3
A1A2R4
A1A2R5
A1A2R6
A1A2R7
A1A2R8
A1A2R9
A1A2R10
A1A2R11
A1A2R12
A1A2R13
A1A2R14
A1A2TP1
A1A2TP2
A1A2TP3
A1A2U1
A1A2U2
A1A2U3
A1A2U4
A1A2VR1
A1A2VR2
A1A2C1 THRU
A1A2C3
A1A2C4
A1A2C5 THRU
A1A2C9
A1A2C10
A1A2C11
A1A2CI2
A1A2C13
A1A2C14
A1A2C15
A1A2C16
A1A2CR1
A1A2CR2
A1A2CR3
A1A2J1
A1A2L1
A2
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A1
A1A1
A1A2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number
08558-60125
0180-0197
0160-4084
0160-4084
0180-0197
0160-0168
0180-2207
0160-4084
1901-0040
1901-0050
1200-0508
9100-1644
1854-0404
1854-0404
0757-0465
0757-0420
2100-1702
0698-3446
0757-0442
0698-3260
0698-3457
0698-3439
0757-0442
0757-0416
0757-0442
0757-0458
0757-0458
0757-0317
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
1826-0431
1858-0047
1820-1413
1810-0346
1902-0064
08558-60100
2100-3593
2100-.3452
2100-3066
2100-0542
2100-3973
2100-3973
3101-0044
2100-3973
D
1
8
1
2
7
7
9
7
0
0
0
4
5
2
7
9
6
4
9
7
6
3
7
3
9
0
0
0
1
8
8
8
8
1
8
0
3
1
3
1
5
8
8
8
8
Qty
1
2
18
11
35
27
7
1
3
5
1
1
1
29
27
1
1
6
13
1
1
1 t
2
Description
DIGITAL PANEL METER ASSEMBLY
NOT ASSIGNED
DPM DRIVER ASSEMBLY
NOTE
SEE A2 FOR DPM DISPLAY
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD 2,2UF+-10X 20VDC TA
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-10% 200VODC POLYE
CAPACITOR-FXD 100UF +-10% 10VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD , 1UF +-20X 50VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
SOCKET-IC 14-CONT DIP-SLDR
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 330UH 5% .2DX.45L.G
NOT ASSIGNED
NOT ASSIGNED
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 100 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN
RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1OO
RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 178 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10OK 1%X 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-O00
RESISTOR 51.1K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
IC CONV 24-DIP- C PKG
TRANSISTOR ARRAY 16-PIN PLSTC DIP
IC DCDR CMOS BCD-TO-7-SEG 4-TO-7-LINE
NETWORK-RES 16-DIP080.0 OHM X S
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-ZNR 7.5V 5% DO-35 PD=,4W TC=+.05X
Mfr.
Code
28480
56289
1
1
3
1
1
1
1
FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(ELECTRICAL PARTS)
NOTE
SEE FIGURE 6-3 FOR COMPLETE IDENT-
IFICATION OF FRONT SW. ASSY PARTS.
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%
(COARSE TUNE)
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-.TRN 10K 10%
(FINE TINE)
RESISTOR-VAR PREC WW 10-TRN 5K 5%
(FREQ. ZERO)
RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN
(RF LVL FINE)
RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW
(VIDEO FILTER)
RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW
(VIDEO FILTER)
SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN
(FREQ. CAL)
RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW
P/O A2RS/R6/52(MAX VIDEO FILTER)
28480
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-5
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
24546
24546
02660
24546
24546
28480
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
00000
00000
00000
04713
13606
3L585
11236
28480
28480
28480
56289
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
08558-60125
150D225X9020A2
0160-4084
0160-4084
150D225X9020A2
0160-0168
150D107X9010R2
0160-4084
1901-0040
1901-0050
1200-0508
9100-1644
1854-0404
1854-0404
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
3810P-101
C4-1/8-TO-383R-.F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
0698-3260
0698-3457
C4-1/8-TO-178R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/B-TO-5112-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
C4--1/8-TO-1331-F
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
MC14433L
ULN-2003A
CD45118E
761-3-RI80
1902-0064
0855860100
2100-3593
2100-3452
2100-3066
2100-0542
2100-3973
2100-3973
3101-0044
2100-3973
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A2A1
A2A1CR1
A2A1CR2
A2A1DS1
A2A1DS2
A2A1DS3
A2A1DS4
A2A1D55
A2A1R1
A2A1R2
A2A1R3
A21AR4
A2A1R5
A2A1R6
A2A1R7
A2A1R8
A2A1S1
A2A1S2
A2A1S3
A2A1S4
A2A1S5
A2A1S6
A2A1S7
A21AW1
A2A1W2
A2A1XDS1
A2A1XDS2
A2A1XDS3
A2A1XDS4
A2A1XDS5
A3
A4
A4J1
A4J2
A4J3
A4J4
A4MP1
A4HP2
A4MP3
A4R0
A4R2
64R3
64R4
A4R5
A4U1
A5
A5C1
A5C2
A5C3
A5C4
A5CR1
A5J1
A5J2
A5J3
A5L1
A5L2
A5L3
A5L4
A5L5
A5MP1
A5MP2
A5MP3
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
08558-60160
1901-0025
1902-0064
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0485
0757-0447
2100-3340
2100-2681
2100-3332
0757-0444
2100-1412
2100-3331
0757-0317
6
2
7
3
1
3
3
5
4
1
7
4
2
7
7
7
1
1
8
0
17
1
1
1
1
2
6
3101-2213 0 1
3101-2124 2
018558-60168 2
08558-60037
1990-0619
4
7
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0485
5086-7363
08495-60004
7
5
7
7
9
9
08558-60004 5
1250-1020 8
1250-1020
1250--1020
8
8
1250-1020 8
0E8558-00052 7
08558--20042 7
08558-20043 8
0698-7212
0698-7221
0698-7216
0698-7202
0698-7216
08550-60152
3
4
08558-60097 6
0160-3036
0160-3036
8
8
3
7
9
0
0160-4959
0140-0075
1901-0950
1250-1157
1250-1435
1250-0829
9100-2255
08558-80009
08550-00034
08558-00033
08558-00033
08558-20122
9
3
4
2
2
2
6
7
4
4
5
4
08558-20121 3
1
1
6
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
0
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
Description
Mfr.
Code
SWITCH BOARD ASSEMBLY
DIODE-GEN PRP 1OOV 200MA DO-7
DIODE-ZNR 7.5V 5% 0DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.05%
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-.NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3--H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
LED-LAMP LUM-INT=8OOUCD IF=3OMA-MAX
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL CCP 1K 20% LIN
RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% CCP TOP-ADJ I-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR o10K 20% CC TOP-ADS 1-TRN
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 20% CCP TOP-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 20% MC TOP-ADJ 1-TRN
28480
28480
20480
20480
28480
28480
28480
28480
24546
28480
28480
28480
24546
28480
28480
24546 RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
(REF LEVEL DOM) SEE FIGURE 6-3.
SWITCH-PB DPDT(AMPLITUDE SCALE)
(SWEEP TIME/DIV) SEE FIGURE 6-3.
(SWEEP TRIGGER) SEE FIGURE 6-3.
(RESOLUTION BW) SEE FIGURE 6-3.
(FREQ SPAN/DIV) SEE FIGURE 6-3.
SWITCH-PB DPDT (START/CENTER)
RIBBON CABLE ASSY-DPM
28480
RIBBON CABLE ASSY-INTERCONNECT
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG I-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-HUM-SEC i-CHAR .3--H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
LED-LAMP LUM-INT=800UCD IF=30MA-MAX
INPUT ATTENUATOR
RESTORED 08558-60003,EXCHANGE REQUIRED
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
FIRST CONVERTER 28480
CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480
CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480
CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEN SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480
CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-'HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480
GASKET, FIRST CONVERTER 28480
COVER, FIRST CONVERTER
MOUNT, FIRST CONVERTER
28480
28480
RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 38.3 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .85W F TC=0+-100
FIRST MIXER DIODE ASSEMBLY
SECOND-CONVERTER
CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 5000PF +80 -20% 200V
CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 5000PF 0SO -20% 200V
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 10PF 5% 200V CER
CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 22PF 10% 500V MICA
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM THD-HOLE 50-OlIM
CONN: RF: 500 OHM: SMC
CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 47ONH 10% .185DX.26LC
COIL, SECOND CONVERTER
COUPLING LOOP, INPUT
COUPLING LOOP, FILTER
COUPLING LOOP, FILTER
OSCILLATOR HOUSING/SECOND CONV. COVER
MATCHED> TO ASFMP2NOT SEPARATELY REPLA
CAVITY BLOCK, SECOND CONVERTER
MATCHED TO A5MP1;NOT SEPARATELY REPLACE
NOT ASSIGNED
33095
72982
28410
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
08558-60160
1901-0025
1902-0064
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0485
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
2100-3340
2100-2681
2100-3332
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
2100-1412
2100-3331
C4-1/8-TO-1331-F
3101-2213
3101-2124
08558-60168
08558-60037
1990-0819
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0485
5086-7363
08495-60004
08558-60004
1250-1020
1250-1020
1250-1020
1250-1020
08558-00052
08558-20042
08558-20043
C3-1/8-TO-100R-F
C3-1/8-TO-237R-F
C3-1/8-TO-147R-F
C3-1/8-TO-30R3-F
C3-1/8-TO-147R-F
08558-60152
0855800097
0160-3036
0160-3036
54-713-002-XSE-100J
666-053-0160-220K
1901-0950
1250-1157
1250-1435
1250-0829
9100-2255
08558-80009
08558-00034
08558-00033
08558-00033
08558-20122
08558-20121
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-6
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A7
A7C1
A7C2
A7C3
A7C4
A7C5
A7C6
A7C7
A7C8
A7C9
A7C10
A7C11
A7C12
A7C13
A7C14
A7CR1
A7CR2
A5MP4
A5MP5'
A5MP6
A5MP7 THRU
A5MP10
A5MP11
A5MP12THRU
A5MP17
A5MP18
A5MP19THRU
A5MP22
A5MP23
A5MP24
ASMP25
A5R1
A5A1
A5A1Q1
A5A1R1
A5A1R2
A6
A6MP1
A6MP2
A6MP3
A6MP4
A6MP5 THRU
A6MP7
A7CR3
A7CR4
A7CR5
A7CR6
A7CR7
A7CR8
A7CR9
A7L1
A7L2
A7MP1
A7MP2
A7MP3
A7MP4
A7MP5 THRU
A7MP8
A7MP9 THRU
A7MP12
A7MP13THRU
A7MP16
A7Q1
A7Q2
A7Q3
A7Q4
A7Q5
A7Q6
A7Q7
A7Q8
A7Q9
A7Q10
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
1901--0040
08558-80011
08558-80011
1205-0002
1205-0002
1205-0002
08558-00007
0520-0129
0610-0001
2190-0014
1854-0039
1853-0451
1854-0023
1855-0417
1854-0039
1854-0023
1854-0475
1853-0012
1854-0882
1853-0007
3030-0397
0380-0573
0516-0041
2200-0151
2740-0001
08565-20068
08565-20069
08565-20092
0757-0346
08558-60028
5086-4218
0683-4705
0683-2715
5086-7080
08558-00008
08558-00008
08558-00076
08558-20118
686558-20119 9
08558-60126 2
0180-1746
0180-1746
5
5
0160-3466
0180-0197
0160-3094
0160-3457
0160-3094
0180-0197
0180-1745
0160-3466
0160-2055
8
9
8
4
8
7
8
8
8
0160-2055
0180-1714
0180-1714
1901-0040
1901-0535
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
7
1
9
9
7
3
3
1
1
3
5
8
3
3
6
7
2
3
7
8
7
6
3
6
6
8
4
0
8
6
9
9
2
6
9
1
6
5
9
1
7
7
7
9
8
7
5
4
HP Part C
Number D Qty
08558-20074 5
085513-00032 3
08558-20120 2
1
1
1
1
1
3
1
2
30
1
2
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
2
4
1
6
1
3
4
4
12
2
3
3
1
4
26
1
4
4
3
2
4
6
4
1
98
3
Description
INSULATOR, COUPLING POST
MOUNTING, MIXER DIODE
COVER, OSCILLATOR
SCREW-SET 10-32 1-IN-LG FLAT-PT BRS
STANDOFF-HEX .625-IN-LG 10-32THD
SCREW-MACH 0-80 .125-IN-LG FIL-HD-SLT
SCREW-MACH 4-40 ,75-IN-LG PAN-ND-POZI
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 10-32-THD .109-IN-THK
CAPACITOR, INNER ELEMENT
CAPACITOR, OUTER ELEMENT
CAPACITOR, DIELECTRIC
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
SECOND CONVERTER OSCILLATOR
TRANSISTOR, NPN, MICROWAVE
RESISTOR 47 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500
RESISTOR 270 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+600
OSCILLATOR, YIG (DOES NOT INCL MTG. HDW}
YIG BRACKET
YIG BRACKET
STRAP, YIG OSCILLATOR
STANDOFF, NOTCHED
STANDOFF, PLAIN
FREQUENCY CONTROL
CAPACITOR-FXD 15lF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 15UF+--10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR--FXD 2,216F+-10% 2OVDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 10VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 200RPF +-10% 250VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 1IRVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2,21UF+-1O% 2OVDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 1,SUF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD ,.01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V SOMA 2NS 0D-35
DIODE-SM SIC SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 2ODMA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 8OV I00MA 2NS D0-35
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
COIL, 100 UH
COIL, 100 UH
HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS
HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS
HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS
HEAT SINK, YIG DRIVE
SCREW-MACH 2-56 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 2-56-THD .062-IN-THK
WASHER-LK INTL T NO. 2 .089-IN-ID
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30536 SI TO-39 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-8IS PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-.FET N--CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2904A SI TO-39 PD=600MW
TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=20OMHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
20480
00000
00000
00000
00000
26480
56289
56289
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
56289
56289
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
56289
56289
28480
20480
00000
28480
28480
28480
24546
28480
28480
01121
01121
28480
28480
28480
28480
28460
28480
26480
28460
28480
28480
28480
28430
00000
00000
20480
3L585
01295
28486
26480
3L585
28480
28480
01295
28480
04713
Mfr Part Number
08558-20074
08558-00032
08558-20120
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
08565-20068
08565-20069
08565-20092
C4-1/8-TR-10R0-F
08558-60028
5086-4218
CB4705
C82715
5086-7080
08558-00008
08558-00008
08558-00076
08558-20118
08558-20119
08558R0126
150D156X9020812
150D156X902082
0160-3466
150D225X9020A2
0160-3094
0160-3457
0160-3094
1500225X9020A2
150D155X9020A2
0160-3466
0160-2055
0160-2055
150D337X9006S2
156B337X9006S2
1901-0040
1901-0535
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0040
08558-80011
08558-80011
1205-0002
1205-0002
1205-0002
08558-00007
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
2190-0014
2N3053S
2N3799
1854-0023
1855-0417
2N3053S
1854-0023
1854-0475
2N2904A
1854-0882
2N3251
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-7
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A7R10
A7R11
A7R12
A7R13
A7R14
A7R15
A7R16
A7R17
A7R18
A7R19
A7R20
A7R21
A7R22
A7R23
A7R24
A7R25
47R26
A7R27
A7R28
A7R29
A7R30
A7R31
A7R32
A7R33
A7R34
A7R1
A7R2
A7R3
A7R4
A7R5
A7R6
A7R7
A7R8
A7R9
A7Q11
A7Q12
A7Q13
47Q14
A7Q15
A7Q16
A7Q17
A7Q18
A7Q19
A7Q20
A7Q21
A7Q22
A7Q23
A7Q24
A7Q25
A7R35
A7R36
A7R37
A7R38
A7R39
A7R40
A7R41
A7R42
A7R43
A7R44
A7R45
A7R46
A7R47
A7R48
A7R49
A7R50
A7R51
A7R52
A7R53
A7R54
A7R55
A7R56
A7R57
A7R58
A7R59
A7R60
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0757-0317
0757-0465
0683-1555
0757-0280
0757-0465
0757-0465
0757-0424
0757-0274
069B-3151
0683-1555
0757-0438
0698-3458
0757-0465
0683-1555
0698-3458
0757-0465
0757-0438
0698-0083
0698-3153
0698-3151
06B3-1555
0683-1555
0757-0280
0698-3153
0757-0290
1854-0882
1854-0039
1853-0007
1853-0007
1855-0062
1855-0062
1854-0404
1853-0007
1855-0420
1855-0062
1B54-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1855-0062
1854-0404
2100-1754
2100-1760
2100-1754
2100-1757
2100-1757
2100-1756
2100-3123
2100-3123
0698-3458
0698-3154
0698-3458
0698-3156
0698-3453
0757-0401
0698-3458
0757-0470
0698-3160
0757-0470
0757-0401
0757-0401
0757-0290
0757-0199
0698-3151
0698-6271
0698-6315
0683-1555
0698-7799
0698-8323
0698-3458
0698-3438
0698-3162
0757-0317
0757-0290
0757-0279
0698-3153
6
0
7
6
3
7
7
0
6
6
7
5
0
3
7
6
3
9
5
0
0
9
7
3
8
0
0
5
0
8
0
7
2
7
7
8
7
8
8
0
0
0
7
2
1
9
2
9
7
3
7
8
1
0
5
3
0
0
7
3
8
2
2
0
7
7
5
0
9
3
0
5
7
0
7
HP Part C
Number D Qty Description
5
1
2
1
4
1
4
6
6
23
6
11
2
1
19
2
4
1
1
1
1
3
5
22
TRANSISTOR NPN PD=30OMNW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30535 SI TO-39 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NMW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET 2N4391 N-CHAN D-MODE
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360HW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360hW
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 5% WW SIDE-ADS 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 200 5% WW SIDE-ADJ I-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17--TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10OK 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.5N 5% .25W FC TC=.-900/+1100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.50 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 5.111K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F T 0=D+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=+-100
RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.5N 5% .25W FC 'TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=2+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=2+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.22K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=D+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=2+-100
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100
RESISTOR 162K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 162K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1 00
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-800
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.B7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3K .1% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 503.1 .12X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-800/+1100
RESISTOR 2K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.76K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC= 0-1100
RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .12 5W F -TC=0+-10
RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .15W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-8
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Mfr.
Code
24546
24546
01121
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
01121
24546
28480
24546
01121
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
01121
01121
24546
24546
19701
20480
3L585
04713
04713
28480
20480
28480
04713
01295
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
02111
02111
28480
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
28480
03888
01121
19701
19701
28480
84546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
Mfr Part Number
1854-0882
2N3053S
2N3251
2N3251
1855-0062
1855-0062
1854-0404
2N3251
2N4391
1855-0062
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1855-0062
1854-0404
2100-1754
2100-1760
2100-1754
2100-1757
2100-1757
2100-1756
43P501
43P501
0698-3450
C4-1/8-TO-1331-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
CS1555
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003--F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101.-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
C81555
C4-1/8-TO-5111-F
0698-3450
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C155
0698-5458
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-5111-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
C4--1/8-TO-2871-F
CB1555
C81555
C4-1/S-TO-1001 -F
C4-.1/8-TO-3831-F
MF4CI/8-TO-6191 -F
C4-1/8-TO-4221-F
0698-3458
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-10-1963-F
C4-1/S-TO-101-F
06?98-2458
C4-1/8-TO-1623.-F
C4--1/8-TO-3162-F
C4- 1/8--1T623--F
84-1/8-TO-101 F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
1/8-0-191-F
C42/8-1-1--F
C4-01/8-0-2871-F
0698-6271
PME55-1/8-TO-503R1-C
C81555
NF4C1/8-10-2001-C
MF4C1/8-T2-2761-C
0698-345 8
C4-1/8-TO-147R-F
C4-1/8-TO-4642-F
C4-1/8-TO-1331-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A7VR1
A7VR2
A7VR3
A8
A8C1
A8C2
A8C3
A8C4
A8C5
A8C6
A8C7
A8C8
A8C9
A8C10
A8C11
A8C12
A8C13
A7R61
A7R62
A7R63
A7R64
A7R65
A7R66
A7R67
A7R68
A7R69
A7R70
A7R71
A7R72
A7R73
A7R74
A7R75
A7R76
A7R77
A7R78
A7R79
A7TP1 THRU
A7TP19**
A7U1
A7U2THRU
A7U4
A7U5
A7U6
A8C14
A8C15
A8C16
A8C17
A8C18
A8C19
A8C20
A8C21
A8C22
A8C23
A8C24
A8C25
A8C26
A8C27
A8CR1
A8CR2
A8CR3
A8CR4
A8CR5
A8CR6
A8CR7
A8CR8
A8CR9
A8CR10
A8CR11
A8CR12
A8CR13
A8CR14
A8CR15
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
1251-0600
1826-0261
0
8
0160-4297
0160-3456
0160-3094
0160-3449
0160-4297
0180-2205
0180-1743
0160-0163
0160-2055
0160-0155
0160-0153
0160-0134
0180-0197
0170-0066
1901-0040
1901-0040
1826-0229
1858-0032
1826-0092
1902-0033
1902-0680
4
7
1902-0202 9
08558-60123 9
8
8
3
0180-0197
0160-3456
0160-3402
0160-3009
0180-0197
0160-3094
0160-3456
0160-3466
0160-2257
0160-2150
0180-0197
0140-0192
0180-0197
8
9
8
3
5
6
8
0
8
8
6
2
5
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0376
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1
1
1
1
1
6
1
1
1
3
3
3
3
0
9
1
1
4
1
9
6
5
3
2
6
5
7
5
6
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0757-0401
0757-0416
0757-0199
0690-3450
0757-0441
0811-3247
0683-1065
0698-3156
0757-0199
0757-0401
0811-3246
2100-3094
0757-0462
0757-0459
0698-3428
0757-0199
0698-3132
0683-1065
0757-0422
7
2
3
8
4
3
9
0
7
4
3
0
3
3
4
7
5
8
1
1
1
1
1
2
4
1
1
2
1
60
2
12
1
1
3
1
2
1
3
2
5
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-9
Description
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-00
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1Dno
RESISTOR 41.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 150 1% 7.5W PW TC=0+-20
RESISTOR 10N 5% .25W CC TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% 7.5W PW TC=0+-20
RESISTOR-TRMR 100K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TEN
RESISTOR 75K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 261 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10M 5% .25W CC TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 909 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 20480
IC OP AMP LOW-NOISE TO-99 PKG 28480
IC OP AMP LOW-DRIFT TO-99 PKG
TRANSISTOR ARRAY 14-PIN PLSTC DIP
IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG
DIODE--ZNR IN823 6.2V 5% 0DO-7 PD=.4W
DIODE-ZNR 1N827 6.2V 5% D00-7 PD=.4W
DIODE-ZNR 15V 5% PD=1W IR=5UA
SWEEP GENERATOR
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2LIF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1IF +-5% 50VDC MET-POLYC
CAPACITOR-FXD 982PF +-1% 1 100VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.21JF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-10% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 10PF +-5% 50FVDC CER 0+-60
CAPACITOR-FXD 33PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.21WF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 68PF +-5% 30OVDC MICA
CAPACITOR--FXD 2,21UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .022UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 200OPF +-10% 250VDC CER
56289
28480
24800
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .022UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 33UF+-10% 35VDC TA
56289
56289
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF+-10% 35VDC TA 56289
CAPACITOR-FXD ,033UF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE 28480
CAPACITOR-FXD O01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 3300PF +-10% 200VDC POLYE
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE
CAPACITOR-FXD 220PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .027UF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50NA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50NA 2NS D0-35
28480
21480
28480
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-GEN PRP 35V 50MA D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE--SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V SOMA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
06665
3L585
28480
24046
24046
28480
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
56289
72136
56289
Mfr.
Code
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
21480
01121
24546
24546
24546
28480
02111
24546
24546
0388
24546
24546
01121
24546
**A7TP11 IS GND;A7TP12 NOT ASSIGNED.
Mfr Part Number
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-T0-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-4222-F
C4-1/8-TO-8251-F
0811-3247
C01065
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
0811-3246
43P104
C41/8-TO-7502-F
C4-1/8-TO-5622--F
PME55-1/8-TO-14R7-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2610-F
CB1065
C4-1/8-TO-909R-F
1251-0600
1826-0261
OP-05CJ
CA3146E
1826-0092
1N823
1N827
1902-0202
0855860123
150D225X9020A2
0160-3456
0160-3402
0160-3009
1500225X9020A2
0160-3094
0160-3456
0160-3466
0160-2257
0160-2150
150D225X9020A2
DM15E68OJO300WVICR
150D225X9020A2
C023F101H223ZS22-CDH
0160-3456
0160-3094
0160-3449
C023F101H223ZS22-CDH
150D334X9035A2
150D104X9035A2
0160-0163
0160--2055
0160-0155
0160-0153
0160-0134
1500225X902A2
0170-0066
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0376
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A8Q26
A8Q27
A8Q28
A8Q29
A8Q30
A8Q31
A8Q32
A8Q33
A8Q34
A8Q35
A8Q36
A8Q37
A8Q38
A8Q39
A8Q40
A8Q41
A8Q42
A8Q43
A8Q44
A8Q45
A8Q46
A8Q47
A8Q48
A8Q49
A8Q50
A8Q51
A8Q52
A8Q53
A8Q54
A8Q55
A8R1
A8R2
A8R3
A8R4
A8R5
A8R6
A8R7
A8R8
A8R9
A8R10
A8Q1
A8Q2
A8Q3
A8Q4
A8Q5
A8Q6
A8Q7
A8Q8
A8Q9
A8Q10
A8Q11
A8Q12
A8CR16
A8CR17
A8CR18
A8CR19
A8CR20
A8CR21
A8CR22
A8CR23
A8CR24
A8CR25
A8MP1
A8MP2
A8MP3
A8Q13
A8Q14
A8Q15
A8Q16
A8Q17
A8Q18
A8Q19
A8Q20
A8Q21
A8Q22
A8Q23
A8Q24
A8Q25
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
1855-0082
1855-0082
1855-0082
1855-0062
1855-0082
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1853-0020
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0404
1853-0020
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0040
1205-0202
0380-0198
2360-0055
1854-0071
1855-00B2
1855-0082
1853-0007
1853-0020
1854-0071
1853-0007
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0404
1855-0417
1853-0020
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1855-0002
1854-0071
1855-0417
1854-0071
1853-0020
1854-0071
0698-3450
2100-3154
0757-0279
0757-0419
0757-0459
0698-3152
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0444
2100-3109
7
7
7
7
7
7
4
2
8
2
2
2
0
3
0
0
3
7
0
7
7
0
4
3
0
0
0
9
7
8
8
9
9
1
2
7
4
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
0
7
4
2
7
4
7
2
3
1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
3
0
3
0
0
3
2
0
0
1
1
1
16
7
5
20
1
6
2
1
Description
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2HS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA INS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
THERMAL LINK DUAL TO-18-CS
STANDOFF-RVT-ON .312-IN-LG 6-32THD
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .188-IN-LG BDG-HD-SLT
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3OOMW FT=200MNHZ
TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-.MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N31251 SI T0-18 PD :360NW
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=15SNHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3OOnW FT=200NHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360NW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=30OMW FT=200NHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3SSNW FT=201HZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D0MODE TO-18 SI
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=30OMW FT=150MIIZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PS=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PS=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=36ONW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-B18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-S18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET P--CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET P--CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=15MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN ST PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=3&0MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=3&0MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO--IS PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP SI, PD=300MW FT=150MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20 0MHZ
TRANSISTOR J--FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20PNDZ
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=150MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 11.1K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17--TRN
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-10
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
24546
02111
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
02111
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
00000
00000
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
1855-0002
1855-0082
1855-0082
1855-0062
1855-0082
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1853-0020
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0404
1353-0020(
1901-0 050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0040
1205-0202
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
1854-0071
1855-0082
1855-0082
2N3251
1853-0020
1854-0071
2N3251
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0404
1855-0417
1853-0020
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0019
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0404
1854-0019
1855-0082
1854-0071
1855-0417
1854-0071
1853-0020
1854-0071
C4-1/8-TO-4222-F
43P102
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-5622-F
C4-1/8-TO-3481-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
43P202
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A8R42
A8R43
A8R44
A8R45
A8R46
A8R47
A8R48
A8R49
AR850
A8R51
A8R52
A8R53
A8R54
A8R55
A8R56
A8R57
A8R58
A8R59
A8R60
A8R61
A8R62
A8R63
A8R64
A8R65
A8R66
A8R67
A8R68
A8R69
A8R70
A8R71
A8R72
A8R73
A8R74*
A8R75
A8R76
A8R77
A8R78*
A8R79
A8R80
A8R81
A8R82
A8R83
A8R84
A8R85
A8R29
A8R30*
A8R31
A8R32
A8R33
A8R34
A8R35*
A8R36
A8R37
A8R38
A8R39
A8R40
A8R41
A8R11
A8R12
A8R13
A8R14
A8R15
A8R16
A8R17
A8R18
A8R19
A8R20
A8R21
A8R22
A8R23
A8R24
A8R25
A8R26
A8R27
A8R28
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0698-7421
0698-3194
0698-7794
0698-3156
0757-0199
0757-0346
0757-0465
0757-0464
0757-0442
0757-0279
0757-0439
0757-0460
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0465
0757-0439
0757-0465
0757-0279
0698-3160
0757-0465
0757-0465
0757-0346
0757-0199
0757-0199
0757-0199
0757-0199
0698-7412
0757-1094
0757-0199
0757-0199
2100-2850
0757-0199
0698-3151
0757-0199
0757-0442
0757-0199
0757-0458
0757-0199
0757-0199
0757-0199
0698-0085
0698-3260
0757-0444
2100-2850
0698-3457
0698-3442
2100-3052
0698-3446
0757-0424
0698-7412
0757-0442
0757-0458
0757-0465
0757-0465
0757-0279
0757-0280
0698-3444
0698-7794
0698-0416
0698-7794
0683-3355
0683-3355
0698-7794
0698-7798
0757-0442
0698-3160
0698-3260
0698-3160
0757-0400
0757-0401
0683-6845
3498-3457
0757-0442
0698-3451
0757-0459
9
9
6
4
4
1
9
0
3
2
6
5
2
2
2
8
3
3
3
6
2
8
6
6
0
3
3
3
0
3
7
3
9
9
1
8
3
8
3
7
9
3
3
1
9
0
9
8
2
6
9
8
9
0
8
1
6
2
2
7
2
0
3
1
2
6
6
9
7
4
3
7
1
6
9
17
8
1
3
4
7
3
3
3
1
1
2
3
4
4
2
8
47
6
2
Description
Mfr.
Code
RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W - TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR -51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 44K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=:0-100
RESISTOR 3.3M 5%., .125W F TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 3.3M 5% .25W F TC=-900/+1100
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=+100
RESISTOR 5.25K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 464k 1% .125W F TC=:+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 90.9 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC:TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 680K 5% .25W F TC=-800/+900
RESISTOR 316K 1% . 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 133K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 20K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0·1-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC:0+-100
RESISTOR 90.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC-TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W E TC=D+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 61.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% ,125W F TC=0+ -100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21 .5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10S
RESISTOR 21.5K 17 .125W F TC=04-100
RESISTOR 3.3K 25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.47K 17 .125W F TC=0+-10
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
24546
19701
24546
24546
RESISTOR 21.5K 1-. 125W F TC=D+-100 24546
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN 02660
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10 0
24546
24546
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 51.1K 1% ,125W F TC:0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% , 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .1 -5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-101
RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
28480
24546
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN 02660
19701
19701
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
01121
28480
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
02111
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
19701
19701
01121
01121
19701
03888
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-11
Mfr Part Number
0698-3457
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
43P500
C4-1/8-TO-383R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
MF4C1/8 -TO-1332-C
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-T0-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
MF4C1/8-TO-4402-C
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
CB3355
CB3355
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
MF4C1/8-TO-5251-C
C4-1/8 TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
0698-3260
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
C4-1/8-TO -90R9-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
CB6845
0698-3457
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1333-F
C4-1/8-TO-5622-F
MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C
PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-9092-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-6192-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-C
C4-1/8-TO-1471-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
3810P-103
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2071-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2611-F
0698-3260
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
3810P-103
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A8R110
A8R111
A8R112
A8R113
A8R114
A8R115
A8R116
A8R117
A8R118
A8R119
A8R120
A8R121
A8R122
A8R123
A8R124
A8R125
A8R126
A8R127
A8R128
A8R129
A8R130
A8R131
A8R132
A8TP1 THRU
A8TP9
A8R86
A8R87
A8R88
A8R89*
A8R90
A8R91
A8R92
A8R93
A8R94
A8R95*
A8R96
A8R97
A8R98
A8RR99
A8R100
A8R101
A8R102
A8R103
A8R104
A8R105*
A8R106
A8R107
A8R108
A8R109
A8U1
A8U2
A8U3
A8VR1
A8VR2
A8VR3
A9
A9
A9C1
A9C2
A9C3
A9C4
A9C5
A9C6
A9C7
A9C8
A9C9
A9C10
A9C11
A9C12
A9C13
A9C14
A9C15
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
1251-0600
1820-0223
1826-0092
1826-0261
1902-0025
1902-3139
1902-0049
08558-60154
08558-60155
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-2249
0160-2264
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-2207
0140-0195
0140-0198
0180-0197
0180-0197
0160-3878
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0698-3451
0757-0442
0757-0442
0698-7794
0757-0459
0757-0442
0757-0442
0698-3238
0757-0465
0698-7794
0698-7086
0698-8322
0683-1055
0683-1055
0757-0465
0757-0461
0757-0442
0698-7421
0757-0442
0698-3194
0683-3355
0757-0442
0698-3194
0698-7794
0757-0199
0757-0199
0757-0460
0698-7421
0757-0199
0757-0289
0698-3194
0757-0199
0698-3153
0698-7412
0757-0199
0757-0442
0757-0199
0757-0465
0698-7794
0757-0459
0757-0442
0698-3154
0698-3457
0757-0440
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0442
5
5
6
2
5
4
6
2
B
9
9
1
9
2
0
9
2
9
8
9
8
9
2
3
9
3
6
9
1
0
3
3
1
2
3
2
3
2
9
9
9
6
7
9
0
2
8
3
7
10
5
10
1
1
3
1
3
8
6
2
5
6
3
2
6
6
6
6
3
6
6
2
6
7
4
7
3
8
0
0 1
5
2
1
1
1
2
1
I
1
1
12
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-12
Description
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-1O0
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 61.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% ,125W F TC=0+ -100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.22K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 133K 1% 3 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.5K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.02K .25% -125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 111 .2% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-800/+900
RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-800/+900
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 68.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR 3.3M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-900/+1100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F rC=0+-50
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-S7 SQ 28480
IC OP AMP GP TD-99 PKG 3L585
IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG
IC OP AMP LOW-NOISE TO-99 PKG
28480
28480
DIODE-ZNR 10V 5% DO-35 PD=4W TC=.06%
DIODE-ZNR 8.25V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W
DIODE-ZNR 6.19V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W
THIRD CONVERTER
THIRD CONVERTER, OPTION 001/002
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 10IVOC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 1009VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 4.7PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 20PF +-5% 500VDC CER 0+-30
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 200PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR--FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2U2F+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
72136
72136
56289
56289
28480
Mfr.
Code
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
19701
28480
19701
01121
01121
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
03888
01121
24546
03888
19701
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
19701
03888
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
Mfr Part Number
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-6192-F
MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-C
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-PF
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
C4-1/8-TO-5622-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-4221-F
0698-3457
C4-1/B-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1333-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
C4-1/8-TO-5622--F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
0698-3238
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C
0690-7086
MF4C1/8-TO-111R-C
CB1055
CB1055
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-6812-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C
CB3355
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C
1251-0600
CA301AT
1826-0092
1826-0261
1902-0025
1902-3139
1902-0049
08558-60154
08558-60155
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-2249
0160-2264
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-2207
DM15F131J0300WV1CR
DM15F201J0300WV1CR
150D225X9020A2
150D225X9020A2
0160-3878
Model 8558B
A9R10
A9R11
A9R12*
A9R12*
A9R13
A9R14*
A9R15
A9R16
A9R17
A9R18
A9R19
A9R20
A9R21
A9R22
A9R23
A9R24
A9R25
Reference
Designation
A9L7
A9L8
A9L9
A9L10
A9L11
A9L12
A9L13
A9L14
A9L15
A9L16
A9MP1
A9MP2
A91Q
A9Q2
A9Q3
A9Q4
A9Q5
A9R1
A9R2
A9R3
A9R4*
A9R5
A9R6
A9R7
A9R8
A9R9*
A9R10
A9R10
A9E3
A9J1
A9J2
A9L1
A9L2
A9L3
A9L4
A9L5
A9L6
A9C16
A9C17
A9C18
A9C19
A9C20
A9CR1
A9CR2
A9CR3
A9CR4
A9CR5
A9CR6
A9CR7
A9CR8
A9E1
A9E2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0698-7203
0698-7206
0757-0416
0757-0416
0698-3450
0757-0463
0698-3438
0683-0475
0757-0464
0698-3150
0698-3156
0757-0418
0698-3159
0757-0317
0698-3447
0757-0280
0757-0418
HP Part C
Number D Qty
9100-2255
9100-2255
9100-2249
9100-2249
9100-2276
9140-0178
9140-0178
9140-0143
9100-1623
9100-1623
08558-00014
08558-00079
1854-0345
1854-0247
1854-0247
1854-0019
1854-0404
2100-2522
0757-0280
0757-0346
0757-0424
2100-3123
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0799
0757-0274
0698-7188
0698-7196
0160-3456
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0070
1901-0070
9170-0029
1200-0173
1200-0173
1250-0830
1250-0830
9100-2255
9100-2255
08558-80002
08558-80012
9100-2255
9100-2250
8
9
9
3
1
8
8
8
9
0
0
9
6
6
4
4
2
2
9
7
0
3
2
0
1
5
8
8
7
7
3
5
1
1
9
9
7
7
6
7
7
1
1
7
4
9
4
5
6
4
5
6
10
23
2
21
3
4
1
1
1
8
6
2
1
1
1
2
1
4
1
1
1
2
4
8
1
1
7
7
8
1
5
7
2
9
3
1
5
6
9
4
4
3
9
12
1
2
5
4
0
0
Description
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-PWR RECT 600V 750MA DO-29
DIODE-PWR RECT 600V 750MA DO-29
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL
INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL
CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM
CONNECTOR-RE SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG
COIL, NEUTRALIZING
COIL., FREQUENCY ADJUST
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 180NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 150NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 150NH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100UH 10% .185Dx.26L.G
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10%.166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 3.3UH 10% .105DX,26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 27UH 5% .166DX,38SLG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 27UH 5% .166DX.385L.G
COVER, THIRD CONVERTER
RF SHIELD, MIXER
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI T0-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-39 PD=1W FT=800MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-39 PD=1W FT=800MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=O+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 10 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 121 1x .5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .5OW F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
(OPTION 001/002)
RESISTOR 42.2 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
(OPTION 001/002)
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=1+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
(OPTION 001/002)
RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 02.5K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.7 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500
RESISTOR 90,9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2,37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1Z .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 26.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.33K-1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 422 1% ,125W F T=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-13
Mfr Part Number
0160-3456
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0070
1901-0070
9170-0029
1200-0173
1200-0173
1250-0830
1250-0830
9100-2255
9100-2255
08558-80002
08558-80012
9100-2255
9100-2250
9100-2255
9100-2255
9100-2249
9100-2249
9100-2276
9140-0178
9140-0178
9140-0143
9100-1623
9100-1623
08558-00014
08558-00079
2N5179
1854-0247
1854-0247
1854-0019
1854-0404
ET50X103
C4-1/8-TO-001-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
43P501
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
0757-0799
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C3-1/8-TO-10R-F
C3-1/8-TO-21R5-F
C3-1/8-TO-42R2-F
C3-1/8-TO-56R2-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-4222-F
C4-1/8-TO-0252-F
C4-1/8-TO-147R-F
CB47G5
C4-1/8-TO-9092-F
C4-1/8-TO-2371-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-619R-F
C4-1/8-TO-2612-F
C4-1/8-TO-1331-F
C4-1/8-TO-422R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-619R-F
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
01121
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
28480
28480
30983
24546
24546
24546
02111
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A9U1
A9VR1
A9VR2
A9Z1
A11C1
A11C12
A11C13
A11C14
A11C15
A11C16
A11C17
A11C18
A11C19
A11C20*
A11C21
A11C22
A11C23
A11C24
A11C25
A11C26
A11C27
A11C28
A11C29
A11C30
A11C31
A11C32
A11C33
A11C34
A11C35
A10L1
A10L2
A10L3
A10L4
A10L5
A10MP1
A10MP2
A10Q1
A10Q2
A10R1
A10R2
A10R3
A10R4
A10R5
A11
A11C1
A11C2
A11C3
A11C4
A11C5
A11C6
A11C7
A11C8
A11C9
A11C10
A10
A10C1
A10C2
A10C3
A10C4
A10C5
A10C6
A10C7
A10C8
A10C9
A10C10
A10C11
A10C12
A10C13
A10C14
A10C15
A10J1
A10J2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0955-0076
1902-3104
1902-0025
1GA1-8001
4
3
5
6
1
1
1
1
3
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0140-0194
0160-3431
0160-4084
0121-0036
0121-0446
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-4084
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
08558-60010
0121-0457
0121-0457
0121-0457
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3877
0160-3878
0160-2236
0160-2250
0160-3878
0160-2250
0160-2250
0160-2252
0160-2250
0160-2250
1250-0830
1250-0830
9100-2247
08558-80005
08558-80003
08558-80003
08558-80003
08558-00015
1200-0172
1853-0007
5086-4218
0757-0442
0698-3136
0757-0438
0698-3442
0757-0280
9
3
08558-60128 4
0160-2055 9
8
3
7
9
6
2
4
7
6
6
4
8
0160-0127
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2250
0121-0059
3
9
9
9
9
9
9
2
8
6
6
9
9
7
6
6
6
6
6
8
6
6
5
6
8
6
6
6
9
9
3
9
6
8
6
9
3
9
9
9
9
6
9
7
8
0
9
1
9
9
1
3
9
1
1
2
2
1
3
1
1
3
4
4
4
5
4
Description
MIXER, D0UBLE BALANCED
DI0DE-ZNR 5.62V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W
DI0DE-ZNR 10V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.06%
SURFACE ACOUSTICAL. WAVE RESONATOR
(SAWR)
SECOND IF
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN 8-8.5PF 750V
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN .8-8.5PF 750V
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN .8-8.5PF 750V
CAPACITOR-FXD 1D00PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 200VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500 VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-.20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500 VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 6.2PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-H0LE-FR 50-OHM
CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-H0LE-FR 50-OHM
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100NH 10% .105DX.26LG
COIL, PAR TANK
COIL, BANDPASS FILTER
COIL, BANDPASS FILTER
COIL, BANDPASS FILTER
C0VER, SECOND I. F
INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR, NPN MICROWAVE
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC:=0+-100
RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=00+-100
BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1
CAPACITOR-FXD ,01UF +80-20% 100VDC CE0R
CAPACITOR-FXD 11JF -20% 2SVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.2PF 5S00VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .016F +80-20% 1100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-7FXD .0UF +00-20 1001VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 500PF 1-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 10VD0C CER
CAPACITOR --FXD .01UF +80--207 10lVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10%x 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25'SPF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-.20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +0--20% 1D0VDC 10 ER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20X 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8 .+-.5PF 500VDC
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V
CAPACITOR FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 10UVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +10-20% 10VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF R80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% - 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% x100VDC CER
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-14
Mfr Part Number
0955-0076
1902-3104
1902-0025
1GA1-8001
08558-60010
TP9
TP9
TP9
0160-3878
0160-3878
0160-3877
0160-3878
0160-2236
0160-2250
0160-3878
0160-2250
0160-2250
0160-2252
0160-2250
0160-2250
1250-0830
1250-0830
9100-2247
08558-80005
08558-80003
08558-80003
08558-80003
08558-00015
1200-0172
2N3251
5086-4218
C4-1/8-T0-1002-F
C4-1/8-T0-1782-F
C4-1/8-T0-5111-F
C4--1/8-T0-237R-F
C4-1/8-T0-1001-F
08558-60128
0160-2055
0160-0127
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2250
304324 2/8PF NPO
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
DM15F111J0300D0WV1CR
0160-3431
0160-4084
304324 5.5/18PF NPO
0121-0446
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-4084
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
72136
28480
28480
52763
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
52763
28480
18736
18736
18736
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A11C36
A11C37
A11C38
A11C39
A11C40
A11C41
A11C42
A11C43
A11C44
A11C45
A11C46
A11C47
A11C48
A11C49
A11C50
A11C51
A11C52
A11C53
A11C54
A11C55
A11C56THRU
A11C59
A11C60
A11C61
A11C62
A11C63
A11C64
A11C65
A11C66
A11C67
A11C68THRU
A11C72
A11C73
A11C74
A11CR1
A11CR2
A11CR3
A11CR4
A11CR5
A11CR6
A11CR7
A11CR8
A11CR9
A11CR10
A11CR11
A11CR12
A11CR13
A11CR14
A11CR15
A11CR16
A11CR17
A11E1 THRU
A11E8
A11L1
A11L2
A11L3
A11L4
A11L5
A11L6
A11L7
A11L8
A11L9
A11L10
A11L11
A11L12
A11L13
A11L14
A11L15
A11L16
A11L17
A11MP1
A11Q1
A11Q2
A11Q3
A11Q4
A11Q5
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0121-0452
0121-0452
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0535
9170-0029
9140-0112
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9100-3854
9140-0098
9140-0178
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9140-0098
9100-1620
9100-3854
9140-0144
9100-1624
08565-00024
1854-0345
1854-0404
1853-0007
1853-0007
1855-0267
8
9
9
9
9
8
9
9
8
8
9
9
8
9
9
4
4
8
1
3
5
4
9
0
0
1
3
9
2
1
0
7
7
5
8
0
3
2
0
4
9
1
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0160-2055
0160-2250
0121-0059
9
6
7
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3431
0140-0194
0121-0036
0160-4084
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0121-0446
0160-2055
9
9
9
9
9
9
6
9
9
6
9
7
8
9
1
0
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2208
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
9
9
9
9
9
9
4
9
4
13
3
4
7
6
14
4
4
2
3
2
1
1
Description
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC: CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01F +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-5PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF4-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-2.0% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 330PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +50-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE--PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE.-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75HA 10NS
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX,385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% 166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX .385LG
INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1 .016LG Q =150
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX .385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX. 385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2,2UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .166DX385LG
INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1, .016LG Q=150
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% .185 DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .1,6DX.385LG
BAFFLE, INDUCTOR
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD:=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN 0-MODE TO-92 SI 4
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-15
TM 11-6625-3061-14
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
74970
74970
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
04713
04713
28480
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
52763
28480
28480
28480
28480
72136
52763
28480
28480
284B0
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
0160-2055
0160-2250
304324 2/8PF NPO
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3431
DM15F111J0300WV1CR
304324 5.5/18PF NPO
0160-4084
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0121-0446(
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2208
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
187-0103-028
187-0103-028
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0535
9170-0029
9140-0112
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9100-3854
9140-0098
9140-0178
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9140-0098
9100-1620
9100-3854
9140-0144
9100-1624
08565-00024
2N5179
1854-0404
2N3251
2N3251
1855--0267
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A11R29
A11R30
A11R31
A11R32
A11R33
A11R34
A11R35
A11R36
A11R37
A11R38
A11R39
A11R40
A11R41
A11R42
A11R43*
A11R44
A11R45
A11R46
A11R47
A11R48*
A11R49
A11R50
A11R51
A11R52
A11R53
A11R54
A11R55
A11R56*
A11R57
A11R58
A11R59
A11R60
A11TP1
A11TP2
A11TP3
A11TP4
A11TP5
A11TP6
A11TP7
A11TP8
A11TP9
A11TP10
A11Q6
A11Q7
A1RQ8
A11Q9
A11Q10
A11R1
A11R2
A11R3
A11R4
A11R5
A11R6
A11R7
A11R8
A11R9
A11R10
A11R11
A11R12
A11R13
A11R14
A11R15
A11R16
A11R17
A11R18
A11R19
A11R20
A11R21
A11R22
A11R23*
A11R24
A11R25
A11R26
A11R27
A11R28
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
1853-0007
1854-0404
1853-0007
1855-0267
1853-0007
0757-0444
0698-3156
0757-0402
7
0
7
5
2
1
7
1
6
2
2
1
0757-0346
0757-0290
0698-3440
0757-0416
0757-0442
0757-0424
0757-0180
0698-3152
0757-0180
0698-3153
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
0757-0405
0698-3431
0698-8822
0757-0401
0757-0439
0757-1094
0757-0440
0757-0447
0698-0082
0757-0346
0698-3440
0757-0419
0698-3442
0757-0279
0757-0279
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0289
0757-0465
0757-0465
2100-3163
0757-0444
0757-0290
0757-1094
0757-0402
2100-3052
0757-0442
0757-0199
0757-0288
0698-0083
0757-0416
0698-3441
0757-0419
0698-3442
0757-0279
0757-0442
0757-0200
0757-0442
0757-0401
0757-0401
0757-0346
0698-3156
0757-0444
7
2
8
7
9
2
5
7
7
7
2
9
0
7
7
0
0
0
0
9
2
6
9
9
0
0
0
9
9
1
4
1
5
6
8
7
4
4
9
7
2
7
4
6
9
0
8
0
9
0
7
9
3
1
7
9
0
9
2
2
1
0
0
1
9
14
2
5
3
4
6
8
Description
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-M0DE TO-92 SI
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 23.7 1% .125W F TC=+-100
RESISTOR 6.81 1% .1251W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 464 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F 1C=D+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=D+-100
RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1%.125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-.ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1R0
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0 +-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE--ADJ 17-TRN
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESIST1)R 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESIST 0R 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-110
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-110
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6 1x .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ S0
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ S
CONNECTOR-SGL- CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ
NOT ASSIGNED
C10NNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-16
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Mfr Part Number
2N3251
1854-0404
2N3251
1855-0267
2N3251
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
C4-1/8-TO-162R-F
PME55-1/8-TO-23R7-F
0698-8822
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TR-1471-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-'TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-4640-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161--F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
MS4C1/8-TO-1332F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
43P105
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-1471-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
43P500
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-215R-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4. 1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-5621-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1 /8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8TO-1212-F
C4-1/8 -TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8STD-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R--F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
0757-0180
C4-1/8-TO-3481-F
0757-0180
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
28480
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
02111
24546
19701
24546
24546
02111
24546
03888
28480
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
Mfr.
Code
04713
28480
04713
28480
04713
24546
24546
24546
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A11TP1
A11VR1
A11Y1/2
A12CR3
A12CR4
A12CR5
A12CR6
A12E1
A12E2
A12E3
A12L1
A12L2
A12L3
A12L4
A12L5
A12L6
A12L7
A12L8
A12L9
A12L10
A12L11
A12Q1
A12Q2
A12Q3
A12Q4
A12Q5
A12Q6
A12Q7
A12C17
A12C18
A12C19
A12C20
A12C21
A12C22
A12C23
A12C24
A12C25
A12C26
A12C27
A12CR1
A12CR2
A12
A12
A12C1
A12C2
A12C3
A12C4
A12C5
A12C6
A12C7
A12C8
A12C9
A12C10
A12C11
A12C12
A12C13
A12C14
A12C15
A12C16
A12Q8
A12Q9
A12Q10
A12Q11
A12Q12
A12Q13
A12R1
A12R2
A12R3
A12R4
A12R5
HP Part C
Number D Qty
1251-0600
1902-0048
0410-0450
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9100-2260
9140-0158
9100-2552
1853-0007
1854-0345
1853-0007
1854-0345
1853-0007
1854-0345
1853-0007
08558-60012
08558-60073
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2199
0160-2307
0140-0194
0180-0291
1901-0050
1901-0050
1853-0007
1853-0007
1854-0882
1854-0882
1853-0007
1853-0213
2100-3103
2100-3103
2100-3054
2100-3061
2100-3103
2
5
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
3
1
9
9
9
9
7
8
7
7
8
7
8
6
4
7
7
6
6
8
8
7
7
6
5
6
9
2
9
9
9
9
9
9
3
3
3
4
1
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
3
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
5
8
0
1
5
1
1
1
3
2
2
1
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
Description
Mfr.
Code
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1,14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W
28480
CRYSTAL, 21.4 MHZ (MATCHED SET OF FOUR;
INCLUDES A11Y1, A11Y2, A13Y1, & A13Y2)
28480
STEP GAIN
STEP GAIN, OPTION 001/002
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF+-10% 35VDC TA
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
56289
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 30PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 47PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF+-10% 35VDC TA
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
72136
56209
28480
28480
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1.8UH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N4236 SI TO-5 PD=1W
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 50K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
04713
04713
04713
04713
04713
04713
04713
04713
28480
28480
04713
04713
02111
02111
02111
02111
02111
Mfr Part Number
1251-0600
1902-0048
0410-0450
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9140-0179
9100-2260
9140-0158
9100-2552
2N3251
2N5179
2N3251
2N5179
2N3251
2N5179
2N3251
08558-60012
08558-60073
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
150D105X9035A2
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3457
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3457
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3457
0160-2055
0160-2199
0160-2307
DM15F111J0300WV1CR
150D105X9035A2
1901-0050
1901-0050
2N3251
2N3251
1854-0882
1854-0882
2N3251
2N4236
43P103
43P103
43P503
43P504
43P103
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-17
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A12R6
A12R7
A12R8
A12R9
A12R10
A12R11
A12812
A12R13
A12R14
A12R15
A12R16
A12R17
A12R18
A12R19
A12R20
A12R21
A12R22
A12R23
A12824
A12R25
A12R26
A12R26
A13C1
A13C2
A13C3
A13C4
A13C5
A13C6
A13C7
A13C8
A13C9
A13C10
A13C11
A13C12
A13C13
A13C14
A13C15
A13C16
A13C17
A13C18
A13C19
A13C20*
A12827
A12R28
A12R29
A12R30
A12R31
A12R32
A12R33
A12R34
A12R35
A12R36
A12R37
A12R38
A12R39
A12R40
A12R41
A12R42
A12R43
A12R44
A12R45
A12R46
A12R47
A12R48
A12R49
A12S1
A12TP1 THRU
A12TP9
A12VR1
A13
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0757-0280
0757-0279
0690-3444
0757-0395
0757-0280
0757-0420
0757-0280
0757-0279
0698-3444
0757-0395
0757-0280
0757-0420
0757-0280
0698-3440
0757-0274
0757-0274
0698-3151
0698-3151
0757-0290
0698-3151
0698-3162
0698-3162
0698-3162
3101-0973
2100-3056
2100-1757
0757-0288
0698-3457
0757-0346
0757-0279
0698-3444
0757-0208
0757-0395
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0290
0757-0346
0757-0290
0757-0279
0698-3162
0757-0279
0698-3444
0757-0395
0757-0280
0757-0417
0757-0419
1251-0600
1902-0033
08558-60129
0160-2055
0160-0127
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2250
0121-0059
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0140-0194
Description
Mfr.
Code
7
5
3
3
0
1
1
3
3
3
1
3
3
0
1
0
0
7
0
5
5
7
7
5
5
0
0
0
5
2
2
2
3
8
1
1
0
1
1
1
2
0
1
6
8
2
1
5
2
1
RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 9.09K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1x .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 46.4K 11 .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 17 .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 11 .125W F TC=0+-108
RESISTOR 562 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
(OPTION 001/002)
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F C=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 46.4K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
SWITCH-SL DPDT MINTR .5A 125VAC/DC PC
9
1
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
3
6
6
7
8
9
9
2
0
4
5 1
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
DIODE-ZNR 1N823 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W
BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2
24046
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-20% 25VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
28480
28480
52763
28480
28480
28480
72136
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
02111
28480
19701
213480
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
6-18
Mfr Part Number
43P502
2100-1757
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
0698-3457
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-4642-F
C4--1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-562R-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C4-1/8-TO-2071-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
C4-1/8-TO-4642-F
C4-1/8-TO-4642-F
C4-1/8-TO-4642-F
3101-0973
1251-0600
1N823
08558-60129
0160-2055
0160-0127
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2250
304324 2/8PF NPO
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
DM15F111J0300WV1CR
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A13C21
A13C22
A13C23
A13C24
A13C25
A13C26
A13C27
A13C28
A13C29
A13C30
A13C31
A13C32
A13C33
A13C34
A13C35
A13C36
A13C37
A13C38
A13C39
A13C40
A13C41
A13C42
A13C43
A13C44*
A13C45
A13C46
A13C47
A13C48
A13C49
A13C50
A13C51
A13C52
A13C53
A13C54
A13C55
A13C56 THRU
A13C59
A13C60
A13C61
A13C62
A13C63
A13C64
A13C65
A13C66
A13C67
A13C68 THRU
A13C72
A13C73
A13C74
A13CR1
A13CR2
A13CR3
A13CR4
A13CR5
A13CR6
A13CR7
A13CR8
A13CR9
A13CR10
A13CR11
A13CR12
A13CR13
A13CR14
A13CR15
A13CR16
A13CR17
A13CR18
A13E1
A13E2
A13E3
A13E4
A13E5
A13E6
A13E7
A13E8
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0121-0452
0121-0452
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0047
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0160-3431
0160-4084
0121-0036
0121-0446
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-4084
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2250
0121-0059
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3431
0140-0194
0121-0036
0160-4084
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0121-0446
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
Description
Mfr.
Code
9
9
6
6
9
8
3
9
6
9
6
7
9
9
7
8
0
9
6
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
7
9
6
1
0
8
CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-.5PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20x 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +.-10% 1KVDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-.5PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF+80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
9
9
9
9
4
4
8
8
3
3
3
3
9
8
9
8
3
3
3
3
8
9
9
9
9
8
8
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V
CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 112V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA-10NS
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-19
74970
74970
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
52763
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
20480
28480
52763
28480
28480
20480
28480
72136
52763
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
187-0103-028
187-0103-028
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0047
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0535
1901-0047
1901-0535
1901-0047
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
9170-0029
Mfr Part Number
0160-3431
0160-4084
304324 5.5/18PF NPO
0121-0446
0160--2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-4084
0160-2207
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2250
304324 2/8PF NPO
0160-2055
0160-3456
0160-2055
0160-3431
DM15F111J0300WV1CR
304324 5.5/18PF NPO
0160-4084
0160-2055
0160-20550
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0121-0446
0160-2055
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A13MP1
A13Q1
A15Q2
A13Q3
A13Q4
A13Q5
A13Q6
A13Q7
A13Q8
A13Q9
A13Q10
A13R1
A13R2
A13R3
A13R4
A13R5
A13R6
A13R7
A13R8
A13R9
A13R10
A13011
A13R12
A13R13
A13R14
A13R15
A13R16
A13R17
A13R18
A13019*
A13R20
A13R21
A13R22
A13R23*
A13L1
A13L2
A13L3
A13L4
A13L5
A13L6
A13L7
A13L8
A13L9
A13L10
A13L11
A13L12
A13L13
A13L14
A13L15
A13L16
A13L17
A13R24
A13R25
A13R26
A13R27
A13R28
A13R29
A13R30
A13R31
A13R32
A13R33
A13R34
A13R35
A13R36
A13R37
A13R38
A13R39
A13R40
A13R41
A13R42
A13043*
A13R44
A13R45
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0757-0405
0698-3431
0698-3427
0757-0402
0757-0288
0698-0083
0757-0442
0757-0199
0757-0416
0757-0346
0698-3441
0757-0419
0698-3442
0757-0279
0757-0200
0757-0442
0757-0442
0757-0442
0698-3156
0757-0465
0757-0465
2100-3163
0757-0444
0757-0290
0757-1094
0757-0402
2100-3052
0757-0442
0757-0199
0757-0288
0698-0083
0757-0416
0698-3441
0757-0419
0698-3442
0757-0279
0757-0442
0757-0438
0757-0442
0757-0401
9140-0112
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9100-3854
9140-0098
9140-0178
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9140-0098
9100-1620
9100-3854
9140-0144
9100-1624
08565-00024
1854-0345
1854-0404
1853-0007
1053-0007
1855-0267
1853-0007
1854-0404
1853-0007
1855-0267
1853-0007
0757-0447
0698-3157
0757-0402
HP Part C
Number D Qty Description
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
9
3
9
0
9
0
1
8
9
3
7
8
0
9
9
2
7
9
9
0
8
0
9
3
7
2
1
8
0
1
4
6
5
9
1
4
8
1
6
6
3
0
0
1
1
4
9
2
0
5
1
0
9
1
3
4
9
7
0
7
7
5
0
7
2
8
4
3
5
7
1
1
1
4
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1.016LG Q=150
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.305LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.38SLG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR 400NH 10% ,3DX1.016LG Q=150
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% ,105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG
BAFFLE, INDUCTOR
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-92 SI
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-92 SI
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N5251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1X .125W F TC=0+-100
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 23,7 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
04713
04713
28480
04713
28480
04713
20480
04713
24546
24546
24546
9140-0112
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9100-3854
9140-0098
9140-0178
9100-1641
9140-0114
9100-1624
9140-0179
9140-0098
9100-1620
9100-3854
9140-0144
9100-1624
08565-00024
2N5179
1854-0404
2N3251
2N5251
1855-0267
2N3251
1854-0404
2N3251
1855-0267
2N3251
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-1962-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
24546 C4-1/8-TO-162R-F
03888 PME55-1/8-TO-23R7-F
03888
24546
PME55-1/8-TO-13R3-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
C4-2/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
02111
24546
19701
24546
24546
02111
C4-1/8-TO-215R-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-5621-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
43P105
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
MF4C1/8-T0-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-1471-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
4AF500
C4-11/-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-215R-F
C4-1/8-TO-681R-F
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-5111-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-101 F
6-20
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A13R46
A13R47
A13R48*
A13R49
A13R50
A13R51
A13R52
A13R53
A13R54
A13R55
A13R56*
A13R57
A13R58
A13R59
A13R60
A13TP1
A13TP2
A13TP3
A13TP4
A13TP5
A13TP6
A13TP7
A13TP8
A13TP9
A13TP10
A13TP11
A13VR1
A13Y1/2
A14C72
A14C73
A14C74
A14C75
A14C76
A14C77
A14CR1
A14CR2
A14CR3
A14CR4
A14CR5
A14CR6
A14CR7
A14CR8
A14CR9
A14CR10
A14CR11
A14CR12
A14CR13
A14CR14
A14CR15
A14
A14C1
A14C2
A14C3
A14C4
A14C5
A14C6
A14C7
A14C8
A14C9
A14C10
A14C11
A14C12
A14C13
A14C14 THRU
A14C34
A14C35
A14C36 THRU
A14C69
A14C70
A14C71
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0160-4554
0160-4519
0140-0195
0160-4386
0160-3872
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
1910-0016
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0757-0401
0757-0346
0698-3156
0757-0444
0757-0346
0757-0290
0698-3440
0757-0416
0757-0442
0757-0274
0757-0180
0698-3153
0757-0180
0698-3153
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1902-0048
0410-0450
5061-5411
0160-4554
0180-0197
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-3879
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
Description
Mfr.
Code
7
7
7
7
2
7
8
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
0
0
7
2
9
7
7
2
9
9
5
2
5
7
7
2
1
0
2
0
0
0
0
1
5
7
1
65
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
24546
24546
24546
24546
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=.+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1%X .125W F TC=0+-100
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
28480
28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
NOT ASSIGNED
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5%X DO-35 PD=.4W
CRYSTAL, 21.4 MHZ
(MATCHED SET OF 4;INCL.A13Y1,A13Y2,A11Y1
AND A11Y2)
28480
28480
LOG AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
28480
28480
56289
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
28480
7
7
3
0
7
4
2
7
7
0
3
3
1
1
1
1
6
9
6
6
9
6
6
6
6 16
6
1
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 9.1PF +-.5PF 200VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 33PF +-5% 200VDC CER 0+-30
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2PF +-.25PF 200VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER
DIODE-GE 60V 60MA 1US DO-7
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
NOT ASSIGNED
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
28480
28480
72136
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
0757-0180
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
0757-0180
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
0360-1788
0360-1788
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1251-0600
1902-0048
0410-0450
5061-5411
0160-4554
150D225X9020A2
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-3879
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4519
DM15F131J0300WV1CR
0160-4386
0160-3872
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
0160-4554
1910-0016
1901-0050
1901-0050
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1065
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
6-21
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A14CR33
A14E1
A14L1
A14L2
A14L3
A14L4
A14L5
A14L6
A14L7
A14L8
A14L9
A14L10
A14L11
A14L12
A14L13
A14L14
A14Q1
A14Q2
A14Q3
A14Q4
A14Q5
A14Q6
A14Q7
A14Q8
A14Q9
A14Q10
A14Q11
A14912
A14Q13
A14Q14
A14Q15
A14Q16
A14Q17
A14Q18
A14CR16
A14CR17
A14CR18
A14CR19
A14CR20
A14CR21
A14CR22
A14CR23
A14CR24
A14CR25
A14CR26
A14CR27
A14CR28
A14CR29
A14CR30
A14CR31
A14CR32
A14Q19
A14Q20
A14Q21
A14Q22
A14Q23
A14Q24
A14Q25
A14R1
A14R2
A14R3
A14R4
A14R5
A14R6
A14R7
A14R8
A14R9
A14R10
A14R11
A14R12
A14R13
A14R14
A14R15
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
1901-0050
9170-0029
9100-1618
9140-0144
9140-0105
9100-1619
9100-1619
9140-0114
9140--0114
9140-0114
9140-0112
9140-0105
9100-1627
9100-1629
9100-1622
9100-2257
1854-0637
1853-0281
1853-0281
1053-0015
1053-0015
1853-0007
1854-0019
1853-0015
1854-0019
1853-0015
1854-0019
1053-0015
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1005
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1005
1901-0050
1901-0050
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0475
1854-0404
1853-0181
1854-0404
1854-0019
0757-0117
0757-0280
0698-0084
0698-1430
0757-0443
0757-0442
0757-0465
0757-0442
0698-3450
2100-2633
0698-3155
0757-0458
0757-0401
0757-0460
0757-0458
Description
Mfr.
Code
7
3
7
1
7
7
9
9
4
7
6
1
3
2
4
2
2
4
4
3
2
1
0
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
7
3
7
3
1
6
6
6
6
6
9
9
6
9
6
3
3
6
9
9
6
9
6
9
9
5
0
3
9
9
0
3
7
5
0
3
3
1
7
7
0
5
1
2
1
1
1
3
1
1
2
1
1
2
4
2
2
4
1
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
CORE-SHIELDING BEAD
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 5.6UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 8.2UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 6.8UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 6.8UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 8.2UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 39UH 5% .166DX.385LG
28480
28480
28480
28480
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 47UH 5% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 24UH 5% .166DX.385LG
28480
28480
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 820NH 10%X ,105DX.26LG
28480
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N2219A SI TO-5 PD=800MW 01295
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI T0-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
04713
04713
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
28480
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSTSTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28400
28480
28480
28480
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO -18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.15K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+--100
RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 61,9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
24546
24546
24546
03888
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
30983
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
Mfr Part Number
1901-0050
9170-0029
9100-1618
9140-0144
9140-0105
9100-1619
9100-1619
9140-0114
9140-0114
9140-0114
9140-0112
9140-0105
9100-1627
9100-1629
9100-1622
9100-2257
2N2219A
2N2907A
2N2907A
1853-0015
1853-0015
2N3251
1854-0019
1853-0015
1854-0019
1853-0015
1854-0019
1853-0015
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1901-1070
1901-1005
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-1005
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-0050
1901-0050
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0475
1854-0404
2N2907A
1854-0404
1854-0019
C4-1/8-TO-1331-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-2151-F
PME55-1/8-TO-21R5-F
C4-1/8-TO-1102-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003--F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-4222-F
ET50X102
C4-1/8-TO-4641-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-6192-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
6-22
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A14R33
A14R34
A14R35
A14R36
A14R37
A14R38
A14R39
A14R40
A14R41
A14R42
A14R43
A14R44
A14R45
A14R46
A14R47
A14R48
A14R49
A14R50
A14R51
A14R52
A14R53
A14R54
A14R55
A14R56
A14R57
A14R58
A14R59
A14R60
A14R61
A14R62
A14R63
A14R64
A14R65
A14R66
A14R16
A14R17
A14R18
A14R19
A14R20
A14R21
A14R22
A14R23
A14R24
A14R25
A14R26
A14R27
A14R28
A14R29
A14R30
A14R31
A14R32
A14R67
A14R68
A14R69
A14R70
A14R71
A14R72
A14R73
A14R74
A14R75
A14R76
A14R77
A14R78
A14R79
A14R80
A14R81
A14R82
A14R83
A14R84
A14R85
A14R86
A14R87
A14R88
A14R89
A14R90
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
2100-2522
2100-2521
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0442
0698-3151
2100-2520
0757-0442
0757-0290
0757-0200
0757-0447
0757-0420
0698-3444
0698-3156
0757-0346
0698-3150
0698-3132
0757-0279
0757-0346
0698-3444
0757-0444
0757-0444
0757-0440
0757-0401
0757-0280
0757-0346
0698-3150
0698-3444
0757-0200
0757-0444
0757-0444
0757-0440
0757-0401
0757-0280
0757-0180
0757-0464
0698-3136
0757-0123
0698-0003
2100-2489
0698-3452
2100-2514
0757-0274
0757-0274
0757-0274
2100-2489
0757-0346
0757-0346
2100-2522
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0346
0698-8958
2100-2692
0698-3444
0757-0279
0707-0444
0757-0444
0757-0440
0757-0401
0757-0280
0757-0346
0698-3150
0690-3444
0757-0289
0757-0289
0757-0440
0757-0401
0757-0280
0757-0279
0757-0346
0698-3444
2100-2522
0757-0440
0757-0403
Description
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
1
7
0
3
1
1
0
2
2
2
6
4
3
1
7
4
9
7
9
9
5
2
2
1
0
7
0
3
1
1
1
3
2
6
1
1
5
8
9
2
5
8
3
2
1
2
2
9
2
5
5
1
2
2
7
2
6
0
3
0
1
1
7
6
1
2
2
1
1
7
2
0
2
0
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 90.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 34.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 147K 1% .125W F TO=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 20K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-*100
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 50 20% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.371K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 261 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0 +-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC-=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-23
24546
28480
30983
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
30983
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
28480
24546
30983
24546
30983
24546
24546
24546
30983
24546
24546
30983
24546
24546
0757-0180
C4-1/8-TO-9092-F
C4-1/8-TO-1782-F
0757-0123
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
ET50X502
C4-1/8-TO-1473-F
ET50W203
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
C4-1/8-TO-1211-F
ET50X502
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
ET50X103
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
30983
30983
24546
24546
24546
24546
30983
24546
19701
ET50X103
ET50X202
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
ET50X500
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
C4-1/8-TO-5621-F
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2371-F
C4-1/8-TO-2610-F
24546
24546
24546
24546
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
24546
24546
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
24546 C4-1/8-TO-101-F
24546 C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2371-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
0698-0958
ET5X105
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2371-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
ET50X103
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-121R-F
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A14R108
A14R109
A14R110
A14R111
A14R112
A14R113
A14R114
A14R115
A14R116
A14R117
A14R118
A14R119
A14R120
A14R121
A14R122
A14R123
A14R124
A14R125
A14R126
A14R127
A14R128
A14R129
A14R130
A14R131
A14R132
A14R133
A14R134
A14TP1
A14TP2
A14TP3
A14TP4
A14TP5
A14TP6
A14TP7
A14R91
A14R92
A14R93*
A14R94
A14R95
A14R96
A14R97
A14R98
A14R99
A14R100
A14R101*
A14R102
A14R103
A14R104
A14R105
A14R106
A14R107*
A14TP8
A14TP9
A14TP10
A14U1
A14U2
A14VR1
A15
A15C1
A15C2
A15C3
A15C4
A15C5
A15C6
A15CR1
A15CR2
A15CR3
A15CR4
A15CR5
A15CR6
A15CR7
A15CR8
A15CR9
A15CR10
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0698-3434
0757-0400
0757-0418
0698-3440
0757-0280
0757-0280
0698-3136
0757-0401
0757-0418
0757-0440
0698-0085
0698-3438
0757-0439
2100-2633
0757-0420
0757-0440
0757-0447
0757-0447
0757-0465
0757-0465
0757-0465
0698-0083
0757-0279
0757-0402
0757-1438
0698-7212
0698-7212
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
0757-0289
0757-0289
0698-3153
0698-3150
0757-0346
0698-3444
0757-0289
0757-0289
0757-0440
0757-0403
0698-3153
0757-0346
0757-0401
0757-0401
0698-3444
0757-0417
0757-0199
0360-0535
0360-0535
0360-0535
1826-0092
1826-0092
1902-0901
08558-60015
0180-0197
0180-0197
0180-0197
0160-2055
0180-0197
0160-2055
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0535
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
Description
Mfr.
Code
8
0
1
5
6
6
4
6
5
3
7
4
3
4
7
0
8
0
9
3
3
9
7
9
9
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
9
2
2
7
2
1
9
6
2
2
0
1
8
3
2
0
2
9
9
1
1
1
9
8
8
8
3
5
8
8
0
3
0
0
1
3
3
1
1
9
1
33
1
1
1
1
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC-0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 562 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 34.8 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 90.9 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+- 100
RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR-5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB
IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG
IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG
DIODE-ZNR 5.4V 1% DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.046%
VERTICAL DRIVE AND BLANKING
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
30983
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
00000
00000
00000
00000
00000
00000
00000
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
00000
00000
00000
28480
28480
28480
28480
56289
56289
56289
28480
56289
28400
28480
28400
28480
28450
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-24
Mfr Part Number
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
C4-1/8-TO-2371-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-121R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-562R-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-34R8-F
C4-1/8-TO-90R9-F
C4-1/8-TO-619R-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-1782-F
C4-1/8-TO-101-F
C4-1/8-TO-619R-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-2611-F
C4-1/8-TO-147R-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
ET50X102
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
0757-1438
C3-1/8-TO-101R-F
C3-1/8-TO-100R-F
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
1826-0092
1826-0092
1902-0901
08558-00015
150D225X9020A2
150D225X9020A2
150D225X9020A2
0160-2055
150D225X9020A2
0160-2055
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0535
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0050
1901-0050
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A15Q13
A15Q14
A15Q15
A15Q16
A15Q17
A15Q18
A15Q19
A15Q20
A15Q21
A15R1
A15R2
A15R3
A15R4
A15R5
A15R6
A15R7
A15R8
A15R9
A15R10
A15R11
A15R12
A15R13
A15R14
A15R15
A15R16
A15R17
A15R18
A15R19
A15R20
A15R21
A15R22
A15R23
A15R24
A15R25
A15CR11
A15CR12
A15L1
A15L2
A15MP1
A15Q1
A15Q2
A19Q3
A15Q4
A15Q5
A15Q6
A15Q7
A15Q8
A15Q9
A15Q10
A15Q11
A15Q12
A15R26*
A15R27
A15R28
A15R29
A15R30
A15R31
A15R32
A15R33
A15R34
A15R35
A15R36
A15R37
A15R38
A15R39
A15R40
A15R41
A15R42
A15R43
A15R44
A15R45
A15R46
A15R47
A15R48
A15R49
A15R50
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
1854-0404
1854-0475
1854-0404
1853-0007
1855-0049
1854-0404
1855-0417
1854-0404
1855-0020
2100-3123
0757-0199
0757-0420
0757-0280
0757-0279
0698-3156
0757-0444
0757-0424
0698-3156
8757-0199
0698-3155
0757-0416
0683-0475
0757-0424
0757-0199
0757-0199
0757-0280
0698-3155
0698-0084
0757-0416
0683-1055
0757-0442
0757-0465
0757-0442
0757-0199
1901-0050
1901-0518
9140-0179
9140-0179
1200-0173
1853-0007
1854-0234
1854-0234
1854-0009
1854-0404
1854-0234
1854-0234
1853-8007
1854-0019
1854-0039
1853-0451
1853-0451
0698-3153
0698-3440
0698-3440
0757-0279
0698-3156
0757-0444
0698-3444
0757-0424
0698-3156
0757-0279
0757-0200
0757-0465
0757-0199
0698-3444
0757-0394
0698-3155
0757-0416
0757-0442
0698-3444
0757-0837
0757-0844
0698-3440
0757-0420
0757-0844
0698-3440
Description
Mfr.
Code
1
7
3
3
1
7
2
3
0
2
1
7
3
3
0
3
1
0
7
0
8
0
7
0
5
6
9
3
5
9
9
7
3
1
5
7
4
4
1
1
I
3
8
3
7
5
5
4
7
0
4
3
1
0
1
7
6
2
0
2
1
1
7
7
0
9
7
3
5
7
5
7
1
6
7
9
1
4
1
1
1
1
2
2
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG
INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=600MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR-JFET DUAL N-CHAN D-MODE SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.7 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2,15K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-10O
RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=-800/+900
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125WF TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1,1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F T=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 51.1 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W FTC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
28480
28480
28480
04713
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
02111
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
01121
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
01121
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
3L585
3L585
04713
28480
3L585
3L585
04713
28480
3L585
01295
01295
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
28480
24546
24546
28480
24546
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-25
Mfr Part Number
1901-0050
1901-0518
9140-0179
9140-0179
1200-0173
2N3251
2N3440
2N3440
2N709
1854-0404
2N3440
2N3440
2N3251
1854-0019
2N30535
2N3799
2N3799
1854-0404
1854-0475
1854-0404
2N3251
1855-0049
1854-0404
1855--0417
1854-0404
1855-0020
43P501
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-4641-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
CB47G5
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-4641-F
C4-1/8-TO-2151-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
CB1055
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-3831-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-1212-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-5621-F
C4-1/8-TO-1013-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-51R1-F
C4-1/8-TO-4641-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
0757-0837
0757-0844
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
0757-0844
C4-1/8-TO-196R-F
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A16VR3
A16VR4
A16W1
A16W2
A16W3
A16W4
A16XA1 THRU
A16XA6
A16XA7
A16XA8
A16XA9
A16XA10
A16XA11
A16XA12
A16XA13
A16XA14
A16XA15
A17
A17C1
A17C2
A17C3
A17C4
A17C5
A15R51
A15R52
A15R53
A15R54
A15R55
A15R56
A15V1
A15V2
A15VR1
A15VR2
A15VR3
A15TP1 THRU
A15TP8
A16
A16C1
A16C2
A16C3
A16C4
A16C5
A16C6
A16C7
A16C8 THRU
A16C14
A16CR1
A16CR2
A16CR3
A16L1
A16L2
A16L3
A16L4
A16L5
A16MP1
A16MP2
A16R1
A16R2
A16R3
A16R4
A16R5
A16R6
A16R7
A16R8
A16TP1
A16TP2
A16VR1
A16VR2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
0757-0837
0698-3444
0698-3260
0698-3446
0757-0280
0698-7284
1826-0092
1E58-0032
1902-0033
1902-0202
1902-0556
1251-0600
08558-65159
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
0180-0197
0180-0197
0160-3879
0160-2055
1901-0033
1901-0376
1901-0050
9140-0158
9140-0158
9140-0158
9140-0158
9100-2247
08558-20159
0380-0843
0757-0424
0757-0465
0698-5360
2100-1757
0757-0444
0698-3442
0757-0395
0698-3260
1251-0600
1251-0600
1902-0625
1902-0631
1902-0632
1902-3182
08558-60169
08558-60044
08558-60080
08558-60081
HP Part C
Number D Qty
5
3
3
3
6
1
9
8
4
9
6
8
8
7
7
7
7
7
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
9
0
9
1
2
1
5
7
4
7
6
2
6
6
6
6
3
3
0
0
7
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-0472
1251-0472
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-2034
08558-60035
11100-0228
0180-1747
0160-0128
0180-0229
0160-0128
3
7
3
6
6
8
2
6
6
6
6
6
6
4
4
6
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
Description
Mfr.
Code
RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
IC OF AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG
TRANSISTOR ARRAY 14-PIN PLSTC DIP
DIODE-ZNR 1N823 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W
DIODE-ZNR 15V 5% PD=1W 1R=5UA
DIODE-ZNR 20V 5% PD=1W 1R=5UA
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
MOTHERBOARD (INCL W12, W13 & P1) 28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CE.R
28480
2B480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
56289
56289
28480
28480
24546
28480
24546
24546
24546
28480
3L585
24046
28480
28480
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
DIODE-GEN PRP 180V 200MA DO-7
DIODE-GEN PRP 35V 50MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100NH 10% .105DX.26LG
BOARD-MOTHER
STANDOFF-RVT-ON .125-IN-LG 4-40THD
RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.74K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50
RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN
RESISTOR 12.1K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100
RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480
DIODE-ZNR 1N829 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W
DIODE-ZNR 1N5351B 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W
04713
04713
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
00000
24546
24546
28480
28480
24546
24546
24546
DIODE-ZNR 1N5354B 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W
DIODE-ZNR 1N829 12.1V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W
CABLE ASSY-.REAR PANEL INTERCONNECT
CABLE ASSY-YIG DRIVER
CABLE ASSY-SECOND CONVERTER
CABLE ASSY-DPM DRIVER
04713
04713
28480
28480
28480
28480
NOT ASSIGNED
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 6-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 6-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 10-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS
INVERTER
CAPACITOR-FXD 22.UF+-10% 15VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 150UF+-20% 15VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF +-20% 50VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 33UF+-10% 10VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF +-20% 50VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
56289
56289
28480
56289
28480
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-0472
1251-0472
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-1365
1251-2034
08558-60035
150D226X9015B2
150D157X0015
0160-0128
150D336X9010B2
0160-0128
Mfr Part Number
0757-0837
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
0698-3260
C4-1/8-TO-383R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C3-1/8-TO-1003-F
11326-0092
CA3146E
1N823
1902-0202
1902-0556
1251-0600
08558-65159
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
0160-3879
150D225X9020A2
150D225X9020A2
0160-3879
0160-2055
1901-0033
1901-0376
1901-0050
9140-0158
9140-0158
9140-0158
9140-0158
9100-2247
08558-20159
ORDER BY DESCRIPTION
C4-1/8-TO-1101-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
0698-5368
2100-1757
C4-1/8-TO-1212--F
C4-1/8-TO-237R-F
C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F
0698-3260
1251-0600
1251-0600
1N829
1N5351B
1N5354B
1902-3182
08558-60169
08558-60044
08558-60080
08558-60081
See introduction to this section for ordering information ,
*Indicates factory selected value
6-26
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A17C6
A17CR1
A17CR2
A17CR3
A17CR4
A17CR5
A17CR6
A17CR7
A17CR8
A17L1
A17L2
A17L3
A17L4
A17L5
A17L6
A17L7
A17L8
A17NP1
A17MP2
A17MP3
A17Q1
A17Q2
A17R1*
A17R2
A17T1
A17VR1
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0180-1714
1901-0620
1901-0620
1901--0620
1901-0620
1901-0620
1901-0620
1901-0620
1901-0620
9100-2552
08558-80010
9100-1618
9100-2552
9100-2552
9140-0096
08558-80007
08558-80007
7100-0529
7100-0530
08558-00049
1854-0039
1854-0039
0757-0459
0757-0180
08558-80006
1902-0551
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
6
7
3
3
3
3
3
1
4
4
5
4
3
3
3
7
7
8
2
9
2
2
1
0
0
9
1
Description
CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX .385LG
COIL, FILTER, ORANGE, 500 UH
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 5.6UH 10%
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG
INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10% .166DX.385LG
COIL, FILTER, GREEN, 150 UH
COIL, FILTER, GREEN, 150 UH
COVER
CAN
INSULATOR, INVERTER
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W
RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
TRANSFORMER, INVERTER
DIODE-ZNR 6.2V 5% PD=1W 1R=10UA
Mfr.
Code
56289
9N171
9N171
9N171
9N171
9N171
9N171
9N171
9N171
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
3L585
3L585
24546
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
150D337X9006S2
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
NDP250
9100-2552
08550-80010
9100-1618
9100-2552
9100-2552
9140-0096
08558-80007
08558-80007
7100-0529
7100-0530
0855EI-00049
2N3053S
2N3053S
C4-1/8-TO-5622-F
0757-0100
08558-80006
1902-0551
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
6-27
V1
W1
W1
W2
W3
W4
W5
W6
W7
W8
W8
W9
W10
W11
W12
W13
W14
W15
W16
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts
HP Part C
Number D
11593A
1250-0780
5020-8565
5020-8566
5020-8567
08558-60131
7
0
7
5
9
9
5086-7282
08558-60031
08558-60038
08558-20071
08558-20090
08558-20073
08558-60047
08558-60048
08558-60046
08558-60074
1
8
5
7
5
4
6
9
2
5
08557-60045 3
08558-20117
08558-20116
08558-60170
7
6
6
Qty
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Description
Mfr.
Code
1
1
1
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
Mfr Part Number
ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED
TERMINATION-50 OHM
ADAPTER, TYPE N MALE TO BNC FEMAL.E
CRT-OVERLAY, 180-SERIES DISPLAYS
CRT-OVERLAY, 181-SERIES DISPLAYS
CRT-OVERLAY, 182-SERIES DISPLAYS
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480 SIDE STOP KIT
ELECTRICAL CHASSIS PARTS
LIMITER, RF INPUT,THRESH=1MW; MAX 10W,2WDC 28480
11593A
1250-0780
5020-8565
5020-8566
5020-8567
08558-60131
CABLE ASSY-750 OHM INPUT(OPT.001,002)
CABLE ASSY-50 OHM INPUT(STD. SEE FIG.6-1)
NOT ASSIGNED
CABLE ASSY-1ST LO OUTPUT
CABLE ASSY-YIG OSC TO FIRST CONVERTER
28480
28480
28480
28480
CABLE ASSY-FIRST CONVERTER TO SECOND CON 28480
CABLE ASSY-SECOND CONVERTER TO SECOND IF 28480
CABLE ASSY-SECOND IF TO THIRD CONVERTER
CABLE ASSY-50-OHM CAL OUTPUT (STD)
CABLE ASSY-75-OHM CAL OUTPUT(OPT.001/002
28480
28480
28480
5086-7282
08558-60031
08558-60038
08558-20071
08558-20090
08558-20073
08558-60047
08558-60048
08558-60046
08558-60074
NOT ASSIGNED
CABLE ASSY-VERT. OUTPUT(ON TOP GUIDE RAIL 28480 08557-60045
NOT ASSIGNED
NOT ASSIGNED
NOT ASSIGNED
CABLE ASSY-ATTEN TO LIMITER
CABLE ASSY-LIMITER TO FIRST CONVERTER
CABLE ASSY- PROBE POWER
28480
28480
28480
08558-20117
08558-20116
08558-60170
6-28
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Reference
Designation
7
8
9
10
3
4
5
6
1
2
11
12
13
HP Part C
Number D Qty
08558-20080
08558-20079
3050-0253
08558-60127
08558-20077
08558-20076
5040-0306
1250-0915
1250-0914
0160-3344
08558-20101
1250-0505
7
1
0
8
9
5
3
8
7
3
0
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Description
Assy: Cable (Includes W1P1)
Shell: Type-N Capacitor
Washer: Spring
Blocking Capacitor Assy
Dielectric
Conductor: Inner Type-N
Capacitor Insulator
Contact: RF Connector
Body: RF Connector
Capacitor: 0.12
æF 50 Vdc
Dielectric
24 AWG Wire
RF Connector: 75 ohm
(separate white teflon dielectric supplied with connector and pin is not used)
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
28480
28480
28480
28480
28280
28480
28480
02660
02660
28480
28480
08558-20080
08558-20079
3050-0253
08558-60127
08558-20077
08558-20076
5040-0306
131-149
131-150
0160-3344
08558-20101
28480 1250-0505
Figure 6-1. Cable Assembly W1 (08558-60038 or 08558-60031) Replaceable Parts
6-29/6-30(blank)
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
6-31 through 6-33
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION VII.
MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES
7-1. INTRODUCTION
7-2. This section contains information for adapting this manual to earlier 8558B Spectrum Analyzers. If the serial number prefix of your spectrum analyzer appears on the title page of this manual, the contents of the manual are directly applicable to your instrument. If, however, your spectrum analyzer has a lower serial number prefix than what is shown on the title page, you must adapt this manual to your instrument by changing it as indicated in this section.
7-3. To adapt this manual to your instrument, refer to
Table 7-1 and make all the manual changes listed
opposite your instrument serial number. Make the changes in the sequence in which they are given.
7-4. If your instrument serial number is not listed on the
title page of this manual, or in Table 7-1 below, it may
be documented in a yellow MANUAL CHANGES supplement. For additional important information about serial number coverage, refer to INSTRUMENTS
COVERED BY MANUAL in Section I.
NOTE
In instruments with serial numbers
listed in Table 7-1, some parts have
part numbers that are different from those listed in the Replaceable Parts
list (Table 6-3) of this manual. Unless
otherwise indicated by the ‘change' instructions in this section, however, the listed parts are the recommended replacement parts.
Table 7-1. Manual Change Requirements by Serial Number
Serial Number, Prefix or Complete Number Make Manual Changes:
2145A A
2142A A, B
2118A A,B,C
2024A06643 thru -06691, and 2024A06731 to, but A, B, C, D not including, prefix 2118A
2024A prefix with suffixes thru 06642 A, B, C, D, E
1926A prefixes and 1914A with suffixes 04747,04918, A, B, C, D, E, F
04993,05158,05160, 05172, 05228,05229,05252,
05281,05297, 05300, thru 05307,05311,05312,
05313,05316,05318,05320
1914A with suffixes other than those listed above A, B, C, D, E, F, G
7-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS
CHANGE A
Page 6-31, Figure 6-2, Mechanical Chassis Parts:
Substitute Figure 7-1 (CHANGE A) of this section for Figure 6-2.
Page 6-33, Figure 6-3, Front Panel Assembly:
Substitute Figure 7-2 (CHANGE A) in this section for Figure 6-3.
Page 8-26, Figure 8-12, Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 Component Locations:
Page 8-27, Figure 8-13, Front Switch Assembly A2 Schematic Diagram:
Substitute Figure 7-3 of this section for Figure 8-13.
General:
the operation booklet, 8558B Spectrum Analyzer Operation, change front panel PUSH TO LOCK to LOCK (rotate clockwise to lock 8558B into mainframe).
Change description of OPTIMUM INPUT (changed from INPUT ATTEN) control function to read: 'The optimum and maximum input level selected is designated by the pointer behind the control. Push in control knob and turn it to select the required input level range.
Use table below to translate input attenuation levels given in manual to optimum input levels.
INPUT
ATTEN (dB)
OPTIMUM
INPUT
OPTION
001
OPTION
002
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
-40 dBm
-30 dBm
-20 dBm
-10 dBm
0 dBm
10 dBm
20 dBm
30 dBm
-35 dBm
-25 dBm
-15 dBm
-5 dBm
5 dBm
15 dBm
25 dBm
30 dBm
15 dBmV
25 dBmV
35 dBmV
45 dBmV
55 dBmV
65 dBmV
75 dBmV
80 dBmV
CHANGE B
steps in Log mode.
Affects adjustment of LOG/LIN.
7-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)
CHANGE B (Cont'd)
Page 5-45, Paragraph 5-26, Figure 5-13:
Substitute paragraph 7-6, LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE
B) in this section for paragraph 5-26, and Figure 7-4 (CHANGE B) for Figure 5-13.
Pages 6-21 through 6-24, Table 6-3:
of this section.
Page 6-31, Figure 6-2, Mechanical Chassis Parts:
Change item 30 to HP Part Number 08558-00086, Check Digit 7.
Page 8-84, Figure 8-37, A14 Log Amplifier Component and Test Point Locations:
Replace Figure 8-37 with Figure 7-5 (CHANGE B) of this section.
Pages 8-85/8-86 and 8-87/8-88, Figure 8-38, A14 Log Amplifier Schematic:
Replace Figure 8-38 with Figure 7-6 (2 sheets) (CHANGE B) of this section.
CHANGE C
Under Calibrator Output, change '
±
300 kHz' to '
±
50 kHz.'
Under Cal Output, change text to read as follows:
'-30 dBm, 280 MHz with 2nd through 5th harmonics greater than -60 dBm.
002: + 20 dBm V, 280 MHz with 2nd through 5th harmonics greater than - 10 dBm V.'
Change A9C5 to HP Part Number 0150-2251, Check Digit 6, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD 5.6PF
±
.25PF.
Delete A9C20
Add A9Y1, HP Part Number 0410-0447, Check Digit 0, Qty 1, CRYSTAL-QUARTZ
FREQ = 280 MHz 11th OVERTONE.
Delete A9Z 1.
Replace Figure 8-25 with Figure 7-7 (CHANGE C) of this section.
Replace function block A with function block A shown in Figure 7-8 (CHANGE C) of this section.
CHANGED
Change A11C14 to HP Part Number 0160-2253, Check Digit 9, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD
6.8PF
±
.25PF 500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2253.
Change A11C37 to HP Part Number 0160-2252, Check Digit 8, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD
6.2PF
±
.25PF 500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2252.
7-3
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)
CHANGE D (Cont'd)
Pages 6-18, and 6-19, Table 6-3:
Change A13C14 to HP Part Number 0160-2253, Check Digit 9, Qty 1, CAPACITOR- FXD 6.8PF .25PF
500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2253.
Change A13C37 to HP Part Number 0160-2252, Check Digit 8, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD 6.2PF .25PF 500VDC
CER, 28480, 0160-2252.
Page 8-69, Figure 8-30, A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Schematic:
Page 8-79, Figure 8-35, A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Schematic:
Change value of C14 to 6.8PF, and value of C37 to 6.2PF.
CHANGE E
Delete A16C9 and A16C10.
Delete C9 and C10.
CHANGE F
Change A9R14 to A9R25.
Pages 6-12 and 6-13, Table 6-3:
Delete A9C17, A9C18, A9C19, A9CR7, A9L15, and A9L16.
Change A9R12* (standard instrument) to HP Part Number 0698-3132, Check Digit 4, Qty 1, RESISTOR 261 1%
.125W F TC=0
±
100, 24546, C4-1/8-TO-2610-F.
Change A9R14* to A9R14, HP Part Number 0757-0462, Check Digit 3, Qty 1, RESISTOR 75K 1% .125W F TC
= 0
±
100, 24546, C4-1/8-TO-7502-F.
Change A9R25 to A9R25*.
Replace Figure 8-25 with Figure 7-9 of this section.
Replace circuit descriptions for 21.4 MHz Amplifier (E) and PIN Driver (F) with the circuit descriptions provided below.
21.4 MHz Amplifier E
The 21.4 MHz Amplifier consists of A9Q3 in a common-emitter configuration and A9Q4 as an emitter follower.
Transistor A9Q3 employs resistor A9R12 and zener diode A9VR2 to furnish base bias and negative feedback for gain control and stabilization. Resistor A9R12 is factory selected to provide the proper gain of the third converter assembly. Capacitor A9C14 is connected across A9VR2 to reduce zener noise. The output of the 21.4 MHz
Amplifier looks into a voltage-controlled attenuator consisting of two PIN diodes, A9CR3 and CR4, resistor
A9R25, and the input impedance of the A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1.
7-4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)
CHANGE F (Cont'd)
PIN Driver (F)
The PIN diode resistance of A9CR3 and CR4 is controlled by the PIN driver A9Q5 and its associated circuitry.
The base of A9Q5 is the summing point for the frequency analog voltage from the A7 Frequency Control and a dc level set by the front-panel REF LEVEL CAL screwdriver adjustment A2R3. Setting the dc level by adjusting
A2R3 calibrates the 8558B display at a given frequency, usually performed at 280 MHz. The frequency analog voltage is a dc level varying from + 0.6 volts to + 6.7 volts as a function of frequency. This frequency analog voltage at the base of A9Q5 compensates for input mixer response. SLOPE COMP adjustment A9R1 sets the amount of compensation required for a flat frequency response. The total current through the PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4 is shaped by the emitter network of A9Q5. This network provides a change in current through the PIN diodes to cause a change of PIN diode resistance. The change in resistance is required to provide the proper log curve within an 8 dB range for the voltage-controlled attenuator.
Replace function block E and F with function blocks E and F shown in Figure 7-10 (CHANGE F).
CHANGE G
Change item 53 HP Part Number to 08558-20052, Check Digit 9.
Change item 57 on HP Part Number 08552-20053, Check Digit 0.
7-5
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A1
A1MP1
A1MP2
A1MP3
A1MP4
A1MP5
A1MP6
A1MP7
A1IMP8
A1MP9 THRU
A1MP16
A1MP17 THRU
A1MP20
A1MP21 THRU
A1MP24
A1MP25 THRU
A1MP28
A1A1
A1A1DS1
A1A1DS2
A1A1DS3
A1A1DS4
A1A1W1
A1A1XDS1
A1A1XDS2
A1A1XDS3
A1A1XDS4
Table 7-2. Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)
HP Part C
Number D Qty
08558-00090
08558-00091
08558-20130
08558-20130
2200-0107
2200.0107
2200-0107
2200-0107
0520-0174 3
6
6
6
4
4
3
4
6
1
1
2
4
1
8
Description
DIGITAL PANEL METER ASSEMBLY
BRACKET, LEFT-HAND
BRACKET, RIGHT-HAND
DPM DISPLAY MOUNT
DPM DISPLAY MOUNT
SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 2-56 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
0610-0001
2190-0890
3050-0098
08558-60124
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
1990-0619
08558-60130
1200-0693
1200-0693
1200-0693
1200-0693
6
7
7
7
0
7
6
1
8
4
4
4
4
1
4
4
1
4
4
4
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 2-56-THD.062-IN-THK
WASHER-LK MTCL NO. 2.088-IN-ID
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 2.094-IN-ID
DPM DISPLAY
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H
CABLE ASSY RIBBON, DPM
SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR
SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR
SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR
SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR
Mfr.
Code
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Mfr Part Number
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
08558-00090
08558-00090
08558-20130
08558-20130
2200-0107
2200-0107
2200-0107
2200-0107
0520-0174
28480 0610-0001
28480 2190-0890
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
51167
51167
51167
51167
3050-0098
08558-60124
5082-7613
5082-7613
5082-7613
5082-7613
08558-60130
10-513-11
10-513-11
10-513-11
10-513-11
7-6
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
P1
R1
R2
R3
R4
R5
R6
S1
U1
W1
W1
W2
W3
W4
W5
W6
W7
W8
W8
W9
W10
W11
W12
W13
W14
W15
Reference
Designation
AT1
Table 7-3. Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)
7
5
4
6
9
4
2
2
5
5
8
7
6
3
7
4
1
1
1
0
1
8
8
4
08558-60117
2100-3593
2100-3452
2100-3066
2100-0542
2100-3317
2100-3317
3101.0044
5086-7282
08558-60038
08558-60031
08558-20071
08558-20090
08558-20073
08558-20047
08558-20048
08558-20046
08558-20074
08558-60037
08558-60043
08558-60044
08558-60080
08558-20117
08558-20116
HP Part C
Number D Qty
11593A
1250-0780
5020-8565
5020-8566
5020-8567
08558-60131
7
5
7
8
9
9
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
Description
Mfr.
Code
ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED
TERMINATION, 50 OHM
ADAPTER, TYPE N MALE TO BNC FEMALE
OVERLAY, 180 SERIES SCOPES
OVERLAY, 181 SERIES SCOPES
OVERLAY, 182 SERIES SCOPES
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480 KIT, SIDE STOP
CHASSIS PARTS
REAR-PANEL INTERCONNECT (PREWIRED)
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 10K 10%
RESISTOR-VAR PREC WW 10-TRN 5K 5%
RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN
RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20% 10CW
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20% 10CW 28480
SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN 28480
28480 LIMITER, RF INPUT
CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF(SEE FIG. 6-1)
CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF (OPT. 001/002)
NOT ASSIGNED
CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, L.O.
CABLE ASSY, INPUT, 1ST L.O.
28480
28480
28480
28480
CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, 1ST I.F.
CABLE ASSY, INPUT, 2ND I.F.
CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, 2ND I.F.
CABLE ASSY, CAL OUTPUT
CABLE ASSY, CAL OUTPUT (OPT. 001/002)
CABLE ASSY, INTERCONNECT
CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, VERTICAL
NOT ASSIGNED
CABLE ASSY, YIG DRIVER
CABLE ASSY, SECOND CONVERTER
CABLE ASSY, ATTENUATOR TO LIMITER
CABLE ASSY, LIMITER TO FIRST CONVERTER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
11593A
1250-0780
5020-8565
5020-8565
5020-8567
08558-60131
08558-60117
2100-3593
2100-3452
2100-3066
2100-0542
2100-3317
2100-3317
3101-0044
5086-7282
08558-60038
08558-60031
08558-20071
08558-20090
08558-20073
08558-60047
08558-60048
08558-60046
08558-60074
08558-60037
08558-60043
08558-60044
08558-60080
08558-20117
08558-20116
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
7-7
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
29
30
31
32
33
24
25
26
27
28
19
20
21
22
23
34
35
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
8
9
6
7
10
11
3
4
5
1
2
Reference
Designation
08558-20092
08558-20030
08558-20041
08558-20027
0624-0203
2200-0055
2200-0104
2360-0210
0624-0268
0624-0206
2200-0103
2360-0115
2200-0170
0380-0006
2260-0003
2200-0107
2200-0164
2200-0168
08558-00086
08558-00089
08558-00088
08558-00087
08565-20096
08565-20093
HP Part C
Number
08558-00002
08558-00004
08558-00005
08558-00003
08558-20039
08558-20040
08558-20037
08558-20036
08558-20051
08558-20038
08558-40015
D
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
9
7
5
0
1
6
0
8
2
7
9
0
9
9
7
8
7
2
3
2
5
0
7
2
2
4
0
6
6
8
9
3
3
7
1
Qty
4
40
1
4
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
8
1
17
7
2
1
3
1
1
1
1
Description
MECHANICAL CHASSIS PARTS
PANEL, FRONT, SUP
GUSSET, LEFT
GUSSET, RIGHT
PANEL, REAR
GUIDE RAIL, LEFT
GUIDE RAIL, RIGHT
EXTRUSION, END PLATE ENCLOSURE
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED (4)
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE
EXTRUSION, ENCLOSURE DIVIDER
HOUSlNG, LATCH (FOR INSTRUMENTS WITH
SERIAL PREFIX 13344 & BELOW, SEE
SECTION VII
SHIFT, LATCH
INSULATOR, BOTTOM GUIDE RAIL
GUIDE RAIL, BOTTOM
BOARD, VERTICAL OUTPUT CONNECTOR
SCREW-TPG 4-40 .375-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .125-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .625-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-TPG 4-24 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-TPG 6-32 .25.-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI STL
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .31 2-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .625.-IN-LG 82 DEG
SPACER-RND .375-IN-LG .18-IN-ID
NUT.HEX-PLSTC LKG 4-40-THD .141-IN.-THK
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .375IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .188-IN.LG UNCT 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .438-IN-LG 82 DEG
COVER, LOG AMPLIFIER
COVER, BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1
COVER, STEP GAIN
COVER, BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE,TAPPED (8)
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE,TAPPED (4)
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28280
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Figure 7-1. Mechanical Chassis Parts (1 of 2) (CHANGE A)
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
08558-00002
08558-00004
08558-00005
08558-00003
08558-20039
08558-20040
08558-20037
08558-20036
08558-20051
08558-20038
08558-40015
08558-20092
08558-00030
08558-20041
08558-20027
0624-0203
2200-0055
2200-0104
2360-0210
0624-0268
0624-0206
2200-0103
2360-0115
2200-0170
0380-0006
2260-0003
2200-0107
2200-0164
2200-0168
08558-00086
08558-00089
08558-00088
08558-00087
08565-20096
08565-20093
7-8
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-1. Mechanical Chassis Parts (2 of 2) (CHANGE A)
7-9
66
67
68
69
35
36
37
38
32
32
33
34
28
29
30
31
24
25
26
27
43
44
45
46
47
39
40
41
42
60
61
62
63
56
57
58
59
52
53
54
55
48
49
50
51
11
12
13
14
7
8
9
10
4
5
6
6
3
4
1
2
19
20
21
22
23
15
16
17
18
64
65
70
71
72
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
TM 11-6625-3061-14
HP Part C
Number
0610-0002
08558-20002
08558-40005
3050-0017
1460-0532
2200-0165
08558-00020
08558-20061
08558-20062
08558-20052
2260-0002
0380-0413
08558-00022
08558-20053
1490-0841
2950-0006
2190-0027
08558-00021
2190-0019
08558-20054
1430-0036
08558-00036
3030-0007
0510-0089
08558-00017
08558-00055
3050-0032
08558-60050
08558-60072
3030-0022
08558-00043
08558-00018
08558-00038
08558-60051
00180-67402
08558-00043
08558-40003
2950-0043
2190-0016
1410-0721
08558-40001
2200-0781
08558-00019
0380-0411
08558-20047
08558-20051
1410-0006
1460-0578
08559-60060
1480-0367
1480-0059
08558-40011
08558-40008
0510-0015
08558-60046
08558-60074
2200-0509
2200-0125
08558-00024
08558-20050
08558-20066
08558-20089
1460-1376
08558-20088
0520-0139
0380-0487
08558-00081
3050-0105
08558-20030
2200-0143
08558-40004
08558-00025
D Qty Description
FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLY
Mfr.
Code
7
3
1
0
1
9
6
5
6
0
6
1
9
0
0
6
7
9
4
9
6
2
6
0
3
2
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
3
4
3
0
1
4
1
1
1
1
18
3
6
1
1
1
1
4
2
1
3
3
3
2
8
2
6
4
0
8
3
4
1
8
4
1
2
2
8
1
2
9
6
2
5
9
4
9
0
8
1
7
8
4
7
5
3
3
14
4
1
9
13
1
1
6
1
6
5
10
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
10
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
33
1
1
1
4
1
2
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
KNOB,REF LEVEL FINE
SCREW-SET 4-40 .125-IN-LG SMALL CUP-PT
RETAINER-RING BSC EXT .188-IN-DIA BE-CU
DISC, INDEX
DISC, INDEX (OPTION 002)
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 8 .189-IN-ID
KNOB, REF LEVEL
KNOB, REF LEVEL (OPTION 002)
SCREW-SET 6-32 .125-IN-LG SMALL CUP-PT
NUT
POINTER, ATTENUATOR
KNOB, DIAL, RESOLUTION
KNOB, FREQUENCY
KNOB, FINE TUNING
KNOB, COARSE TUNING
WINDOW, DBM
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK
WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID
BUSHING PNL .265-ID .47-LG 3/8-32-THD
SLIDER, REF LEVEL
SCREW-MACH 4-40 2.75-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
DETENT, ATTENUATOR
SPACER-RND .5-IN-LG .114-IN-ID
BUSHING, PANEL
SHAFT, REF LEVEL
BALL-BRG TYPE .1875-DIA GRADE-50 SST
SPRING-CPRSN .18-IN-OD .312-IN-DA-LG MUW
HUB ASSEMBLY
PIN-DWL ANSI-UNHDND/GND .0625-IN-DIA
PIN-ROLL .062-IN-DIA .25-IN-LG STL
ROTOR, ATTENUATOR DRIVE
GEAR, 45 TEETH
RETAINER-RING E-R EXT .125-IN-DIA STL
CABLE, CAL OUTPUT
CABLE, CAL OUTPUT, 75 OHM (OPT. 001/002)
SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.625-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
DETENT, SWEEP TIME
SHAFT, SWEEP WIDTH
ROTOR, FREQUENCY SPAN
BUSHING, SLOTTED
SPRING-TRSN MUW
GEAR, 20 TEETH
SCREW-MACH 2-56 .875-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SPACER-RND .625-IN-LG .086-IN-ID
NOT ASSIGNED
NUT, HEX-BL-CHAM 2-56-THD .062-IN-LG
BOARD, FRONT SWITCH
ROTOR, DOUBLE CONTACT
WASHER-FL MTLC ¼ IN .26-IN-ID
SPRING-CPRSN .54-IN-OD .45-IN-DA-LG MUW
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG
DETENT, IF GAIN
LOCKOUT, ROTATING
LOCKOUT, FIXED
SHAFT, FIXED
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 4-40-THD .062-IN-THK
SPACER-RND 1.25-IN-LG .114-IN-ID
CRANK, SLOTTED
SHAFT, REF LEVEL FINE
COUPLER-RGD .375-LG BRS
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ¼-32-THD .094-IN-THK
WASHER-LK INTL T ¼ IN .256-IN-ID
PLATE, LEVEL POT
WASHER-LK HLCL NO. 4 .115-IN-ID
SHAFT, ATTENUATOR DRIVE
GEAR-MIT 16-T 32-DP 20-DEG PA BRS
NOT ASSIGNED
BRACKET, ATTENUATOR
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID
NOT ASSIGNED
BOARD, REAR SWITCH
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
ROTOR, SINGLE CONTACT
DETENT, BANDWIDTH
Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (1 of 3) (CHANGE A)
7-10
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
Mfr Part Number
08558-00036
3030-0007
0510-0089
08558-00017
08558-00055
3050-0032
08558-60050
08558-60072
3030-0022
08558-00043
08558-00018
08558-00038
08558-60051
00180-67402
08558-00043
08558-40003
2950-0043
2190-0016
1410-0721
08558-40001
2200-0781
08558-00019
0380-0411
08558-20047
08558-20051
1410-0006
1460-0578
08559-60060
1480-0367
1480-0059
08558-40011
08558-40008
0510-0015
08558-60046
08558-60074
2200-0509
2200-0125
08558-00024
08558-20050
08558-20066
08558-20089
1460-1376
08558-20088
0520-0139
0380-0487
0610-0002
08558-20002
08558-40005
3050-0017
1460-0532
2200-0165
08558-00020
08558-20061
08558-20062
08558-20052
2260-0002
0380-0413
08558-00022
08558-20053
1490-0841
2950-0006
2190-0027
08558-00021
2190-0019
08558-20054
G462Y (MOD)
08558-00081
3050-0105
08558-20030
2200-0143
08558-40004
08558-00025
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
7-11 through 7-14
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B)
REFERENCE
A14 and A15 Schematics
DESCRIPTION
10 dB/DIV and LIN are adjusted for correct steps and full-screen display translations.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-4. Log Amplifier Log and Linear Adjustment Test Setup (CHANGE B)
EQUIPMENT
Signal Generator.......................................................................................................................HP 8640B
Digital Voltmeter......................................................................................................... HP 34740A/34702A
10 dB Attenuator.................................................................................................... HP 8491A, Option 010
Step Attenuator (10 dB/step).......................................................................................................HP 355D
Adapter, Type N Male on one end,
BNC Female on other end (2 required)..........................................................................HP 1250-0780
Adapter, Type N Female on both ends................................................................................HP 1250-0777
Adapter, Type N Male on one end,
SMC Male on other end................................................................................................HP 1250-1023
7-15
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)
PROCEDURE
1.
Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:
FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................300 kHz
OPTIMUM INPUT .......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm
001: - 25 dBm
002: + 25 dBm V
REFERENCE LEVEL dBm..................................................................................................................- 50
002: 0 dBm V
10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN...................................................................................................................LIN
SWEEP TIME/DIV ..........................................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................FREE RUN
2.
dBm. Remove W7P1 from Second IF assembly A10J2. Connect signal generator output through step attenuator, 0 dB attenuator, and adapters to W7P1.
NOTE
The 10 dB attenuator is included to compensate for the 10 dB of gain on A12 Step
Gain assembly when the TEST-NORM switch is in TEST.
3.
Set the TEST-NORM switch on A12 Step Gain assembly to the TEST position. Tune signal generator frequency for maximum signal amplitude on oscilloscope display with step attenuator set at 0 dB.
4.
Set output level of signal generator for
REFERENCE LEVEL control set to - 50 dBm.
002: 0 dBm V
5.
Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to - 80 dBm and set step attenuator to 30 dB. Observe digital voltmeter reading.
002: - 30 dBm V
6.
Adjust A14R3 LIN GAIN for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV.
7.
Repeat steps 4, 5, and 6 until the DVM reading in step 5 is 700 +2 . mV.
8.
Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to -50 dBm and set step attenuator to 0 dB. Change REFERENCE LEVEL and s
A14R3.
002: Set REFERENCE LEVEL dBm V to 0 and set attenuator to 0 dB. REFERENCE
LEVEL (dBmV) settings in Table 5-7 top to bottom are, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40.
7-16
Model 8558B
ADJUSTMENTS
7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)
Table 7-4. Linear Gain Adjustment Limits
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Reference Level
(dBm)
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
Step Attenuator
Setting (dB)
0
10
20
30
40
Deviation From
Reference
Reference
±
0.2 DIV
±
20 mV
±
0.2 DIV
±
20 mV
±
0.2 DIV
±
20 mV
±
0.3 DIV
±
30 mV
9.
Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to 0 dBm and disconnect signal generator from step attenuator. Record offset reading (DVM). The offset should be less than + 30 mV.
002: REFERENCE LEVEL, +50 dBm V
attenuator to 40 dB.
sum). (Example: If offset is - 23 mV, set output level of signal generator for a DVM reading of 377 mV.) reading is not within limits, adjust A14R2 LOG/LIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV, plus offset minus 50 percent of overshoot. Example: If DVM indicates 767 mV and should be indicating 777 mV (-10 mV overshoot), adjust A14R2 for a DVM reading of 777 mV minus - 5 mV, or 782 mV.
of A14R2 in step 12.
DVM readings by algebraically adding the offset (recorded in step 9).
15. Readjust A14R2 if necessary to meet the limits in Table 7-5.
16. Set step attenuator to 0 dB and set output level of signal generator for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV plus offset (recorded in step 9)
±
1 mV.
mV. If it does, go to step 19. If it does not, or if log fidelity is not within limits, go to step 18 and select A14R16*.
7-17
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)
Table 7-5. Log Fidelity Check
DVM Reading Corrected For Offset
Step Attenuator
Setting (dB)
40
50
60
70
0
10
20
30
DVM Reading
(mV)
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
Min. (mV)
799
697
596
496
395
294
193
92
Actual (mV)
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
_______________
Max. (mV)
801
703
604
504
405
306
207
108
18. Select A14R16* to obtain an output in step 17 within 25 mV of the reading set in step 16. Decreasing A14R16* 10 percent will increase the DVM reading approximately 30 mV in step 17.
NOTE
Log fidelity must be considered when selecting A14R16*. That is, if the DVM
READING CORRECTED FOR OFFSET in Table 7-5 is greater than 100 mV for a
STEP ATTENUATOR SETTING of 70 dB, A14R16* should be selected for a DVM reading greater than the reading set in step 16. If the READING CORRECTED FOR
OFFSET is less than 100 mV, A14R16* should be selected for DVM reading less than the reading set in step 16.
20. Set 8558B 10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN switch to 10 dB/DIV and adjust A14R2 LOG/LIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV plus offset.
21. Repeat step 14 to recheck the log fidelity.
002: 0 dBm V
23. Set the step attenuator to 0 dB and set output level of signal generator for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV (do not include offset).
24. Set the 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL dBm control to -90 and the step attenuator to 40 dB. Adjust A14RI LOG GAIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV.
002: - 40 dBm V
7-18
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ADJUSTMENTS
7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)
not exceed the given limits.
002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBmV) settings, top to bottom are, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40.
26. Return the TEST-NORM switch on A12 assembly to the NORM position.
Table 7-6. Log Gain Adjustment Limits
Reference Level Step Attenuator Deviation From
(dBm) Setting (dB) Reference
-50 0 Reference
-60 10
±
0.3 DIV
±
30 mV
-70 20 ±
0.3 DIV
±
30 mV
-80 30 ±
0.3 DIV
±
30 mV
-90 40
±
0.3 DIV
±
30 mV
7-19
Reference
Designation
A14C17
A14C18*
A14C19
A14C20
A14C21
A14C22
A14C23
A14C24
A14C25
A14C26
A14C27
A14C28
A14C29
A14C30*
A14C31
A14C32
A14C33
A14C34
A14C35
A14C36
A14C37
A14C38
A14C39
A14C40*
A14C41
A14C42
A14C43
A14C44
A14C45
A14C46
A14C47
A14C48
A14C49
A14C50
A14C51
A14C52*
A14C53
A14C54
A14C55
A14C56
A14C57*
A14C58
A14C59
A14C60
A14C61
A14C62
A14C63
A14C64
A14C65
A14C66
A14C67
A14C68
A14C69
A14C70
A14
A14C1
A14C2
A14C3
A14C4
A14C5
A14C6
A14C7
A14C8
A14C9
A14C10
A14C11
A14C12
A14C13
A14C14
A14C15
A14C16
Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (1 of 4) (CHANGE B)
HP Part C
Number D Qty Description
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
0160-2055
0160-2234
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-0228
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
08565-60111
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2256
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-0195
0160-2055
0160-2308
0160-2240
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
9
9
8
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
8
9
9
9
6
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
8
9
6
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
4
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
5
4
9
9
2
9
9
9
9
8
9
9
9
2
9
9
9
9
8
9
9
9
9
9
1
59
7
1
1
5
1
1
1
LOG AMPLIFIER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .51PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 22UF +-10% 15VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
NOT ASSIGNED
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 9.1PF +-.2PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 36PF +-5% 500VDC MICA
CAPACITOR-FXD 2PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +0-.25PF 500VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2256
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
DM15F131J0300WV1CR
0160-2055
0160-2308
0160-2240
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
7-20
08565-60111
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-2055
0160-3459
0160-3459
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
150D226X901582
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2236
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
Model 8558B
A14CR26
A14CR27
A14CR28
A14CR29
A14CR30
A14CR31
A14CR32
A14E1
A14L1
A14L2
A14L3
A14L4
A14L5
A14L6
A14L7
A14L8
A14L9
A14L10
A14L11
A14L12
A14L13
A14L14
A14Q1
A14Q2
A14Q3
A14Q4
A14Q5
A14Q6
A14Q7
A14Q8
A14Q9
A14Q10
A14Q11
A14Q12
A14Q13
A14Q14
A14Q15
A14Q16
A14Q17
A14Q18
A14Q19
A14Q20
Reference
Designation
A14C71
A14C72
A14C73
A14C74
A14C75
A14C76
A14C77
A14C78
A14CR1
A14CR2
A14CR3
A14CR4
A14CR5
A14CR6
A14CR7
A14CR8
A14CR9
A14CR10
A14CR11
A14CR12
A14CR13
A14CR14
A14CR15
A14CR16
A14CR17
A14CR18
A14CR19
A14CR20
A14CR21
A14CR22
A14CR23
A14CR24
A14CR25
TM 11-6625-3061-14
2
2
2
2
4
2
2
7
3
2
7
3
3
3
3
7
2
1
0
1
1
3
8
6
6
8
1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
7
8
7
5
1901-0047
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0047
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
9170-0029
9100-1622
9100-0105
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1627
9100-1629
9100-1622
9100-1619
9140-0145
9100-2269
1854-0071
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1853-0020
1853-0007
1853-0345
1853-0015
1854-0475
Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (2 of 4) (CHANGE B)
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0180-2206
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
0180-0197
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-1085
6
6
1
1
6
6
6
6
6
1
1
1
9
9
9
4
9
8
9
9
1
6
6
6
9
6
9
6
8
1
6
6
6
1
5
17
17
3
2
Description
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20, 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD 60UF+ -10% 6VDC TA
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER
CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CE
CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+ -10% 20VDC TA
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-PIN 110V
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
Mfr.
Code
28480
28480
28080
56289
28480
28480
28480
56280
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
284080
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
1
2
1
7
1
1
1
0
3
15
2
4
1
1
2
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SCHOTTKY
DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35
DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35
CORE-SHIELDING READ
COIL-MLD 24AUH 5% Q=60 .155DX .375L-NOM
COIL-MLD 8.2UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 39UH 5% Q=60 .155DX.375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 47UH 5% Q=55 .155DX.375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 24UH 5% Q=60 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 8.2UH 10% Q=60 .095DX .25LG-NOM
COIL-MLD 27UH 10% Q=45 .095DX .25LG-NOM
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=20OMHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300mw FT=150MHZ
TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO=18 PD=360mw
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI T0=72 PD=I200mw
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200mw FT=500MHZ
TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750mw
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
04713
04713
28480
28480
See introduction to this section for ordering information
* Indicates factory selected value
7-21
1901-0047
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0047
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
9170-0029
9100-1622
9100-0105
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1619
9100-1627
9100-1629
9100-1622
9100-1619
9140-0145
9100-2269
1854-0071
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1854-0019
1853-0020
2N3251
2N5179
1853-0015
185-0475
Mfr Part Number
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
150D606X9006B2
0160-2055
0160-2055
0160-2055
150D225X9020A2
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0047
1901-1085
1901-1010
1901-1085
1901-1070
1901-0040
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-1085
1901-0040
1901-1085
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A14R13
A14R14
A14R15
A14R16*
A14R17
A14R18
A14R19
A14R20
A14R21
A14R22
A14R23
A14R24
A14R25
A14R26
A14R27
A14R28
A14R29
A14R30
A14R31
A14R32
A14R33
A14R34
A14R35*
A14R36
A14R37
A14Q21
A14Q22
A14Q23
A14Q24
A14Q25
A14R1
A14R2
A14R3
A14R4
A14R5
A14R6*
A14R7
A14R8*
A14R9
A14R10
A14R11
A14R12
A14R38
A14R39
A14R40
A14R41
A14R42
A14R43
A14R44
A14R45
A14R46*
A14R47
A14R48
A14R49
A14R50
A14R51*
A14R52
A14R53
A14R54
A14R55
A14R56
A14R57
A14R58
A14R59
A14R60
A14R61
A14R62
A14R63
A14R64*
A14R65
A14R66
A14R67
A14R68
A14R69
A14R70
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (3 of 4) (CHANGE B)
HP Part C
Number D Qty
6
0698-0085
0757-0279
0757-0289
0757-0346
0698-3444
0757-0279
0698-3152
0757-0290
0757-0346
0698-3449
0757-0199
0698-3152
0757-0279
0757-0289
0757-0289
0698-3154
0757-0346
0698-3438
0757-0439
0757-0279
0698-3154
0757-0280
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0289
1854-0404
1853-0020
1854-0071
1854-0071
1854-0039
2100-3109
2100-3161
2100-3109
0757-0442
0757-0279
0757-0346
0757-0442
0757-0280
0757-0430
0757-0465
0757-0440
0698-3157
0698-3444
0757-0420
0698-3136
0698-3443
0698-3156
0757-0439
0698-0083
0757-0279
0757-0289
0757-0416
0698-3444
0757-0346
0757-0465
0698-0083
0757-0280
0698-3151
0757-0458
0757-0346
0757-0289
0757-0442
0698-3157
0757-0442
0698-3152
0698-3159
0757-0279
0757-0290
0757-0439
0757-0279
0757-0289
0757-0440
0757-0463
0
2
2
3
8
2
6
1
5
3
4
1
2
3
2
2
0
0
2
0
0
2
2
1
0
2
9
3
9
0
7
3
4
6
8
0
2
1
3
0
4
7
7
6
2
7
2
7
2
2
3
7
9
8
9
3
0
2
7
4
8
6
8
1
2
5
4
0
5
0
2
7
4
1
7
2
2
1
2
5
1
14
1
20
2
2
12
3
1
1
5
9
9
4
2
12
2
2
1
9
Description
TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO=18 PD=360MW
TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300mw FT=150MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=200MHZ
TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30538 SI TO=39 PD=1w
RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 20K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 287 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 28.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 4.22K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 82.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
Mfr Part Number
1854-0404
1854-0020
1854-0071
1854-0071
2N30538
43P202
43P203
43P202
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1080-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-1962-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-751-F
C4-1/8-TO-1782-F
C4-1/8-TO-287R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1472-F
C4-1/8-TO-2611-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2872-F
C4-1/8-TO-2152-F
C4-1/8-TO-3481-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-147R-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-4221-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-1003-F
C4-1/8-TO-1961-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
C4-1/8-TO-5112-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-1962-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-3481-F
C4-1/8-TO-2612-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-7501-F
C4-1/8-TO-8252-F
Mfr.
Code
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
28480
28480
28480
28480
01928
02111
02111
02111
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
7-22
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
A14R121
A14R122
A14R123
A14R124
A14R125
A14R126
A14R127
A14R128
A14R129
A14R130*
A14U1
A14VR1
A14VR2
A14VR3
A14R96
A14R97
A14R98
A14R99
A14R100
A14R101
A14R102*
A14R103
A14R104
A14R105
A14R106
A14R107
A14R108
A14R109
A14R110
A14R111
A14R112
A14R113
A14R114
A14R115
A14R116
A14R117
A14R118
A14R119*
A14R120
A14R71
A14R72
A14R73*
A14R74*
A14R75
A14R76
A14R77
A14R78
A14R79
A14R80
A14R81
A14R82*
A14R83
A14R84
A14R85
A14R86
A14R87
A14R88
A14R89
A14R90
A14R91
A14R92
A14R93
A14R94
A14R95
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (4 of 4) (CHANGE B)
0757-0289
0757-0288
0698-3444
0757-0439
0757-0346
0698-3158
0698-3160
0698-3160
0698-3160
0757-0346
0757-0289
0698-0085
0757-0439
0757-0290
0757-0279
0757-0289
0757-0416
0757-0346
0698-3444
0757-0439
0757-0346
0757-0438
0757-0346
0757-0289
0757-0280
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0439
0757-0290
0757-0405
0757-0279
0757-0280
0698-0348
0757-0447
0757-0447
0757-0441
0698-3260
0757-0442
0757-0421
0757-0290
0757-0290
0757-0467
1826-0092
1902-0041
1902-0048
1902-0579
HP Part C
Number D Qty
0698-3444
0757-0290
0757-0346
0698-3151
0757-0442
0757-0289
0757-0280
0757-0346
0757-0346
0757-0439
0757-0403
0757-0290
0757-0418
0757-0402
0757-0279
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
1
1
5
5
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
5
1
5
1
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
5
1
1
5
1
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
5
1
1
1
1
1
9
3
4
1
3
2
2
1
1
1
Description
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
NOT ASSIGNED
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 23.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 825 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
RESISTOR 121K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100
OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99
DIODE-ZNR 5.11V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W TC=-.009%
DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5% DO-7 PD=4W TC=+.043%
DIODE-ZNR 5.11V 5% DO-15 PD=1W TC=-.009%
See introduction to this section for ordering information
*Indicates factory selected value
Mfr Part Number
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2871-F
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-121R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-619R-F
C4-1/8-TO-111-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-511R-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-5111-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-162R-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-1001-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F
C4-1/8-TO-316R-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
C4-1/8-TO-2372-F
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
C4-1/8-TO-3162-F
C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F
MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F
C4-1/8-TO-2611-F
C4-1/8-TO-6811-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-3161-F
C4-1/8-TO-147R-F
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-1622-F
C4-1/8-TO-8251-F
0698-3260
C4-1/8-TO-1002-F
C4-1/8-TO-825R-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F
C4-1/8-TO-1213-F
1826-0092
1902-0041
1902-0048
1902-0579
Mfr.
Code
24546
19701
19701
24546
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
19701
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
19701
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
19701
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
24546
28480
24546
24546
19701
19701
24546
28480
28480
28480
28480
7-23
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-5. A14 Log Amplifier, Component and Test Point Locations (CHANGE B)
7-24
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
7-25 through 7-26
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-7. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Component Locations (CHANGE C)
7-27
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-8. P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF Schematic Diagram (CHANGE C)
7-28
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-9. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Component Locations (CHANGE F)
7-29
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 7-10. P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF Schematic Diagram (CHANGE F)
7-30
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
8-1. INTRODUCTION
8-2. This section prov ides instructions for troubleshooting and repairing the HP Model 8558B
Spectrum Analyzer. It includes general serv icing hints and information, block diagrams of the instrument, circuit descriptions, parts identification illustrations, and schematic diagrams.
WARNING
SECTION VIII.
SERVICE
Test conditions for the signal and dc voltage levels shown on the block and schematic diagrams are
8-7. TEST EQUIPMENT
8-8. Test instruments and accessories used to maintain
the spectrum analyzer are listed in Table 1-4. If the
listed instrument is not available, another instrument that meets the required minimums specifications may be substituted.
To troubleshoot and repair this instrument, you must remove it from the display mainframe and reconnect it to the mainframe through an extender cable. Operating the spectrum analyzer outside the mainframe in this manner exposes high voltage points in the instrument which might, if contacted, cause personal injury.
Maintenance and repair of this instrument should, therefore, be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazards involved.
8-3. SERVICE INFORMATION INDEX
8-9. TROUBLESHOOTING
8-10. General
8-11. Troubleshooting to the assembly level is accomplished by referring to the overall and troubleshooting block diagrams, and by checking for the voltages given for the various system test points. Once the problem is isolated to a particular assembly, the circuit description and schematic diagram for the suspect assembly are used to locate the faulty component.
8-12. Before pursuing any troubleshooting in the spectrum analyzer, you should first make sure the problem is not in the display mainframe, or is not caused by a faulty connection between the spectrum analyzer and the display mainframe.
8-4. Table 8-1 lists specific kinds of information about
the spectrum analyzer main assemblies, and indicates where the information is located. The serv ice information for each assembly normally includes a description of the assembly circuits, a diagram showing the locations of the assembly components, and a schematic of the assembly circuits. These packages of assembly information are arranged in assembly number order with the circuit descriptions and component locations diagram preceding the assembly schematic.
The assembly numbers are printed in large, bold-faced, alpha-numeric characters (e.g., A4) in the lower righthand corner of each schematic diagram.
8-5. SCHEMATIC SYMBOLS, TERMINOLOGY, AND
VOLTAGE LEVELS
8-6. Symbols and terminology used on the schematic
diagrams are explained in Figure 8-1.
8-13. Troubleshooting Hints
NOTE
When a part is replaced, an adjustment of the affected circuitry is usually required. For adjustment
procedures, refer to Section V.
8-14. Residual FM. The troubleshooting procedure
prov ided in Table 8-2 can usually isolate the cause of
residual FM to a particular circuit or circuit component.
Figure 8-3 shows how certain components affect FM in
these procedures. Note that the zener diode causes peaks which are sharp and extreme compared to the IC peaks. A leaky
8-1
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 8-1. Service Information Index (1 of 2)
Subject Location
General Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting Hints
Spurious Responses Paragraph 8-16
Troubleshooting Block Diagram Figure 8-6
General Principles of Operation Paragraph 8-18
Simplified Block Diagram Figure 8-5
DPM Driver Assembly A1A2
Schematic (includes display) Figure 8-11
Component Locations Figure 8-10
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-1
Front Switch Assembly A2
Board Assembly A2A1 Component Locations Figure 8-12
Disassembly and Repair Procedures Follows Figure 8-47
Input Attenuator Assembly A3 Figure 8-14
Description Precedes Figure 8-18
First Converter Assembly A4
Component Locations Figure 8-16
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-18
Second Converter Assembly A5
Component Locations Figure 8-17
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-18
Frequency Control Assembly A7
Component Locations Figure 8-19
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-20
Sweep Generator Assembly A8
Component Locations Figure 8-22
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-23
Third Converter Assembly A9
Component Locations Figure 8-25
Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-26
8-2
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 8-1. Service Information Index (2 of 2)
Subject
Second IF Assembly A10
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Step Gain Assembly A12
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly A13
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Log Amplifier Assembly A14
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Motherboard Assembly A16
Schematic
Component Locations
Inverter Assembly A17
Schematic
Component Locations
Circuit Description
Major Assemblies, Location of
Location
8-3
Model 8558B electrolytic capacitor (not shown) usually causes the displayed signal to step down and remain at the same level for several divisions before stepping up to a new level.
8-15. Sideband Noise. Sideband noise is usually caused by YIG Oscillator Assembly A6.
8-16. Spurious Responses. Spurious responses are usually caused by loose RF connections. Check all the
RF connections.
8-17. Baseline Step. If the left side of the baseline lifts to the signal peak level, the trouble is A7Q17; a lift of the right side of the baseline is caused by A7Q18 (see
8-18. GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
8-19. A simplified block diagram of the HP 8558B
Spectrum Analyzer is shown in Figure 8-5. The HP
8558B is basically a superheterodyne receiver with a
YIG (Yttrium-Iron-Garnet) tuned oscillator for the first
LO (local oscillator). The first LO is the only LO that is swept. The sweep width is determined by the sweep attenuator (part of A8) which attenuates the ramp driv ing the LO. This ramp is produced by the sweep generator on A8. The ramp also drives the horizontal sweep of
TM 11-6625-3061-14 the CRT, and is available at a rear panel BNC connector to synchronize other instruments, such as X-Y recorders, with the analyzer.
8-20. The RF input to the spectrum analyzer passes through an attenuator network on assembly A3 which is controlled by the front panel INPUT ATTEN dB control.
This control is used to set the input signal level as required for a wide dynamic range. From the attenuator, the signal goes to first converter assembly
A4. Here it is mixed with a 2050 to 3550 MHz output from YIG oscillator assembly A6. The lower sideband,
2050 MHz, of the resulting signal is passed by a 2050
MHz IF amplifier immediately following the first converter circuit. It then enters second converter assembly A5 where it is mixed with a fixed 1748.6 MHz signal from a fixed-cav ity local oscillator. This produces a 301.4 MHz IF signal which is amplified and fed to third converter assembly A9. This time, the signal is mixed with a 280 MHz signal from a SAWR (surface acoustic wave resonator) oscillator, resulting in a 21.4 MHz IF signal. The final 21.4 MHz signal is amplified and detected, then filtered by low pass v ideo filter A2 before it is applied to the vertical deflection amplifier of the
CRT. The vertical deflection seen on the CRT corresponds to the RF input signal amplitude. The 280
MHz signal from the SAWR oscillator is fed out of the front panel for use as a -30 dBm calibration reference.
8-21. Circuit descriptions for each assembly precede the assembly schematic diagram.
8-4
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATICS AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS
BASIC COMPONENT SYMBOLS
Variable Resistor: Clockwise rotation of shaft moves wiper towards end of resistor marked CW.
Light-emitting diode
Transistor, PNP
Electrolytic capacitor
Variable capacitor
Slide, toggle, or rocker switch
Transistor, NPN
MOS-FET, N-Channel
Ferrite bead (prevents high frequency parasitic oscillations)
Pushbutton switch
Relay
Surface Acoustic Wave
Resonator (SAWR)
Indicates a factory-select component
Crystal
Speaker
Indicates shielding conductor for cables
Indicates a plug-in connection
Breakdown (zener) diode
Schottky diode
Indicates a soldered or mechanical connection
Indicates a single pin of a
PC board edge connector
Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (1 of 4)
8-5
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATICS AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS
BASIC COMPONENT SYMBOLS
Connection symbol indicating a Jack (except for
PC board edge connectors)
946
Indicates wire or cable color code. Color code same as resistor color code. First number indicates base color, second and third numbers indicate colored stripes.
Connection symbol indicating a Plug (except for
PC board edge connectors) Earth ground
Test Point: Terminal prov ided for test probe.
Instrument chassis ground.
May be accompanied by a number or letter to specify a particular ground.
Measurement Point: Used to indicate a convenient point for measurement. No terminal prov ided for test probe.
Screwdriver adjustment
Front-panel control
Oscillator
COMMONLY USED ASSEMBLY AND CIRCUIT SYMBOLS
Mixer
Operational amplifier Inverter, buffer
Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (2 of 4)
8-6
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Distinctive-Shape Symbols
SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATIC AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS
BASIC LOGIC SYMBOLS
AMPLIFIER/BUFFER Output is active when input is active.
AND FUNCTION
OR FUNCTION
Output is active only when all inputs are active.
Output is active when one or more inputs are active.
Output is active when only one input is active.
EXCLUSIVE-OR
FUNCTION
WIRED AND
FUNCTION
Two or more elements are joined together to achieve the effect of an AND function.
WIRED OR
FUNCTION
Two or more elements are joined together to achieve the effect of an OR function.
Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (3 of 4)
8-7
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATIC AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS
BASIC LOGIC SYMBOLS
Indicator Symbols (positive logic assumed)
Input is active only on the negativegoing transition.
ACTIVE-HIGH inputs and outputs are indicated by the absence of the negation symbol, O.
ACTIVE-LOW inputs and outputs are indicated by the presence of the negation symbol, O.
EDGE-TRIGGERED (dynamic) inputs are indicated by the presence of the dynamic input symbol.
Input is active only on the positive-going transition.
Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (4 of 4)
8-8
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Nominal power levels, voltages, and waveforms shown on schematic diagrams were measured using the test setup shown below. Note that signal characteristics shown on schematic diagrams are prov ided as a troubleshooting aid only. They should not be used for making instrument adjustments.
EQUIPMENT:
Oscilloscope(with 10:1 probe) .......................................................................................HP 1741A
Spectrum Analyzer....................................................................................HP 141T/8552B/8555A
Digital Voltmeter ...........................................................................................................HP 3455A
Signal Generator ...........................................................................................................HP 8640B
Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................HP 5060-0303
Adapter, Type N to BNC (2 required)...................................................................... HP 1250-0780
Figure 8-2. Conditions for Schematic Diagram Measurements (1 of 2)
8-9
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
PROCEDURE:
1. Set HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer controls as follows:
START-CENTER ........................................................................................................... CENTER
TUNING ..........................................................................................................................280 MHz
FREQ SPAN/DIV ................................................................................................................1 MHz
RESOLUTION BW...........................................................................................................300 kHz
INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................0 dB
REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................-10 dBm
Option 002: +40 dBm V
REFERENCE LEVEL FINE.........................................................................................................0
Amplitude Scale ............................................................................................................10 dB/DIV
SWEEP TIME/DIV..............................................................................................................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER .....................................................................................................FREE RUN
VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................OFF
BASELINE CLIPPER.............................................................................................................OFF
BL CLIP .................................................................................................................................OFF
2.
3.
4.
Connect equipment as shown. Set signal genera tor for a 280 MHz, -10 dBm output signal. Center the signal on the display.
Using board extenders when necessary, check voltages and waveforms indicated on schematic diagrams.
Trigger oscilloscope on negative transition of AUX B PENLIFT/BLANKING signal from rear of display mainframe.
To measure RF power levels, set RESOLUTION BW control to 3 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 0 (zero span).
The first LO is not swept in zero span, allowing signal levels to be checked with a second spectrum analyzer (use adapter cables as necessary). DO NOT use a power meter (harmonics and LO signals will contribute to give erroneous levels).
Figure 8-2. Conditions for Schematic Diagram Measurements (2 of 2)
8-10
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 8-2. Residual FM Troubleshooting Procedure (1 of 2)
Probable FM Source Troubleshooting Step
1.
Set 8558B controls as follows:
INPUT ATTEN ......................................0 dB
REF LEVEL............................................-20
(Option 002: +30 dBm V)
FREQ SPAN/DIV...............................2 MHz
RESOLUTION BW ............................1 MHz
SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................AUTO
SWEEP TRIGGER ....................FREE RUN
AMPLITUDE SCALE ..............................LIN
VIDEO FILTER.....................................OFF
2.
Tune LO feedthrough to the left edge of CRT display
and make sure a double lobe (Figure 8-3d) does not
occur.
3.
Connect CAL OUTPUT to spectrum analyzer input.
Center 280 MHz signal on CRT and adjust REF
LEVEL FINE for a top-of-screen signal.
4.
Step FREQ SPAN/DIV from 2 MHz to 1 MHz.
Frequency shift should be less than one major div ision.
5.
Use FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton to remove YIG hysteresis, then center 280 MHz signal on CRT.
Repeated operations should shift signal less than one major div ision.
6.
Second LO frequency should be stable and not vary more than 200 kHz (check at A5J3).
7.
Check the voltages at A7TP6 and A7TP7 for correct level and stability.
A7TP6
≈
+6V
A7TP7
≈
+14.5V
8.
Select a 10 kHz RESOLUTION BW and tune the spectrum analyzer so the 280 MHz signal skirt crosses the center frequency graticule line between the fourth and seventh horizontal graticule lines. Switch to zero (0) span and select a .1 SEC/DIV sweep time. Peak-to-peak variations of the trace should not exceed one major vertical division for each major horizontal div ision.
9.
Try FM check (step 8) with TUNING potentiometer in several different positions. (Tune slightly off frequency with COARSE TUNING control and adjust FINE TUNING control for proper display.)
Main Coil Filter A7Q4 and associated circuitry.
Main Coil Filter A7Q4 and associa ted circuitry.
Calibrate single shot A7Q21-23. Proceed to step 11.
ASCR1 or A5Q1
A7VR2
A7VR1
TUNING potentiometer
8-11
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Table 8-2. Residual FM Troubleshooting Procedure (2 of 2)
Troubleshooting Step
10. Disconnect one end of A7C13 and repeat step 8.
Reconnect A7C13, disconnect one end of A7C4, and again repeat step 8.
11. Remove A7CR2 and A7Q22. If FM is still present, remove A7Q21 and A7Q23.
12. Remove A7R55 and repeat step 8.
Probable FM Source
A7C13 or A7C14
Calibrate single shot circuit on Frequency Control Assy A7.
YIG FM coil driver circuit on
Frequency Control Assy A7.
Probably A7U1.
13. Disconnect one end of A7VR3 or A7CR9 and repeat step 8.
14. Ground A7TP1 and repeat step 8.
A7VR3 or A7CR9
YIG main coil gate on Frequency
Control Assy A7.
15. If residual FM is still present, the problem is in the YIG main coil drivers on Frequency Control Assembly A7.
Refer to the Frequency Control Assembly schematic diagram for further troubleshooting.
8-12
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-3. CRT Displays for Residual FM Troubleshooting
Figure 8-4. Baseline Step Caused by Failure of A7Q18
8-13/8-14 (blank)
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-15 through 8-18
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A1A2 DPM DRIVER ASSEMBLY CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The DPM circuit is a dc voltmeter that measures a tuning voltage from Frequency Control Assembly A7, and converts it to a front-panel frequency readout.
The DPM Driver is divided into three parts:
1.
The Analog-to-Digital Converter.
2.
The Segment Driver.
3.
The Digit Driver.
Analog-to-Digital Converter
The Analog-to-Digital converter comprises an MOS LSI dev ice, A1A2U1, and associated circuitry. A1A2U1 compares the input voltage (MTR V) on pin 3 with a reference voltage (V REF) on pin 2 and outputs the measured voltage in a binarycoded decimal (BCD) format. The BCD data is multiplexed out of A1A2U1, one decimal digit (four bits) at a time on pins
20 through 23. DS1 through DS4 (pins 16 through 19) are the enable lines for A2DS1 (MSD) through A2DS4 (LSD).
A1A2R2, A1A2R3, and A1A2R4 form an adjustable voltage divider which divides the 6.2 volts from A16VRI down to approximately 2.0V for the reference voltage (V REF) at pin 2 of A1A2U1.
Segment Drive
AIA2U3 converts the BCD data to seven-segment data for the displays and prov ides a test function which lights all the segments of all the displays when pin 3 (TP2) is jumpered to ground. A1A2Q3 switches the decimal point LED on for frequencies below 198.6 MHz. (The voltage, MTR V, is multiplied by 10 on the Frequency Control Assembly.) A1A2Q4 allows the 'g' segment line of A2DS1 to go high when the input voltage (MTR V) is less than zero. This causes a minus sign (-) to be displayed.
Digit Driver
The digits are enabled one at a time, sequentially through digit driver A1A2U2. Each digit display is in turn enabled for
300 microseconds until a 250 millisecond period has passed. This is the length of time A1A2U1 requires to make a new voltage measurement. After 250 milliseconds, the new data is put out on pins 20 through 23 of A1A2U1 and the cycle
repeats. (See Figures 8-8 and 8-9.)
Display
The digit displays, A2DS1 through A2DS4, are of the common-cathode type. When the digit enable line (cathode) is low and a segment line is high, that segment is turned on. Although only one digit display is enabled at a time, the enable rate is fast enough to prevent visible display flicker.
Troubleshooting
To check the digit displays, jumper A1A2TP2 (LT) to ground. All segments of all four numeric displays (A2DS1 through
8-19
Model 8558B
Figure 8-7. A1A2U1 Clock
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-8. Integrator and EOC Waveforms for FREQUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz
Y3
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
Table 8-3. Truth Table for A2DS1 Display
A1A2U1 Data Output
Y2 Y1
Y0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Decimal
Equivalent
0
3
4
7
10
11
14
15
A1A1DS1
Display
-1
-1
1
1
-
-
Blank
Blank
8-20
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
NOTES
1. TRIGGER OSCILLOSCOPE EXTERNALLY USING EOC {(END OF
CONVERSION), A1A2U1 PIN 14.
2. DURING THE TIME INTERVA L THAT DS1 LINE IS HIGH,THE DATA ON
PINS 20 THROUGH 23 IS NOT STANDARD BCD CODE. SEE TABLE 8-2.
Figure 8-9. A1A2U1 Outputs for FREQUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz
8-21
Model 8558B
A1A2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-10. A1A2 DPM Driver Component Locations
8-22
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-23 through 8-24
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Functions of the switches and potentiometers on Front Switch Assembly A2 and Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 are covered in the circuit descriptions for the electronic assemblies they control. Disassembly and repair procedures for the
Front Switch Assembly are at the back of this section (following Figure 8-47).
8-25
Model 8558B
A2A1
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-12. Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1, Component Locations
8-26
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-27 through 8-28
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A3, U1, A4, A5, A6 CIRCUIT DESCIPTIONS
A3 Input Attenuator Circuit Description
from 0 dB to 70 dB is accomplished by switching the signal path through one or more of the three resistive pads in a predetermined sequence. (Note that the input attenuator is not field repairable.)
U1, RF Input Limiter Circuit Description
The RF input limiter contains Schottky diodes which clamp the input signal voltage, protecting the mixer diodes in the
First Converter Assembly A4. The typical limiting threshold is 1 mW (0 dBm). The limiter is not field serv iceable.
A4 First Converter Circuit Description
The RF signal input (0.1 1500 MHz) passes through a 1550 MHz low pass filter to the mixer diode assembly, U1. The output impedance of this low-pass filter seen from the mixer is effectively a short circuit at 2050 MHz, reflecting any IF power back to the mixer. The first LO input from YIG Oscillator Assembly A6 passes through a 3 dB power splitter consisting of two resistors, R1 and R2, and etched transmission lines. One of the power splitter outputs prov ides the front panel LO OUTPUT; the other output is through a balun (short piece of semi-rigid coaxial transmission line) to prov ide drive voltage to the mixer diodes. The LO signal is coupled to one mixer diode through the balun shield and to the other mixer diode through the balun center conductor. This arrangement splits the LO signal voltage evenly between the two mixer diodes. The 2050 MHz output signal from the mixer (first IF) is split-line coupled to a 6 dB 'pi' resistive matching pad (R3, R4, and R5). A small block of polyiron is placed over the split-output line. The polyiron helps balance the mixer and absorbs harmonics of the mixing signals. A 5000 MHz low-pass filter etched on the A4 printed circuit board prov ides additional filtering to the 2050 MHz IF signal after the 6 dB pad. The signal is then coupled to Second
Converter Assembly A5 through a semi-rigid coaxial cable.
A5 Second Converter Circuit Description
The IF signal from the First Converter is coupled into the Second Converter bandpass filter through coupling loop L3.
The bandpass filter consists of three circular, slug-tuned cav ity resonators operating as less than a quarter wavelength inductive transmission lines. The cav ities prov ide high 'Q' for good selectiv ity at 2050 MHz. Coupling loops L4 and L5 prov ide coupling between the cav ities. The 2050 MHz signal is loop coupled to the cathode end of second mixer diode
CR1. The second LO signal is loop coupled to the anode end of CR1. The second local oscillator is a Colpitts type circuit operating at 1748.6 MHz. The capacitive 'fingers' etched on the A5A1 printed circuit board and the internal transistor capacitances of A5A1Ql prov ide the positive feedback necessary to sustain oscillation. The oscillator tank circuit is a slug-tuned cav ity, Z4. The signal from the second LO is coupled into cav ity Z4 by a 4 - 40 machine screw extending down into the cav ity. The second LO output is also available at test jack A5J3. The 1748.6 MHz local oscillator prov ides the drive for mixer diode CR1. The difference frequency between the first IF, 2050 MHz, and the second LO frequency, 1748.6 MHz, is 301.4 MHz. This 301.4 MHz signal is coupled through the matching filter to the
A10 Second IF. The matching filter is a passive network designed to match the relatively high impedance of the second mixer, about 200 ohms, to the low input impedance of the second IF, about 50 ohms. The match may be optimized by adjusting A5L2, 2nd MIXER MATCH adjustment.
A6 YIG Oscillator Circuit Description
The YIG Oscillator is a transistorized thin-film microcircuit. It uses an yttrium-iron-garnet (YIG) sphere as the frequency determining structure. The YIG sphere is a ferromagnetic material whose resonant frequency is directly proportional to the applied magnetic field. The sphere is placed in the gap of an electromagnet to prov ide a magnetic tuning structure whose field (and thereby the oscillator's frequency) is linearly proportional to the drive current from Frequency Control
Assembly A7.
8-29
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
The main coil is used for wide range sweeping and tuning with the coil current varying from approximately 50 to 8 mA.
The FM coil is used only for narrow spans (1 MHz/DIV and less) with the coil current varying from approximately - 25 mA to + 25 mA.
The YIG Oscillator Assembly consists of three parts: a sealed magnet assembly which encloses the YIG sphere and oscillator; a bias board which uses discrete components to establish oscillator/amplifier bias and to protect against supply noise and voltage overloads; and a mu-metal magnetic shielding can.
8-30
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-14. A3 Input Attenuator
Figure 8-15. A 6 YIG Oscillator
8-31
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-16. A4 First Converter, Component Locations
8-32
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-17. A5 Second Converter Assembly, Component Locations
8-33/8-34(blank)
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-35 through 8-36
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A7 FREQUENCY CONTROL CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
Frequency Control Assembly A7 contains the circuitry to drive and control YIG Oscillator Assembly A6. The frequency is controlled by the sum of the sweep and tune voltages. The tune voltage is generated by the center frequency coarse and fine TUNING controls. The tune voltage is measured by the digital panel meter (DPM) voltmeter to provide the centerfrequency digital readout. The sweep voltage, controlled by the FREQ SPAN/DIV switch, is generated in Sweep
Generator Assembly A8. The YIG Oscillator has two driving coils: the main tuning coil and the FM coil. The tune voltage is applied to the main tuning coil driver. The sweep voltage is either summed with the tune voltage and applied to the main tuning coil driver or, in narrow frequency spans, it is applied to the FM coil driver. Gating circuits determine whether the sweep voltage is applied to the main or FM coil. The Frequency Control Assembly also contains separate low-noise voltage regulators to bias the YIG Oscillator and the 1748.6 MHz second local oscillator.
YIG Main Coil Fixed Driver
The YIG Main Coil Fixed Driver consists of differential amplifier A7Q7, a Darlington pair current source, A7Q5 and Q6, and a + 6V reference voltage from A7VR2 and R4. The fixed driver is used to tune the YIG oscillator to the minimum frequency of 2050 MHz.
The + 6V reference voltage is one input to A7Q7 and the other input, measured at TP3, is negative feedback that senses the voltage across A7R3 and R71. The operation of the fixed coil driver maintains a constant +6.OV across A7R3 and
R71. A11 current through R3/R71 comes from the YIG main coil through Darlington current source A7Q5 and Q6. A7R3 is the 2.05 GHz lower frequency adjustment and sets the emitter current of A7Q5 and Q6. The current source provides the fixed current to determine the zero CENTER FREQUENCY point set by A7R3.
YIG Main Coil Swept Driver
The YIG Main Coil Swept Driver consists of a swept driver, A7U4, and a Darlington pair current source, A7Q1 and Q3.
The swept driver tunes the YIG oscillator over the frequency range of 2050 MHz to 3550 MHz. The inputs to A7U4 are the Coarse and Fine TUNING voltage from the Tune Summing Amplifier, and the attenuated sweep ramp from the
Sweep Buffer. The output from A7U3 is the attenuated sweep only when 2 MHz/DIV or wider frequency spans have been selected. In narrower frequency spans, only the sum of the TUNING voltages is applied to the main coil swept driver. The attenuated sweep and TUNING voltages are summed across A7R49 and R52 and then applied to the noninverting input of A7U4. Diode A7CR3 prevents the input of the swept driver from going negative and driving it into cutoff. A7U4 drives the current source which converts the voltage at the emitter of Q1 into current to drive the YIG main tuning coil.
The current from A7Q1/Q3 is summed with the current from the fixed driver current source, A7Q5/Q6, to increase the main coil current synchronously with the TUNING and sweep voltages. The YIG upper frequency 3.55 GHz is set by
A7R1 (coarse adjust) and A7R2 (fine adjust). The emitter of A7Q1 is connected to the inverting input of A7U4 to provide a voltage proportional to the collector current of Q1/Q3 to be used as negative feedback.
Frequency AnA10g Output for Blanking. The emitter of A7Q1 also drives the base of A7Q2. A7Q2 is an emitter follower that provides the frequency anA10g output voltage to Third Converter Assembly A3 and to the Sweep Ramp High/Low
Limit Comparator (A15U1) of Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15. (See A15 Schematic.)
8-37
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Coarse and Fine TUNING . The Coarse and Fine tuning voltages from control potentiometers A2R1 and A2R2 (shown on A2 schematic) are applied to the noninverting and inverting inputs respectively of A7U2. A7U2 sums these voltages and applies the voltage sum to the junction of A7R52 and R53. It is in turn summed with the attenuated sweep signal from the output of the sweep buffer A7U3 if 2 MHz/DIV or wider frequency spans have been selected. In narrower frequency spans, the input of buffer A7U3 is grounded so only the summed tuning voltages are applied to A7U4.
YIG FM Coil Driver
The FM Coil Driver consists of A7U1, Q17, Q18, and FM adjust R6. Selecting 1 MHz/DIV and narrower frequency spans enables the YIG FM Coil Gate, allowing the attenuated sweep to be applied to the YIG FM Coil Driver. (A7Q15 is on and
Q16 is off.) A7U1 converts the sweep ramp voltage into current to drive the YIG FM coil. Transistors A7Q17/Q18 are biased at cutoff and provide additional current drive. The FM adjust, A7R6, sets the maximum FM coil current.
YIG Main and FM Coil Gates
The YIG Coil Gates determine which YIG coil is used to control the YIG oscillator frequency. The YIG Coil Gates are selected by the Scan Select which is controlled by FREQ SPAN/DIV control A2S6.
YIG Main Coil Gate . When 2 MHz/DIV and wider frequency spans are selected, the base of transistor A7U5C is returned to 12.6V through A7R11 and A8R131. A7U5C is turned off and the collector rises to about 5V while the emitter drops to near 12.6V. The collector of A7U5C turns on U5E and U5D, and these two transistors then turn off FETs Q15 and Q24 respectively. The emitter of A7U5C turns off U5A and U5B, which then turn on FETs Q16 and Q20. With
A7Q20 conducting and A7Q24 open, the attenuated sweep is applied to sweep buffer A7U3 and YIG main coil swept driver A7U4 to control the YIG oscillator frequency. FET A7Q15 is turned off preventing the attenuated sweep input from reaching the ./ YIG FM Coil Driver, and A7Q16 is turned on, grounding the input to the YIG FM coil driver.
YIG FM Coil Gate . The selection of 1 MHz/Div and narrower frequency spans with FREQ SPAN/DIV control A2S6 applies + 15V to the input of A7USC. The + 15V turns U5C on; FETs Q20 and Q16 are turned off, and FETs Q24 and
Q15 are turned on. This enables the YIG FM coil gate, allowing the sweep signal to be applied to the YIG FM Coil
Driver. A7Q20 prevents the Attenuated Sweep input from reaching the sweep buffer A7U3 and A7Q24 grounds the input of A7U3. However, the tuning voltage from the tune summing amplifier is still applied to the YIG main coil swept driver.
Main Coil Filter
When the narrower frequency spans are selected, the + 15V from FREQ SPAN/DIV switch A2S6 is also applied to A7Q4 in the main coil filter. The main coil filter consists of FET switch A7Q4, R75, and C13/C14. The filter provides noise filtering in the 1 MHz and narrower frequency spans. With the FET switch closed, the filter is connected in parallel with the YIG main tuning coil.
Meter Ranging
The DPM is a digital voltmeter which measures the TUNING voltage at the output of the tune summing amplifier. The output of the tune summing amplifier, approximately 0 to -10V, is divided down to 0 to 1.5V at pins 2 and 5 of A7U6 by
A7R53 and R50. This provides a 1 mV/MHz voltage to the DPM. The FREQ ZERO adjust R3 (shown on A2 schematic),
A7R43, and A7R54 enable this voltage to be offset 4 15 mV to zero the DPM. The FREQ ZERO adjustment compensates for the changes in the frequency of the YIG oscillator caused by temperature drift.
8-38
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A7U6A functions as a comparator and A7U6B as a switchable Xl/X10 gain stage. When the instrument is tuned to a frequency below 198.4 MHz, the voltage at A7U6 pin 2 is less than 198 mV. Since the voltage at A7U6 pin 3 is adjusted to be approximately 198 mV, the output at A7U6 pin 1 is positive. This turns on Q19, causing A7U6B to have a gain of approximately 10 and results in an output voltage at pin 7 of 10 mV/MHz.
When the instrument is tuned above 198.4 MHz, A7U6A pin 1 goes low, turning Q19 off, causing A7U6B to have a gain of 1. This results in an output voltage at pin 7 of 1 mV/MHz. The output of A7U6A pin 1 is also used to turn A7Q25 off to turn off the decimal point. The positive feedback from the emitter of A7Q25 to A7U6A pin 3 provides hysteresis for rapid switching of the X1/X10 crossover point. A7CR6 and CR7 provide proper biasing for FET Q19. OFS adjustment A7R72 compensates for input offset of A7U6B.
+ 14.5V Regulator The + 14.5V Regulator consists of series regulator A7Q8, driver Q10, and reference amplifier Q9 and
Q11. The +6.2V developed across zener diode A7VRI provides the base reference for A7Q9. This is compared to the voltage at the base of A7Q11 1 which senses the + 14.5V output across voltage divider A7R28, R29, and the + 14.5V
adjust R5. Should the output voltage increase, A7Q11 conducts more, decreasing the conduction of A7Q9 and driving the base of Q10 more positive. This decreases the drive current to A7Q8 and causes the output voltage to drop (return to + 14.5V). A7C4 provides stability compensation and some additional noise filtering at the output.
The + 14.5V supply is used for the positive supply on A7U2, U3, U4, and Q7. It is also used on Sweep Generator
Assembly A8 as the voltage reference that sets the 5V to + 5V ramp amplitude. The + 14.5V is also applied to Second
Converter A5 as the positive supply for the 1748.6 MHz second local oscillator.
+ 6.00V Reference Voltage Regulator
The + 14.5V at A7R32 and the +6.2V dropped across A7VR2, develop the +6.00V reference voltage. A7R4 REF V adjusts the voltage at TP6 to + 6.00V.
-10V Regulator
The regulated + 14.5V provides a reference voltage for voltage divider A7R34 and R35 for the -10V regulator. The -10V regulator consists of series regulator A7Q12 and reference amplifier A7Q13 and Q14. Should the -10V tend to become more positive (less negative), A7Q13 decreases its conduction and turns A7Q14 on harder. A7Q14 then increases the conduction of A7Q12, dropping the output voltage back to -10V.
The -10V supply is used for the negative supply on A7U2, U3, U4, and Q7. It is also used as the negative supply for the
A6 YIG Oscillator and the second local oscillator in A5.
Calibrate Single Shot
The calibrate single shot circuit consists of A7Q23, Q22, and Q21. The circuit is activated when the front panel FREQ
CAL button is pressed. With the FREQ CAL switch A2S1 (shown on A2 schematic) closed, the YIG Oscillator is tuned to its lowest frequency. Releasing the FREQ CAL button returns the YIG Oscillator to the previous operating frequency.
Pressing the FREQ CAL button shorts the + 6V line to ground, discharging A7C8 and turning A7Q23 off. The emitter of
A7Q22 is grounded, turning it on, and its collector goes low, turning off FET switch A7Q4. The main coil filter is now disabled and the charge held on A7C13/C14 remains the same during the calibration sequence. The charge voltage represents the previous operating frequency. The ground on the + 6V line is applied to the base of A7Q7, disabling the
YIG main coil fixed driver. When the + 6.OV line is grounded, the output of the coarse TUNING control is grounded; the
YIG main coil swept driver is disabled by the output from A7U2. With both YIG main coil drivers disabled, the magnetic current is removed and the magnet hysteresis is cancelled.
8-39
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
When the FREQ CAL button is released, the +6.0V reference line jumps to approximately + 1V. The charge on capacitor
A7C8 turns on A7Q23 which then turns on Q21. A7C8, Q21, and Q23 form a Miller Integrator and the +6.0V reference line slowly charges to +6.0V. This takes about 0.3 second and prevents the introduction of transients into the main coil.
However, as long as the + 6.0V reference line is charging; the conduction of A7Q23 keeps FET switch A7Q4 off, still disabling the main coil filter. The charge on A7C13/C14 has no path for discharge and remains the same. This allows the YIG Oscillator to return to the previous frequency faster since A7C13 and C14 do not have to be recharged.
8-40
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-19. A7 Frequency Control Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-42
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-43 through 8-44
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A8 SWEEP GENERATOR CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
The Sweep Generator Assembly generates a -5 volt to + 5 volt linear sweep voltage. The sweep voltage controls the frequency of YIG oscillator Assembly A6, and also controls the horizontal deflection of the CRT beam. The SWEEP
TIME/DIV control varies from 0.1 mSEC/DIV to 10 SEC/DIV so the full scan sweep time varies from 1 ms to 100 sec.
The sweep may be synchronized with either the video input or the line voltage. Manual and free run modes are also provided. A single sweep may be started or stopped with the front panel TRIGGER switch. A retrace voltage is generated and applied to Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15.
attenuator circuit, and the + V sweep offset circuit. The resolution bandwidth control circuit has three purposes. First it provides the bandwidth filter control current to the PIN diodes on Bandwidth Filter Assemblies A11 and A13. Second, it provides current to the sweep generator current source (AST line) to control the AUTO sweep time circuit as a function of resolution bandwidth. Third, it switches in the proper capacitor for the RC lowpass video filter to provide video filtering as a constant percentage of resolution bandwidth. The sweep attenuator circuit attenuates the sweep ramp to Frequency
Control Assembly A7 in proportion to the FREQ SPAN/DIV selected. It also provides a current to the sweep generator current source (AST line) to control the automatic sweep time circuit as a function of frequency span per division. The +
V sweep offset circuit offsets the ramp voltage by 5 volts so the ramp voltage, when START frequency is selected, is from 0V to + 10V instead of 5V to + 5V.
Sweep Generator Circuit
The sweep ramp is generated in the following cycle. (See Figure 8-21.)
When transistor Q10 turns on, the sweep ramp is initiated. At the beginning of the sweep cycle, the voltage at TP3 is -4V and dead-time capacitor C15 is charging toward + 15V through R33. When the anode voltage on CR11 reaches + 1 .5V,
Q10 turns on and the TP5 voltage becomes + 3V.
Pin 2 of U1 is at -5V and comparator U1 toggles to its positive supply voltage of + 14.5V. CR5 is now reverse biased.
The current source can begin charging timing capacitors C3 and C4 positively, forming the positive slope of the sweep ramp.
As the sweep ramp level approaches + 5V at TP8, the U1 feedback circuit takes control, holding pin 2 of U1 at 2.68V and temporarily bringing pin 6 out of saturation. The anode voltage of zener diode VR1 equals the voltage at pin 6 minus
10V:
E
VR1
= E pin6
- 10V
8-45
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-21. Simplified Schematic of Sweep Generator in AUTO Mode
8-46
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
As the voltage at U1 pin 6 (TP3) decreases, the anode voltage of VR1 decreases. At some time (when the level of the sweep ramp at TP8 is + 5V), the anode voltage of VR1 will no longer forward bias CR7, and the zener feedback loop opens. At this point, the 3.3 megaohm feedback loop becomes active and U1 saturates again. The comparator toggles, this time toward the negative operational amplifier supply, and 4V appears at TP3.
The -4V at T3 forward biases CR5. Timing capacitors C3 and C4 discharge through CR5, forming the negative slope of the sweep ramp. Dead-time capacitor C15 discharges.
The endpoints of the sweep ramp at TP8, 5V and + 5V, are controlled by the voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R30 or
R35, and by U1 and its feedback loops. U1 controls the ramp voltage as it maintains 2.68V at pin 2.
At the end of the ramp, when CR5 is forward biased, and the comparator output (pin 6 of U1) is approaching its negative supply, U1 uses Q1 and Q3 to maintain 2.68V at pin 2. Q10 is off, and the voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R30 produces -5V at TP8.
At the beginning of the ramp, when CR5 is reverse biased, and the comparator output is approaching its positive supply,
U1 again maintains 2.68V at pin 2. This time, Q10 is on, and voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R35 produces + 5V at
TP8.
Fast/Slow Sweep Time Operation . The ST6 control line from Front Switch Assembly A2A1, selects timing and deadtime capacitors C3, C4, C5, and C27, to control fast and slow sweep times. If the same amount of charging current is supplied to a larger capacitor, it charges at a slower rate.
Timing capacitors C3 and C4 are used to provide fast and slow sweep operation. When a fast sweep time (ms/div) is selected at TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3, the ST6 (FAST SWEEP) control line is grounded, turning off Q55 and Q53. With
Q53 off, C3 and C4 are in series and the timing capacitor becomes C4. With Q55 off, the + 15V at R57 back biases CR9 and CR6, so C27 is switched out of the dead-time circuit. the dead-time (about 0.4 ms) is set by C15. In sweep times greater than 1 ms/div (or in AUTO sweep times), the ST6 (FAST SWEEP) control line is open, Q55 and Q53 are both on.
With Q53 on, a ground is provided for C3 and it becomes the timing capacitor. CR6 and CR9 are on because of the conduction of Q55. C15 and C27 are in parallel, so the longer dead-time (about 7.5 ms) is set by C27.
When selecting FREE RUN mode (A2A1S4), + 15 volts is routed to the voltage divider, R59 and R60, via the TRIG control line. CR10 is reversed biased.
FREE RUN TRIGGER Operation. The circuit free runs and QI0 conducts when U1 switches on and off at a time determined by the RC time constants.
VIDEO TRIGGER OPERATION . When the video mode is selected (VIDEO position on A2A1S4 switch), CR10 is forward biased by R59, and Q10 is off. The sweep ramp is generated by turning on Q10 with a negative pulse from the pulse shaper circuitry. The negative pulse is applied to the emitter of Q10.
8-47
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
The pulse shape consists of a Schmitt trigger (Q39 and Q40), a differentiator (C12 and R55), and an emitter follower
(Q12). The Schmitt trigger produces a pulse which exists as long as the video trigger information on the SYNC line is above a certain dc level. When the TRIGGER switch is in VIDEO position, video information from Vertical Driver and
Blanking Assembly A15 is routed through the switch to the base of Q40. Q40 is normally off and Q39 is conducting.
During the positive portion of the SYNC signal, Q40 turns on, turning Q39 off. C7 accelerates the Q39 switching. When
Q40 switches on, the negative change at the collector is differentiated by C12 and R55, and coupled through Q12 to the
Q10 emitter. The negative pulse turns on Q10. CR8, R32, and VR1 keep Q10 on while the ramp is being generated.
After the ramp is completed, the circuit returns to its dead-time state and another trigger is required to generate another sweep. Trigger pulses from Q40, which may occur during the sweep, have no effect since Q10 is already on.
LINE TRIG Operation The sweep may be synchronized with the ac line voltage in the same manner as described in
VIDEO operation. With TRIGGER switch A2A1S4 in LINE position, the ac line from the mainframe power transformer is connected to the Schmitt trigger (Q40 and Q39) input. A16R2 and A16C2 on the motherboard attenuate the ac line signal to approximately 2 volts p-p and filter any line spikes.
SINGLE Sweep Trigger and Abort . Q10 is initially held off by R59 and CR10. Q9 is on, and voltage divider R37 and
R38 charges C16 to +2.8V. When the trigger switch A2A1R4 is set to SINGLE sweep (spring-loaded position), + 15V is applied to R62 turning on Q11. This shorts the positive end of C16 to ground and produces a negative pulse at the emitter of Q10. This turns Q10 on starting a sweep.
During the generation of a sweep, Q9 is off and the voltage divider R37 and R38 charges C16 to 4V. The sweep may be aborted (reset to 5V) by pressing the SINGLE switch to the spring-loaded position. This switches on Q11. The negative end of C16 is shorted to ground, a positive pulse is generated at the emitter of Q10, and Q10 is turned off aborting the sweep.
MANUAL Sweep Control
Manual control of the sweep is obtained with the TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3 in MAN position. A ground is applied to the base of Q38 and Q37 by the ST7 line from A2A1S3 in all sweep modes except manual; the ground holds Q38 and Q37 off. With A2A1S3 in MAN position, Q38 and Q37 are turned on. Q37 turns Q10 on and keeps it on. CR5 is on and the feedback loop to the timing capacitor is closed. Turning the MANUAL SWEEP control A2A1R4 changes the voltage at the collector of Q38 which changes the input current at U1 pin 2. Since the feedback current through R29 is constant, any change in manual sweep current must be compensated by a change in the current through R24, thereby varying the ramp output voltage.
Current Source
Current for the generation of the sweep is provided by the current source circuit. The temperature dependent power supply provides a nominal + 10V; Q6 is the temperature sensing element (diode). The following switches control current to operational amplifier U2A pin 2: RESOLUTION BW switch A2A1S5, FREQ SPAN/DIV switch A2A1S6, VIDEO FILTER potentiometer A2R5, and TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3. In the AUTO sweep time mode, the sweep time is controlled by the
RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER which set the currents to U2A. These currents are summed by U2A to produce a voltage proportional to the log of the sweep time. Q4 is the current driver and converts voltage variations into current variations proportional to sweep time. The current is applied to the timing capacitors C3 and C4, in the buffer amplifier circuit.
8-48
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Q7 provides temperature compensation for Q4. Q8 is a constant-current regulator for Q7. In AUTO, the sweep time is limited to 1 ms and longer because current is limited to 1 mA by Q5/R15.
In the calibrated sweep time/division mode, the gate of Q52 is grounded. This turns Q52 off and disconnects the currents proportional to RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER. Calibrated sweep times are now produced by the currents fed to U2A through R40 through R44. Those resistors are grounded in various combinations by
SWEEP TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3 resistor network. (See A2 Schematic.)
XTAL Resolution Bandwidth Control
When a XTAL bandwidth is selected (30 kHz, 10 kHz, 3 kHz, 1 kHz), control line BW5 is released from + 15V on the front panel and is pulled to -.5V by Q13. This has four effects.
1.
On the Bandwidth Filter boards CR2 and CR13 are turned off and Q3, Q6, CR8 and CR15 are turned on, allowing the XTAL filters to operate.
2.
Q21 is turned off allowing BW7 to be pulled up to more than + -10V by CR18 and R82. This turns off the LC filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.
3.
4.
Q14 is turned off allowing the voltage on BW6 to be controlled by the current through A8Q 19.
Q22 is turned off having an effect on sweep time which is discussed in detail later.
The current through Q19 is a function of the states (off or on) of Q15, Q17, Q42, the values of factory select resistors
R74, R76, and R78, and the setting of. R72 XTL (3 kHz adjustment). The off/on states of Q15, Q17, and Q42 are controlled by BW1, BW2, and BW3 which are controlled by the front panel RESOLUTION BW switch and are at either +
15V or some negative voltage. The amount of current through Q19 controls the bandwidths of the XTAL filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.
2.
3.
LC Resolution Bandwidth Control
When an LC bandwidth is selected, (3 MHz, 1 MHz, 300 kHz, 100 kHz), control line BW5 is pulled to + 15V at the front panel. This has four effects.
1.
On the Bandwidth Filter boards: Q3, Q6, CR8, and CR15 are turned off and CR2 and CR13 are turned on, thus blocking any signal from passing through the XTAL filer sections.
Q14 is turned on, pulling BW6 to -4V, which further defeats any possible action of the XTAL filter sections.
Q21 is turned on, allowing the voltage on BW7 to be controlled by the current through Q20.
8-49
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
The current through Q20 is a function of the states (off or on) of Q23, Q44, Q49, the values of factory select resistors
R89, R92, and R95, and the setting of R85 LC (1 MHz adjustment). The off/on states of Q23, Q44, Q49 are controlled by
BW2, BW3, and BW4 which are controlled by the front panel bandwidth switch and are either at + 15V or some negative voltage. The amount of current through Q20 controls the bandwidths of the LC filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.
4.
Q22 is turned on having an effect on AUTO sweep time which is discussed later.
Video Filter
The video filter is composed of front panel control A2R6, switch A2S2, and 8 capacitors on Sweep Generator A8. The amount of filtering is controlled by the Resolution Bandwidth setting through Q16, Q18, Q43, Q41, Q46, Q24, and Q45.
These transistors switch in and out various combinations of filter capacitors to provide more video filtering when the resolution bandwidth is decreased. In LC mode, BW6 is low holding Q15, Q17, Q42, Q41 off and keeping C19, C20, C21 and C22 out of the circuit.
Switch A2S2 applies maximum video filtering for noise measure mode by switching in C26 through Q47.
Sweep Attenuator
The sweep attenuator circuit changes the amplitude of the sweep voltage applied to the Frequency Control A7 as a function of the FREQ SPAN/DIV selected. The attenuator attenuates the -5V to +5V ramp routed through XA8 pin 39 in a divide by 1, 2, 5, and 10 sequence from a divide-by-1 to a divide-by-200. The circuit also generates an auto-sweep control current used to control the AUTO sweep time circuit as a function of the frequency span.
The sweep attenuator has two voltage dividers buffered by the unity gain voltage follower U3. The divider at the input of
U3 provides either a divide-by-two or a divide-by-five; the divider at the output of the U3 provides a divide-by-one, a divide-by-ten, and a divide-by-one hundred.
Assuming that FS3 (divide-by-two) is selected, + 15V turns on Q31 and Q32 grounds a 10K ohm resistor R113. The -5V to +5V ramp is divided across the input resistor R101 (10K ohms) and R113 (10K ohms). The ramp is now divided in half and applied to sweep buffer U3 pin 3. The dividers at the output of U3 (controlled by FS4 and FS5) have reversed control logic; they are normally connected to + 15V by A2A1S5 and open when selected. Q50 is a gate to drive Q30.
When FS4 and FS5 are connected to + 15V, Q50 is off and Q30 is on, connecting the divide-by-one divider at the output of U3. If either FS4 or FS5 is open, Q30 is off and Q28 or Q26 is on, providing either a divide-by-10 or divide-by-100.
AUTO sweep control current is applied to Q52 as a function of frequency span by Q35, Q31, Q33, Q27, and Q25 and the appropriate resistors. For narrow spans (1 MHz/DIV or less), when the YIG FM coil is swept, FS6 is connected to + 15V by A2A1S5. Q29 is on and the additional current in the AUTO sweep control is used to reduce the sweep time.
8-50
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
+ V Sweep Offset
Normally, START-CENTER switch A2A1S7 is in the CENTER position. The + 15V back biases Q54 and holds it off.
Switching to START allows Q54 to conduct and adds 0.5 mA of current through R67 to offset the sweep ramp. When
START frequency is used, the ramp excursion is from 0V to a positive voltage.
8-51
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-22. A8 Sweep Generator Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-52
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-53 through 8-56
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A9 THIRD CONVERTER CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
The Third Converter Assembly contains of a 280 MHz oscillator followed by a buffer amplifier, a balanced mixer, a matching filter, a 21.4 MHz amplifier,, and a PIN attenuator. The 301.4 MHz second IF signal from A10 is mixed with the
280 MHz oscillator (third LO) in balanced mixer A9U1. The output from the mixer is the difference frequency, 21.4 MHz, which is applied to the matching filter. This is a 21.4 MHz bandpass filter which also acts as an inter-stage impedance matching device. The signal is then amplified by the 21.4 MHz amplifier and coupled to a divider network consisting of two PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4, resistor R25, and the input impedance of the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11.
PIN driver A9Q5 changes the bias of the PIN diodes as a function of frequency, compensating for input mixer frequency response. The 21.4 MHz third IF output signal is coupled to the input of Bandwidth Filter No. 1. The 280 MHz Oscillator also provides the front panel CAL OUTPUT 280 MHz -30 dBm signal. It is sometimes necessary to select a different value for R9 to provide the 30 dBm CAL OUTPUT level while maintaining the proper input level to the balanced mixer.
280 MHz Oscillator (Third LO)
The third local oscillator is a modified Colpitts circuit with a 280 MHz surface acoustic wave resonator (SAWR) A9Z1 in the positive feedback path to provide increased frequency stability. Inductor A9L3, across the SAWR, tunes out the
SAWR shunt capacitance. The oscillator tuned circuit consists of capacitors A9C4, C5, and inductors L4 and L6. This tuned circuit ensures that the oscillator oscillates only on the proper overtone of the SAWR. A1though A9L4 is called the
LO FREQ adjustment, it is used to adjust for maximum LO output power and has only a slight effect on the output frequency. Inductor A9L5 provides a dc path for base bias of buffer amplifier A9Q2. Diodes A9CRI and CR2 provide temperature compensation for the 280 MHz oscillator and indirectly stabilize the CAL OUTPUT level. Power is taken out of the oscillator through L6, which transforms the output to approximately 50 ohms at a level of 0 dBm. The output level of the circuit is controlled by 3RD LO PWR adjustment A9RS, which sets the emitter current of A9Q1 and allows adjustment f6r a 30 dBm 280 MHz front-panel CAL OUTPUT level. It is sometimes necessary to select a different value for A9R4 to provide the proper third LO output level. Buffer amplifier A9Q2 provides isolation for the 280 MHz oscillator and provides about 10 dB of power gain to the L port of balanced mixer U1. The buffer amplifier also provides the proper output level to the front-panel CAL OUTPUT (by selecting A9R9) for a given balanced mixer input.
Balanced Mixer (Third Mixer)
The third LO 280 MHz input to the L port of the balanced mixer is approximately + 10 dBm. The level of the second IF
301.4 MHz input to the X port of the mixer is about 12 dBm or less. The third mixer output (Port R) is the 21.4 MHz difference frequency produced by heterodyning the 301.4 MHz IF and the 280 MHz LO. The third mixer has a conversion loss of about 7 dB.
Matching Filter
The output of the balanced mixer is applied to the matching filter which consists of A9L9, C10, C11, C12, and L10. The matching filter is a 21.4 MHz bandpass filter which also serves as an impedance matching network. The circuit raises the low input impedance of the 21.4 MHz amplifier (about 10 ohms) to match the higher output impedance of the balanced mixer (about 50 ohms).
21.4 MHz Amplifier
The 21.4 MHz amplifier consists of A9Q3 in a common-emitter configuration and A9Q4 as an emitter follower. Transistor
A9Q3 employs resistor A9R12 and zener diode A9VR2 to furnish base bias and negative feedback for gain control and stabilization. Resistor A9R12 is factory selected to provide the
8-57
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 proper gain of the Third Converter Assembly. Capacitor A9C14 is connected across A9VR2 to reduce zener noise. The output of the 21.4 MHz amplifier looks into a voltage-controlled attenuator consisting of two PIN diodes, A9CR3 and
CR4, resistor A9R25, and the input impedance of the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11.
PIN Driver
The PIN diode resistance of A9CR3 and CR4 is controlled by the PIN driver A9Q5 and its associated circuitry. The base of A9Q5 is the summing point for the frequency anA10g voltage from the Frequency Control Assembly A7 and a dc level set by front-panel REF LEVEL CAL screwdriver adjustment A2R3. Setting the dc level by adjusting A2R3 calibrates the
8558B display at a given frequency, usually performed at 280 MHz. The frequency analog voltage is a dc level varying from + 0.6 volts to + 6.7 volts as a function of frequency. This frequency anA10g voltage at the base of A9Q5 compensates for input mixer response. SLOPE COMP adjustment A9R1 sets the amount of compensation required for a flat frequency response. The total current through the PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4 is shaped by the emitter network of
A9Q5. This network provides a change in current through the PIN diodes to cause a change of PIN diode resistance.
The change in resistance is required to provide the proper log curve within an 8 dB range for the voltage-controlled attenuator.
8-58
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A10 SECOND IF CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
The Second IF Assembly contains a bandpass amplifier which provides a gain of approximately 16 dB at 301.4 MHz. It also contains a bandpass filter which provides further rejection of unwanted signals. The bandpass filter has a 3 dB loss, giving the Second IF Assembly a net gain of approximately 13 dB at 301.4 MHz. The 301.4 MHz IF output signal is coupled to Third Converter Assembly A9 by cable W7. This signal is the input to the X port of the balanced mixer on the
Third Converter Assembly.
Bandpass Amplifier
The bandpass amplifier consists of A10Q2 in a common-emitter configuration, and A10Q1 connected to control the base drive and bias current of A10Q2. Capacitors A10C4, C5, C7, and C10 serve as decoupling for high frequencies. The gain of the bandpass amplifier is set by the high frequency characteristics of A10Q2, R5, and the small amount of inductance on the emitter connection of Q2. The emitter inductance is used to establish a 50 ohm input impedance and to help stabilize the current gain of A10Q2. Resistor A10R5 in parallel with the output resistance of A10Q2 establishes an output impedance of about 500 ohms. Components A10L2, C8, C9 and the collector capacitance (Cc) of Q2 form the
transforms the 500 ohm output impedance at the collector of A10Q1 down to 50 ohms. The output of the bandpass amplifier flows from A10C9 through a 50 ohm microstrip transmission line (etched on the printed circuit board) to the bandpass filter. The bandpass amplifier has a gain of about 16 dB from the base of A10Q2 to the 50 ohm output of
A10C9.
Bandpass Filter
The output of the bandpass amplifier passes through a 301.4 MHz bandpass filter. The bandpass filter is made up of
A10L3, L4, L5, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15 and adjustable piston-type capacitors A10C1, C2, and C3. Capacitors A10C11 and C15 are used to transform the bandpass filter input and output impedance to 50 ohms. Inductors A10L3, L4, and L5 are wound on a common coil form which provides mutual inductance coupling between filter sections. The bandpass filter has an insertion loss of approximately 3 dB and 3 dB bandwidth of about 12 MHz.
Figure 8-24. Bandpass Amplifier Tank Circuit, Simplified Schematic
8-59
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-25. A9 Third Converter Assembly, and A10 Second IF Assembly, Component Locations
8-60
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-61 through 8-62
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
A11 BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
Bandwidth Filter No. 1 operates at 21.4 MHz and is variable in bandwidth from 3 MHz to 1 kHz. The front-panel
RESOLUTION BW switch is used to select one of eight available bandwidth settings (3 MHz, 1 MHz, 300 kHz, 100 kHz,
30 kHz, 10 kHz, 3 kHz, or 1 kHz).
The narrower bandwidths (1 kHz through 30 kHz) are obtained from four synchronously tuned crystal filters; the four wider bandwidths (100 kHz through 3 MHz), from four synchronously tuned LC tank circuits. The four stages of bandwidth filters are on two similar printed-circuit boards, Bandwidth Filter No. 1 (A11) and Bandwidth Filter No. 2
(A13). Two LC tank circuits and two crystal filters are on each board. The four crystals in the two bandwidth assemblies
(A11Y1, A11Y2, A13Y1, and A13Y2) are a factory-selected matched set. If replacement of a Bandwidth Filter assembly is necessary, the new board is shipped with two crystals installed. The other two crystals (which must be used to replace the existing two crystals in the good Bandwidth Filter assembly) are packaged separately and shipped with the new
Bandwidth Filter board. In addition to the filter stages, each Bandwidth Filter provides 10 dB of gain in both LC and crystal filter operation. (There is some gain in the "unity" gain buffer amplifiers.)
10 dB Input Buffer Amplifier
The 10 dB input buffer amplifier functions as a non-inverting operational amplifier.
In the crystal mode (bandwidths <30 kHz), the amplifier includes Q3. The biasing of the amplifier is independent of its ac
(21.4 MHz) operation but is very critical for its proper functioning. If a malfunction occurs, the dc bias should be checked first.
In the LC mode (the four wider bandwidths), the BW5 line goes to + 14.8V and turns off current source Q3. The current supplied by Q3 in the crystal mode is then supplied through CR1 and R13 from the BW5 line.
Unity Gain Buffer Amplifier
The unity gain buffer amplifier is the same as the 10 dB input buffer amplifier, except that it has a FET input (Q5) and is connected for unity gain. The input is selected by the BW5 line from CR9 in the LC mode, or from CR8 in the crystal mode.
In the crystal mode, the current through Q5 is determined by the difference between the current sourced by Q6 and that sunk by Q7: about 4 mA. A significant deviation from this current should be reflected by the gate-to-source voltage of
Q5. The source should be at least 0.2V more positive than the gate, but not more than 1.5V more positive. If the difference is less than 0.2V, the FET current is too high; if the difference is greater than 1.5V, the FET current is too low.
In either case the FET could also be defective. To determine
8-63
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14 precisely the current through Q5, the difference between the current through R38 and that through R60 should be subtracted from the current through R30. If the results are inconsistent, check the above mentioned resistors.
In LC mode of operation, current is supplied through R37 and CR19 from the BW5 line instead of through Q6. The difference between the current through R37 and that through R30 yields the FET current.
Output Buffer Amplifier The output buffer amplifier is a complementary pair of transistors in which Q9 acts as a source follower boosted by Q10. The current through FET Q9 is set by R53:
V be
(Q10) .7V
I
FET
= ÷ ÷
196
Ω
196
Ω
3 mA
The total current through Q9 and Q10 is set by R54. The input is selected by the BW5 line from either CR16 in the LC mode or CR15 in the crystal mode.
Crystal Filtering Circuits
The bandwidths 1 kHz, 3 kHz, 10 kHz, and 30 kHz are obtained by crystal filtering. The crystals are used in series resonant mode and can be modeled as a series resonant circuit with a parallel capacitance:
The parallel capacitance (Co) and series resistance (Rs) are not desired and are compensated for in the circuit, resulting in this simplified schematic of a single pole of crystal filtering:
PIN diode CR4 functions as a variable resistor at 21.4 MHz. As the resistance is lowered by increasing the current in the
BW6 line, the bandshape becomes narrower. The bandwidth of one pole widens to approximately 70 kHz when the PIN is turned off completely at the 30 kHz BW setting. (For a four-pole filter, the bandwidth of each pole is about 2.3 times the bandwidth of all four poles taken together. The bandwidth of two poles is about 1.5 times the bandwidth of all four poles taken together).
A simplified schematic of a crystal pole, including compensation for Rx and Co in the crystal and input capacitance of the
buffer amplifier, is shown in Figure 8-27.
8-64
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-27. Crystal Pole, Simplified Schematic
The SYM adjustment, C15, compensates for Co by producing a current (-11) that is equal to the current (11) through Co of the crystal but opposite in phase. These currents cancel and nullify the effect of Co. The positive feedback from the collector of Q3 generates a negative output resistance that cancels Rs of the crystal. This is approximated by resistor R6 in the 10 dB input buffer amplifier and by potentiometer R31 in the unity gain buffer amplifier.
The input capacitance of the buffer amplifier, the printed circuit board capacitance, the PIN capacitance, and the centering (CTR) capacitor C25 are in parallel resonance with L7. These components have negligible effect on the band shape and as long as C25 has sufficient range to 'dip' the bandshape, they can be ignored in analyzing the remainder of the circuit.
PIN diode CR4 controls bandwidths from 1 kHz to 10 kHz. For the 30 kHz bandwidth, CR4 is back biased, and R23 sets the bandwidth. If the 30 kHz bandwidth is much too narrow, even with CR4 back biased, the circuit may be loaded by a bad buffer amplifier (Q5, Q7) or inverting amplifier (Q4). If the bandwidth is only slightly narrow, it may be widened by padding R23. If the narrowest bandwidths (1 kHz or 3 kHz) have too little gain, and it cannot be increased enough by
R31, either the crystals have too high a series resistance (defective crystal); or the output resistance is not negative enough (defective buffer amplifier or Q3).
Almost any defect in the Bandwidth Filter boards will result in a faulty dc bias condition in one of the three buffer amplifiers on each board. The dc bias of each stage is less straightforward than ac (21.4 MHz) operation and should be checked carefully.
8-65
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
LC Filtering Circuits
The two LC filtering circuits are used for the wider bandwidths (100 kHz through 3 MHz). They are similar in function; the first LC pole circuit is described. A schematic of the simplified equivalent circuit is shown below:
The LC filter uses a metallized inductor L6 in parallel with three capacitors: C23 (LC CTR) for centering, C21 for temperature compensation, and C20*. The parallel circuit is driven through PIN diode CR3, which functions as a variable resistor. The BW7 line sets the current through CR3. Higher resistance results in narrower bandwidth. A simplified
schematic of the first LC pole circuit is shown in Figure 8-28.
Figure 8-28. LC Pole, Simplified Schematic
8-66
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
C73 and L5 tune out the capacitance of CR3. R19 sets the 100 kHz bandwidth when CR3 is back biased (i.e., highest resistance). CR5 is controlled by the LC FEEDBACK pot R26 and compensates for losses in the parallel resonant circuit.
(In the second LC pole circuit, fixed resistor R56* replaces CR5.) Low gain in one of the poles in the 100 kHz bandwidth is caused by:
1.
The pole being centered at some frequency other than 21.4 MHz (a defective metallized inductor is most common).
2.
3.
4.
The Q of the pole being too low (not a common failure).
Insufficient feedback from the buffer amplifier.
Defective buffer amplifier is loading the circuit.
If the 100 kHz bandwidth amplitude is correct, but that of the 300 kHz bandwidth is too low, either C73 or C74 might not be properly adjusted. If the 300 kHz amplitude is too high, the four LC poles are not tuned close enough to the same
frequency. In either case, refer to Section V, Adjustments.
8-67
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-29. A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-68
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-69
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
A12 STEP GAIN CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
General Description
The Step Gain Assembly contains three amplifier stages to provide a 0 to 50 dB amplification of the 21.4 MHz third IF signal. The amplifier stages are selected by front panel REF LEVEL dBm switch A2S1. At the output of the final amplifier is a two-section bandpass filter. In conjunction with the front panel REF LEVEL FINE control, the step gain assembly also contains the circuitry for the 0 to 12 dB fine control for the reference level. A TEST/NORM switch is available; in TEST position, tests are made at a low gain level.
0 - 12 dB Control
A minimum current flow through PIN diode A12CR3 (maximum allowable diode resistance) is established by the 12 dB potentiometer, A12R6, so the diode is never completely cutoff. Adjustment of A12R6 sets the 0.3 dB point and is adjusted with the REF LEVEL FINE control fully clockwise (-12 position).
The maximum current flow through the PIN diode is set by the 0 dB potentiometer, A12R5. A12R5 is adjusted to the
12.3 dB attenuation point with the REF LEVEL FINE control fully counterclockwise (0 position).
Transistors A12Q8 and A12Q9 are identical current sources. The maximum current is set by 0 dB adjustment A12R5 in the common base circuit. Diode A12CR1 provides temperature compensation for the transistors.
A12Q8 provides current for a bias voltage applied to the anode of the PIN diode. The voltage source consists of A12R6,
A12R17, and A12CR2. Diode A12CR2 provides temperature compensation for the PIN diode. Inductance A12L5 isolates the current source from the RF signal.
A12Q9 provides current for a variable voltage source at the cathode of PIN diode A12CR3. A resistance is formed by
REF LEVEL FINE control R4 (shown on A2 schematic) and fixed resistor A12R9. The fixed 316K ohm resistor is used to shape the value of potentiometer R4 to match the PIN diode resistance changes. The REF LEVEL FINE control varies the voltage at the cathode of PIN diode A12CR3 and thus varies diode current flow. Regulating the current flow through the PIN diode controls the amount of signal attenuation. For example, if PIN diode current flow is increased, more RF signal is shunted or bypassed to ground. A12C12 provides the RF ground and also isolates from ground the variable dc from the REF LEVEL FINE control. When the REF LEVEL FINE control is fully clockwise, the PIN diode is at minimum conduction, and maximum signal is applied to the base of A12Q7. Conversely, when the REF LEVEL FINE control is fully counterclockwise, the PIN diode is at maximum conduction and minimum signal is applied to A12Q7.
Step Gain Amplifiers
Buffer amplifier A12Q7 operates in an emitter-follower configuration and provides isolation between the 0 12 dB control and the 10 dB amplifier.
The three step gain amplifiers can be considered as operational amplifiers. An equivalent circuit for the three stages is
A12R26, 562 ohms; and for the 20 dB amplifiers it is A12R32 and A12R38, 750 ohms. The input resistance R i
is a combination of a fixed series resistance (56.2 ohms) and the controlled resistance of the PIN diodes. The resistance of the PIN diodes is approximatey 10 to 1000 ohms and increases as the forward bias current is decreased from 100 mA to
1 µA. R i
is approximately 260 ohms for the 10 dB amplifier and approximately 83 ohms for the 20 dB amplifiers.
8-71
Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14
Selection of the correct combination of step gain amplifiers is accomplished with front panel REF LEVEL dBm switch
A2S 1. Rotating the switch grounds the emitter circuit of the selected amplifier(s) allowing current to flow through the PIN diode(s). The possible switch combinations allow the gain to vary from unity (all switches open) to 50 dB maximum gain with all three emitter circuits grounded.
A TEST/NORM switch, A12S1, is included in the emitter paths of the 20 dB step gain amplifiers. In the TEST position, the switch defeats the two 20 dB amplifier stages, providing a fixed 10 dB of gain for use when making LOG amplifier adjustments.
Bandpass Filter
The output of the step-gain amplifiers is coupled through a two-section bandpass filter. The bandpass filter consists of
A12L9, A12L10, A12C24, and A12C25 and provides rejection of signals outside the region of 21.4 MHz.
+ 19.5V Regulator
The + 19.5V regulator consists of series regulator A12Q13, driver A12Q12, and reference amplifier A12Q10 and Q11.
Zener diode A12VR1 provides a +6.2V reference for the base of Q11. Q10 senses the + 19.5V output across resistors
A12R45, R46, and R7, the + 19.5V adjustment. Should the output voltage start to drop below + 19.5V, Q10 will start to turn off. This will turn on Q11 which turns on Q12 and Q13, raising the output back to + 19.5V. L11 and C27 filter the +
19.5V output. C26 between the collector and emitter of Q 12 is used to stabilize the feedback gain at high frequencies.
Figure 8-31. Equivalent Circuit for Step Gain Amplifiers
8-72
8-73
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-32. A12 Step Gain Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-74
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-75 through 8-76
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B
A13 BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
TM 11-6625-3061-14
The Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly is very similar to the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11, and corresponding components have the same reference designators. The differences between the two board assemblies are as follows:
1.
2.
3.
A13 has a limiting diode, CR18, connected between the input (P1-23) and ground; A11 does not.
The values of some resistors and capacitors in A13 are different from their counterparts in A11.
A13 has about 0.5 dB less gain than A11.
8-77
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-34. A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-78
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-79 through 8-80
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B
A14 LOG AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY, CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
TM 11-6625-3061-14
General Description
The Log Amplifier Assembly provides the ability to display signals in either a linear mode or 70 dB LOG mode. It also operates with the Step Gain Assembly A12 to provide the last 40 dB of step gain amplification of the 21.4 MHz IF signal.
The Log Amplifier Assembly has seven amplifier stages, with each stage capable of providing both linear and logarithmic amplification. Following the amplifier stages, the amplified IF signal is detected to produce the vertical signal for the display. An offset circuit, following the detector, is used-in the log mode to offset the vertical output in steps equivalent to
40 dB of IF gain.
Log Mode of Operation
The seven amplifier stages limit the gain in sequence to provide 70 dB of log amplification. Each stage consists of an emitter follower used as a voltage source to drive a common-base amplifier whose gain decreases with increasing signal level.
Log Amplifier Gain. The operation of the second stage is described. In the log mode of operation, Q24 (Gain Control
Lines circuit) is on, forward biasing the log diodes, CR10 and CR11, which are Schottky diodes with a forward bias voltage of approximately 0.4V. The gain of the amplifier is set by the ratio of R52 to the total resistance RT between the
150 ohms) for small signals when the ac signal current in log diodes CR10 and CR11 is small compared to their dc bias current. As the ac signal level is increased, the ac signal current increases to the level of the dc bias current and RT increases because of current limiting in the diodes.
The initial (maximum) gain of the stage (approximately 10 dB) is set by the dc bias current through the log diodes. The bias current is controlled by the temperature variable -8VT supply at the emitter of Q24. The final (minimum) gain of the stage (0 dB) is set by the circuit configuration (RT becomes very large) and can be set further by the adjustment of R39 -
10 dB.
Figure 8-36. Simplified Log Amplifier Stage
8-81
Model 8558B
Linear Mode of Operation
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Linear Gain. In the linear mode, the limiting action of the log diodes is removed from the seven amplifier stages. The operation of the second stage is described. Q24 is turned off, and the dc bias current through log diodes CR10 and
CR11 is zero. With zero dc bias current the total resistance, RT, is maximum and the stage gain is approximately unity
In the sixth and seventh stages, an alternate signal path is used to set the gain at about 5 dB per stage. The purpose of this fixed gain is to scale properly between the log and linear modes. These stages are activated by the -8VT from the
AMPLITUDE SCALE switch through R34 (LIN), R93, and R101, and finally through the cathodes of CR25 and CR28.
The combined gain of the two stages is adjusted with R34 (LIN), which controls the dc bias current in the PIN diodes.
Step Gain Operation
The Log Amplifier Board Assembly provides 40 dB of step gain in 10 dB steps. This gain, combined with 50 dB of step gain from Step Gain Assembly A12, will produce up to 90 dB of total step gain. The amount of step gain is selected by the front panel REFERENCE LEVEL switch (A2A1S1). The control lines from A2AiS1, IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6, control the step gain on the Log Amplifier Board Assembly.
Step Gain When in Log Mode. When in log mode, control lines IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6 route + 15V to the Log Offset circuit through R24, R25, and R26. This forward biases diodes CR32, CR33, and CR31. The Log Offset circuit provide
10, 20, 30, or 40 dB of step gain, depending on the state of the control lines. (See Log Offset circuit description.)
Step Gain When in Linear Mode. In linear mode, amplifier stages 2, 3, 4, and 5, are used to provide 40 dB of step gain in 10 dB steps. In linear mode, the LOG/LIN line is at -8VT, Q24 is off, and the log diodes are normally off. Each amplifier stage has unity gain (0 dB). The control lines, IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6 are used to forward bias the log diodes, thus changing the gain of the amplifier stages from 0 dB to 10 dB. The state of the control lines determine which of stages 2, 3, 4, or 5 has a gain of 10 dB.
For example, with INPUT ATTEN at 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL dBm at -60, -8VT is routed through A2A1S2 and
A2A1S1 to the IFG4 control line to forward bias CR22. The fifth amplifier stage gain changes from 0 dB to 10 dB, providing 10 dB of step gain.
Resistors R33, R30, and R27 may be adjusted to set the step gains of stages 5, 4, and 3 and 2, respectively.
Log Mode Temperature Controlled Variable Gain Amplifier
LOG/LIN Relationship. In linear mode, when approximately 700 mVrms (+ 10 dBm) is applied to the input of the log amplifier, the voltage at the output of stage 7 (TP5) is about 1.5 Vrms. With the same input signal in log mode, the output at TP5 is about 2.0 Vrms. To maintain equal relationship with maximum input signal (trace at the top of the display) the output in log mode must be attenuated. This attenuation is achieved through the use of variable gain amplifier Q7, whose gain is determined by the ratio of its collector load to its emitter load.
Variable Gain Amplifier. In linear mode, the LOG/LIN control line is at -8VT. This forward biases CR4 and causes the output of U2B (TP1) to go to approximately + 15V. CR29 is reverse biased, and the gain of the variable gain amplifier is
R104/R105 (100/316), or approximately 0.3. In log mode, the LOG/LIN control line is at + 15V, which reverse biases
CR4. The output of U2B is now approximately + 0.45V. CR29 is forward biased and has an ac resistance of about 100 ohms, which is in parallel with the 100-ohm R104, so the collector load of Q7 is 50 ohms. The gain is 50/316, or 0.15.
This gain depends upon the resistance of CR29, which is set by SLOPE adjustment R23.
8-82
Model 8558B
Detector and Buffer Amplifier
TM 11-6625-3061-14
The signal output of Q7 is applied to the base of Q6, which converts voltage variations into current variations. Q5 is the current driver for the detector. Q4, a half-wave rectifier, is biased just below cutoff by CR1. When the input signal is positive, Q4 is in conduction but is cut off during the negative transistion. The detector output is routed to a low-pass filter and a X2 buffer amplifier, Q21 and Q22, to provide the video output.
Log Offset
The last 40 dB of log step gain is produced in this circuit. When this gain is used, there is already a full 50 dB of gain in the Step Gain Assembly, so the noise of the analyzer is amplified into the log range of the Log Amplifier Assembly. This makes further amplificiation unnecessary since any signal below the log range of the Log Amplifer Assembly would be buried in the noise. The output of the detector can then be offset in 100-mV steps corresponding to 10 dB of IF amplification. This offset is provided by Q23 operating as a stepped current source into R115. With the AMPLITUDE
SCALE switch in one of the LOG/DIV positions, + 15V is routed throuh the closed contacts of the REFERENCE LEVEL dBm switch to the IF gain control lines IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6. With an IF gain control line connected to + 15V, a log-shift diode (CR31, CR32, or CR33) is forward biased, and this bias current, determined by R123, R124, or R125, flows into the emitter of current source Q23. IFG4 and IFG5 each provides 10 dB (100 mV) of log offset gain and IFG6 provides 20 dB
(200 mV). The LOG GAIN adjustment R121 sets the operating point of Q23 for 100-mV steps.
Temperature Compensation Power Supply
Temperature compensation is provided for the - 8VT and + 1V regulators. CR2 and CR4 operate as the temperaturesensing element. Temperature variations cause diode voltage changes that are amplified by U1A for the - 8VT supply and by U2B for the + 1V supply. The - 8VT supply provides bias current for the Schottky diodes in the LOG mode. In the linear mode, the - 8VT supply provides bias current for CR12, CR15, CR19, CR22, CR25, and CR28. The + 1V supply provides bias current for CR29.
+11 V Regulated Power Supply
A precise 5.4V reference voltage VR1 is provided for the + 11V Regulator. This reference voltage is applied to the positive input of U1B. R5 and R6 set the gain of U1B to 2.1. The output at TP2 is 2.1 x 5.4, or 11.3V. Q1 acts as an emitter follower and provides the current drive for the + 11 V supply.
8-83
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-37. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Component Locations
8-84
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-85 through 8-88
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B
A15 VERTICAL DRIVER AND BLANKING CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
TM 11-6625-3061-14
General Description
The Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly provides a preamplifier circuit to amplify the detected and filtered video from the log amplifier. The video signal needed to trigger the sweep generator in INT mode is picked off at the preamplifier.
A vertical driver (differential amplifier) converts the signal to drive the vertical deflection plates (push-pull output).
The blanking and pen lift drive signals are also generated on assembly A15.
Preamplifier
The detected and filtered video input (0V to 0.8V) from the Log Amplifier Assembly A14 is applied to the gate of
A15Q17A. A15Q17, Q11, Q12, and Q18 make up a differential amplifier. The gate of Q17A is the noninverting input and the gate of Q17B is the inverting input. The output at the emitter of A15Q18 is feedback applied to the gate of Q17B through voltage divider A15R11, R12, and R13. The voltage gain of the preamplifier is 1 + R11/R12 + R13 = 10. With an input voltage range of 0V to 0.8V, the maximum signal measured at the output of A15Q18 (TP5) would be 8V. (This signal coupled through A15R17 is the trigger voltage for INT mode.) A buffer amplifier consisting of A15U2A, U2B, and
Q20 provides isolation between the preamplifier and vertical driver. A15U2D and Q13 are current sources to bias the differential amplifier.
The vertical deflection sensitivity of the following vertical driver is 0.8V for full-scale deflection. Since a maximum possible signal of 8V is available from the preamplifier, to obtain the correct signal amplitude, a divide-by-10 and an offset circuit are used.
10 dB/DIV and LIN. The preamplifier output is divided by 10 when LOG/LIN switch A2S2 is in either LIN or 10 dB/DIV.
With LIN or 10 dB/DIV selected, + 15V is applied to the Expand line, back biasing A15CR1, and turning A15Q19 on.
Also A15CR2 is on and CR3 is back biased. With A15Q19 on, a voltage divider consisting of A15R18, R20, and Q19 divides the preamplifier output by 10.
1 dB/DIV. With 1 dB/DIV selected, the Expand line is open and A15Q19 is held off by A15CR1 and R22. The divide-by-
10 circuit is disabled and the full 8-volt preamp voltage is available. Since only the 0.8V peak can be displayed, the signal to the buffer amplifier is offset by -7.2 volts as follows: A current source A15U2C is on, drawing current through
A15CR3 and R18. The voltage drop across R18 is set for 7.2V, so the 8V input is shifted -7.2V below ground. When the signal goes below ground (OV), A15CR4 conducts and clamps the signal at -0.6V. The 1 dB OFFSET adjustment,
A15R1, sets the current for the correct voltage shift.
-5.5V Temperature Compensated Supply
The -5.5V temperature-compensated supply controls four current sources: A15U2D, Q13, U2C, and Q15. The temperature-sensing element, A15U2E (connected as a diode), tracks the base-emitter temperature changes of the current-source transistors.
Vertical Driver
The vertical driver-is a differential amplifier that consists of A15Q2, Q3, Q6, Q7, and Q14 with Q15 as the current source.
drive the CRT vertical deflection plates. A15Q14 is a dual transistor used as the input stage to the Vertical Driver circuit.
The reference input level at the base of A15Q14A is set by the VERT POSN control, A2R6. The gain of the vertical driver is set by the voltage divider consisting of A15R34, R42, and VERT GAIN control A2R7. The transistor pairs
A15Q2/Q6 and A15Q3/Q7 are current-to-voltage amplifiers and are driven by the current from the collectors of A15Q14A and B respectively. Diodes A15CR5 through CR8 protect the bases of A15Q2, Q3, Q6, and Q7 to prevent them from
8-89
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 being driven more negative than approximately 0.6V (the voltage drop across a diode). The resistors A15R44 and R52 decouple the capacitive load of the CRT plates from the emitters of A15Q2 and Q3, preventing overshoot and ringing in the vertical driver. A15Q21, CR11, and CR12 provide vertical driver input switching for normalizer compatibility. When the normalizer is not connected, pull-up resistor A15R56 places the cathode of A15CR11 at + 15V, preventing CR11 from conducting. A15Q21 is turned on so the input to the vertical driver is from the output of the preamplifier. When the normalizer is connected and in the BYPASS mode, the L NORM line at A15J3 is high (+ 12V) preventing A15CR11 from conducting. When the normalizer is operating, the L NORM line is pulled low (- 12V) causing A15CR11 to conduct.
A15Q21 is turned off by the negative voltage at the gate, switching the vertical driver input to the normalizer output (Y
NORM).
Blanking OR
Normally A15Q4 is off placing a low at the base of A15Q9 and turning it on. A15Q4 requires a positive voltage or about
1 mA to turn on and cut Q9 off. A high into the OR circuit provides a high blanking output (0V) to the mainframe. There
resistor A15R56 places the cathode of A15CR12 at + 15V, preventing CR12 from conducting. When the normalizer is connected and in the bypass mode, the L NORM line at A15J3 is high (+12V) keeping A15CR12 from conducting. When the normalizer is operating, the L NORM line is pulled low (-12V) causing A15CR12 to conduct. With A15CR12 conducting, the output of the blanking OR is held at a negative voltage level, inhibiting blanking from the 8558B.
Vertical/Baseline Comparator
The vertical/baseline comparator circuit consists of A15Q16 and Q8. The baseline clipping reference voltage is set by front panel BASELINE CLIPPER control A2R2 which varies the base voltage of A15Q16. The vertical preamplifier output signal is applied to the base of A15Q8. The signal voltage at the base of A15Q8 is compared to the dc reference on
Q16. When the signal voltage becomes more negative than the reference, Q8 turns on and the high input to its base turns A15Q4 on, blanking the display.
Sweep Ramp High/Low Limit Comparator
Operational amplifier A15Q1A and Q1B is connected to form a comparator circuit. A voltage divider made up of A15R6,
R7, and R8 establishes a high and low voltage reference at UIA pin 2 and U1B pin 5. The switching limits are approximately + 0.6V at U1B pin 5 (low frequency blanking) and +6.8V at U1A pin 2 (high frequency blanking). The signal to the other inputs of the comparator is the frequency analog voltage from the YIG main coil swept driver. The frequency analog input voltage is proportional to the instantaneous frequency to which the analyzer is tuned and sweeps from 0.7V to 6.7V as the analyzer tunes from 0 to 1500 MHz. If the YIG tuning voltage at U1B pin 6 goes below 0.6V, the output of U1B rises to about + 14V. This turns on A15Q4 and blanks the display. If the YIG tuning voltage at U1A pin 2 rises above 6.8V, the output of U1A rises to about + 14V turning on A15Q4. Blanking of the display occurs whenever the analyzer is swept below about - 30 MHz or above about 1600 MHz.
Pen Lift Driver
The display is blanked during retrace and the dead time of the sweep voltage. The Retrace Blanking input from A8Q9 in the sweep generator circuit is applied to the emitter of buffer amplifier A15Q1. When the sweep ramp is turned off (dead time), the Retrace Blanking signal rises to + 10V. The + 10V connected to the base of A15Q4 produces the blanking output. The same + 10V Retrace Blanking input is applied to the base of A15Q5, turning Q5 on and Q10 off. The collector of A15Q10 then rises to + 15V. A15Q10 provides a signal that can be used to drive the Pen Lift input on an X-Y recorder. This signal causes the pen to lift during the analyzer sweep retrace and dead time. Breakdown diodes A15VR2 and VR3 suppress the high positive and negative voltage transients that some X-Y recorder pen lift coils can generate.
8-90
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-39. Simplified Vertical Driver Circuit
8-91
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-40. Simplified Blanking Circuit
8-92
8-93
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-41. A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations
8-94
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-95 through 8-100
TM 11-1247-B
Model 8558B
A17 INVERTER CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
TM 11-6625-3061-14
+5V Power Supply
Inverter Assembly A17 is a single transformer inverter with A17Q1 and Q2 operating as a 22 kHz squarewave oscillator.
Diodes A17CR1 and CR2 prevent the transistors from base-emitter reverse breakdown. Positive feedback to sustain the oscillation is taken from the transistor base tickler winding of T1. A17R1* provides current to the base of Q2 to start oscillations when the -12.6V supply is first turned on. The voltage at the collectors of A17Q1 and Q2 is a -12V to +12V square wave. Diodes A17CR5, CR6, CR7, and CR8 are connected as a full-wave rectifier, receiving ac power from 6V taps on either side of the grounded center tap. The rectified dc is filtered by A17L6, L7, L8, C5, and C6. The filtered output voltage is +5V and powers DPM Driver Assembly A1A2. A17VR1, a 6.19V zener, provides protection for the DPM
Driver in case of excessive or reverse voltage.
+20.5V Power Supply
The oscillating current between the collectors of A17Q1 and Q2 through the primary winding of T1 induces a voltage in the secondary of T1. Diodes CR3 and CR4 full-wave rectify this voltage, which is then filtered by A17L3, L4, L5, C3, and
C4. The dc output voltage, approximately +5.5V, is added to the +15V supply to obtain a + 20.5V supply
8-101
Model 8558B
Figure 8-45. A17 Inverter Assembly, Component Locations
8-102
TM 11-6625-3061-14
THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.
PAGES
8-103 through 8-106
TM 11-1247-B
4.
5.
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY A2 DISASSEMBLY AND REPAIR
Tools and Materials Required
Description
No. 2 Spline (Bristol) Wrench
Long No.4 Hex (Allen) Wrench
Long No. 6 Hex (Allen) Wrench
13/64-inch Open-end Wrench
5/16-inch Open-end Wrench
3/8-inch Open-end Wrench
1/2-inch Open-end Wrench
5/8-inch Open-end Wrench
1/4-inch Nut Driver
5/16-inch Nut Driver
3/8-inch Nut Driver
1/2-inch Nut Driver (end covered with heatshrink tubing)
9/16-inch Nut Driver (drilled out, end covered with heatshrink tubing)
Pozi-driv Screwdriver
Long-nose Pliers
Wire Cutters
Instrument Grease
Tiewraps
Small Brush (for Grease Application)
Isoproply Alcohol/Distilled Water Mixture
(50%-50%, for use as cleaning solvent)
HP Part Number Check Digit
8710-0055
5020-0288
5020-0289
8710-0946
8720-0015
8720-0016
8720-0025
8720-0010
8720-0002
8720-0003
8720-0005
8720-0007
8
9
5
8
1
3
8
3
4
0
5
6
8720-0008
8710-0899
8710-0030
87100012
6040-0584
1400-0249
8520-0015
4
0
1
9
7
0
9
1.
2.
3.
REMOVAL OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY FROM HP 8558B CHASSIS
Turn HP 8558B upside down on a flat work surface.
NOTE
Numbers in parentheses match the numerical callouts on Figure 6-3, Front Switch
Assembly (exploded view), in Section VI. Unless otherwise indicated, all other
illustrations referenced in these procedures follow the last procedural step.
Use a 9/16-inch nut driver (drilled out, if necessary, to fit over front panel BNC connectors, and covered with heatshrink tubing or tape to avoid scratching enameled front panel) to remove two dress nuts holding 1 ST LO
OUTPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors to front panel.
Use a 5/16-inch open-end wrench to carefully disconnect semi-rigid Cable W14 from RF Input Limiter U1 (cable connects Limiter to Input Attenuator A3).
Cut plastic tiewrap holding brown CAL OUTPUT Cable W8 to Front Switch Standoff (69).
Disconnect 50-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1W3 (53) from Motherboard Assembly A16.
8-107
8.
9.
Model 8558B
6.
Turn HP 8558B right-side up, with front panel facing you.
7.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Disconnect 14-conductor Ribbon Cable A2AlWl (52) from DPM Driver Assembly A1A2. Fold cable up away from board.
10.
Remove the four Screws (19) attaching DPM Driver Assembly A1A2 to DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21).
Disconnect four wires (0, 916, 918, 923) from upper right corner of Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 (next to
FREQUENCY ZERO potentiometer).
Remove the four screws attaching Front Switch Diecast (1) to left and right side gussets. Remove Front Switch
Assembly A2, with Front Panel and RF Input Attenuator A3, from HP 8558B chassis and set chassis to one side.
DISASSEMBLY OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
12.
13.
14.
11.
15.
16.
NOTE
It is not necessary to remove front panel, all connectors, and all knobs to service
Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 (steps 11-24).
Remove the following front panel knobs using a no. 4 hex (Allen) wrench: FINE TUNE, COARSE TUNE,
RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, REF LEVEL FINE, and REFERENCE LEVEL (including Index Disc,
Retaining Clip, Nylon Spacer Washer(s), Conical Spring, and Input Attenuator pointer).
Remove VIDEO FILTER and BASELINE CLIPPER knobs using a no. 2 spline (Bristol) wrench.
Remove dress nut on FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton using a 13/64-inch open-end wrench.
Remove front panel hex nut and lockwasher on Coarse Tune Bushing (42) using a 1/2-inch nut driver (covered with heatshrink tubing or tape to avoid scratching enameled front panel).
Remove Retaining Clip (25) from RESOLUTION BW Shaft (61).
Place Front Switch Assembly on flat working surface with remaining knobs face-down and lock mechanism facing you. Prop sides of switch assembly to allow knobs and shafts to clear working surface (be careful not to scratch front panel enamel).
17.
18.
19.
Loosen hex nut attaching RF Input Cable Assembly W1 to Front Switch Assembly using a 5/8-inch open-end wrench (Options 001 and 002: Loosen front panel dress nut with special 9/16-inch nut driver). Carefully disconnect input cable assembly from RF Input Attenuator A3 using a 5/16-inch open-end wrench. Remove input cable assembly from Front Switch Assembly.
Remove Screw (19) and Washer (56) attaching Attenuator Bracket (55) to Front Switch Diecast (1). Remove RF
Input Attenuator A3 from Front Switch Assembly.
Disassembly of REFERENCE LEVEL Switch: a. Cut tiewrap holding REF LEVEL FINE wires to Standoff (69).
b. Remove the three Screws (54) attaching Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75) to Standoffs (69).
c. Remove Index Disc Locator and Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, and 71 through 76) from Front Switch
Assembly (set to one side, without detaching wires).
8-108
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 d. Remove three Standoffs (69) used to support Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75). Use a no. 6 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws on Miter Gear (57) attached to Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17); then remove Miter Gear from shaft.
e. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen Rotating Lockout (70) attached to Ref Level Shaft (6), and remove lockout from shaft. Remove Ref Level Detent (68) from Front Switch Assembly. Be careful to keep Ball Bearing (10) and Spring (11) with Ref Level Rotor (67).
f. Remove the three Studs (59) used to support Ref Level Detent (68).
g. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws on front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) (between Front
Switch Board A2A1 and Front Switch Diecast (1) on Ref Level Shaft (6); accessible from side of Front Switch
Assembly). Remove Ref Level Rotor (67) and Ref Level Shaft (6) with rear Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) still attached.
NOTE
Rear Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) on Ref Level Shaft (6) is preset at 9.525
mm (03 in.) from end of shaft (see Figure 848A). Do not remove drive hub unless necessary for repair.
20.
Disassembly of RESOLUTION BW Switch.
a. Use a 1/4-inch Nut Driver to remove two Hex Nuts (22) attaching Bandwidth Switch Board (66) to Front Switch
Assembly, and set board to one side (without detaching wires).
b. Remove Rotor Spacer (64) and Bandwidth Rotor (63). Be careful to keep Ball Bearings (10) and Springs (62) with rotor.
c. Remove Bandwidth Shaft (61), with rear Drive Hub (14) still attached, from Front Switch Assembly.
NOTE
21.
d. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two screws on Coupling Hub (60) attached to Frequency Span Shaft (9), and remove hub from shaft.
e. Remove the two Studs (59) used to support Bandwidth Switch Board (66). Remove Bandwidth Detent (58) from
Front Switch Assembly.
Disconnect Probe Power wires (0, 92, 97) from Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1.
22.
Rear Drive Hub (14) on Bandwidth Shaft (61) is preset flush with collar on shaft
(see Figure 848B). Do not remove drive hub unless necessary for repair.
23.
Remove Screw (23) and Spacer (24) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 to Front Switch Diecast (1) above DPM Display.
to Front Switch Diecast (1).
24.
Twist the left side of Front Switch Board Assembly A2Al down approximately 1/8-inch to provide clearance from
Front Switch Diecast support arm (upper left corner). Lift Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 from Front Switch
Diecast (1) and set aside.
8-109
Model 8558B
25.
Removal of Rotor Assemblies:
TM 11-6625-3061-14 a. Remove Attenuator Drive Rotor (8), front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7), and Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set these parts aside.
b. Remove Frequency Span Rotor (13) with associated parts (9-12, 14-16) from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set aside. Be careful to keep Ball Bearings (10) and Springs (11) with Frequency Span Rotor (13).
NOTE
Drive Hub (14) on Frequency Span Shaft (9) is preset at 12.954 mm (0.510 in.) from end of shaft (see Figure 848C). Do not remove drive hub from shaft unless necessary for repair.
c. Remove SWEEP TRIGGER, MANUAL SWEEP, and SWEEP TIME/DIV knobs using a no. 4 hex wrench.
26.
d. Remove both remaining rotor assemblies from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set aside. Be careful to keep Ball
Bearings (10) and Springs (27) with their respective rotors.
Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws in Lock Knob. Remove Lock Knob.
27.
Use a 5/16-inch nut driver to remove the two nuts attaching front panel to Front Switch Diecast (1). Remove front panel from Front Switch Diecast.
28.
Disassembly of Lock: a. Press Locking Link (5) into Front Switch Diecast (1) to release pressure on Dowel Pin (4). Remove Dowel Pin
through cutout in Front Switch Diecast. (Individual parts are identified in Figure 8-50.)
b. Remove Locking Link (5), Locking Shaft (3), and Lock Spring (2) from Front Switch Diecast.
CLEANING AND INSPECTION OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
1.
2.
3.
All switch contacts must be totally clean and grease-free for proper operation. Use a 50-50 mixture of isopropyl alcohol and distilled water to thoroughly clean switch rotor contacts and Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1.
Avoid touching contacts with fingers.
Inspect for bent or damaged shafts, worn or broken contacts, weak or broken springs, rough feeling potentiometers, cracked castings, and damaged PC boards. Check for signs of corrosion or rust. Replace any suspect parts.
A special Instrument Grease, (see list of Tools and Materials at beginning of these procedures) is recommended exclusively for use during switch reassembly. Lubrication is essential for proper operation of switches and lock.
A small brush is recommended for applying the Instrument Grease.
CAUTION
Misapplied grease might cause intermittent switch connections. Utmost care must be taken during reassembly to avoid excessive application of grease and contamination of switch contacts. Avoid getting grease on fingers.
8-110
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
ASSEMBLY OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
1.
Assembly of Lock: a. Lightly grease Locking Shaft (3) and insert into Front Switch Diecast (1). Lightly grease bearing surfaces of
Locking Link (5).
b. Insert Lock Spring (2) into Front Switch Diecast (1). Press Locking Link (5) fully into Front Switch Diecast and insert Dowel Pin (4) through access cutout (left side of lock boss) to hold lock mechanism in place. Check for correct lock operation.
2.
3.
CAUTION
Pressed-in mounting studs on front panel will break if overtightened.
Use a 5/16-inch nut driver and two hex nuts to carefully install front panel (with pushbutton bezels and DPM window installed) on Front Switch Diecast (1).
Use a no. 4 hex (Allen) wrench to install lock knob on Locking Shaft (3). Base of Lock Knob should clear front panel when Locking Shaft is pushed in.
4.
Installation of Rotor Assemblies: a. Lightly grease all switch rotor detent holes on back of Front Switch Diecast (1).
b. Place Front Switch Assembly on flat working surface with front panel face-down and lock mechanism facing you.
Prop sides of switch assembly to provide clearance for knobs and shafts during assembly (be careful not to scratch front panel enamel).
c. Inspect SWEEP TRIGGER rotor assembly (10, 12, 27-31). Stop Arm (30) and Horseshoe Spring (31) are held in position by Push-on Retainer (29) and should move smoothly without binding (see Figure 849A). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 7 and hole 18 on SWEEP TRIGGER Rotor (28). Check that Spring (27) and Ball
Bearing (10) are in position.
d. Lightly grease long side of SWEEP TRIGGER Shaft (28) and insert SWEEP TRIGGER rotor assembly into leftmost bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1). Position rotor so that Ball Bearing (10) aligns with stop boss on left
side of Front Switch Diecast (see Figure 8-51).
lightly greased and should turn freely inside SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28). Check that Spring (27) and Ball
Bearing (10) are in position. Note that there are no roll pins inserted in the SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor (28).
f. Lightly grease long side of SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28) and insert SWEEP TIME/DIV rotor assembly into next
bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1) (see Figure 8-51).
g. Inspect FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly (9-16). If Drive Hub (14) has been loosened or removed from
positioned in hole 1 and hole 16 on Frequency Span Rotor (13), as shown in Figure 849C. Slotted Bushing (15),
Hairpin Spring (16), and Frequency Span Shaft must be lightly greased where they contact each other for proper operation of push-pull mechanism. Check that Springs (11), Ball Bearings (10), Slotted Bushing, and Hairpin
Spring are in correct position.
8-111
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 h. Lightly grease long side of Frequency Span Shaft (9) and insert FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly (9-16) into next bushing in Front Switch Diecast (I). Position FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly so that stop boss on Front Switch
Diecast does not fall within small span between Roll Pins (12), as shown in Figure 8-51.
j. Inspect front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7). Note that pin is offset to one side of drive hub; place drive hub over right-most bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1) with this side down (i.e., pin as close as possible to Front
Switch Diecast) for proper switch operation.
NOTE
Correct side of front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) must be oriented towards Front
Switch Diecast (1) for proper operation of Front Switch Assembly.
k. Set Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) over Anticrush Drive Hub (7) with Attenuator Drive Rotor gear facing up. Long pin on Attenuator Drive Rotor should protrude through curved slot in diecast.
l. Lightly grease gear end of Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) and insert into Front Switch Diecast (1) as shown in
Figure 8-51 Place metal Washer (18) on shaft.
m. Clean contact fingers on all rotors using lint-free cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture. All rotors
should be in proper position as shown in Figure 8-51
5. Installation of Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1: a. Inspect Front Switch Board Assembly. Check switch traces for dirt, grease, or wear. Check interconnect wires, solder joints, pushbutton switches, and ribbon cables (52, 53).
b. Clean switch traces using lint-free cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture. No residue should be visible on traces.
c. Use a 1/4-inch nut driver to tighten Hex Nuts (22) and Screws (19) fastening DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21) to
Front Switch Board Assembly.
d. Use a 3/8-inch open-end wrench to tighten Hex Nut (36) and Lockwasher (35) attaching FREQUENCY ZERO
Potentiometer (37) to Front Switch Board Assembly. Use a no. 2 spline (Bristol) wrench to install FREQUENCY
ZERO Knob (34).
e. Use a 3/8-inch open-end wrench to tighten Hex Nut (36) and Lockwasher (35) attaching VIDEO FILTER
Potentiometer (39) and metal Washer (38) to Front Switch Board Assembly.
f. Use a 1/2-inch open-end wrench to tighten inner Hex Nut (32) and Washer (33) attaching Dual Tune Pot assembly (25, 32, 33, 40-51, 77) to Front Switch Board Assembly. Note that Roll Pin (12) aligns with hole in switch board to locate Dual Pot Bracket (45); Washer (33) between bracket and switch board is critical to proper
switch operation. See Figure 8-52 for front view of assembled switch board.
g. Check Dual Tune Pot assembly for smooth operation and proper gear meshing; disassemble and lightly grease shafts if necessary. Install second Hex Nut (32) mid-way onto Coarse Tune Shaft Bushing (42).
h. Set Front Switch Board Assembly into place on partially-assembled Front Switch Assembly and use a Stud (59) on right-most side of switch assembly to loosely fasten switch board to Front Switch Diecast (1).
8-112
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 i. With one Stud (59) in place but not tight, twist left side of Front Switch Board Assembly up approximately 1/8inch to fasten switch board under Front Switch Diecast support arm (upper left corner) and align switch shafts.
Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).
k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to temporarily install SWEEP TRIGGER, SWEEP TIME/DIV, MANUAL SWEEP, and
FREQ SPAN/DIV knobs. Insert FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton through front panel and fasten with dress nut.
Use a 13/64-inch open-end wrench to tighten nut to front panel.
CAUTION
Do not overtighten screws and studs into Front Switch Diecast (1).
l. Tighten Stud (59) and left-most Screw (54) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).
Check all switch rotors for smooth, free switch action. Readjust position of Front Switch Board Assembly as necessary for proper switch action.
m. Install Screw (23) and Spacer (24) used to attach Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1) above DPM Display.
n. Tighten the two remaining Screws (54) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).
o. Recheck all switch rotors for smooth, free switch action and readjust Front Switch Assembly as necessary.
p. Connect PROBE POWER wires (0, 92, 97) to respective pins on Front Switch Board Assembly.
6. Assembly of RESOLUTION BW Switch: a. Place Coupler Hub (60) on Frequency Span Shaft (9) with pin facing up (away from Front Switch Assembly). Do not tighten Coupler Hub at this time.
b. Center Bandwidth Detent (58) over Coupler Hub (60) with stop tab towards top of Front Switch Assembly, and fasten to Front Switch Assembly using two Studs (59).
adjustment. Lightly grease narrow end of Bandwidth Shaft (61) and detent holes on Bandwidth Detent (58).
Insert Bandwidth Shaft (61) through Frequency Span Shaft (9).
d. Inspect RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 1 and hole 18 as shown in
Figure 8-49E. Check that Springs (62) and Ball Bearings (10) are in position.
e. Place RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63) onto Bandwidth Shaft (61). Position RESOLUTION BW Rotor assembly so that stop tab does not fall within small span between Roll Pins (12).
f. Place Rotor Spacer (64) onto RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63).
g. Clean contract fingers on RESOLUTION BW Rotor and switch traces on Bandwidth Switch Board (66) using lintfree cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture.
h. Use a 1/4-inch nut driver to fasten Bandwidth Switch Board (66) to Front Switch Assembly with two Hex Nuts
(22). End of Bandwidth Shaft (61) must not bind against hole in board. Align MANUAL SWEEP Shaft (26) with
MANUAL SWEEP Potentiometer (65) by turning MANUAL SWEEP knob clockwise until shaft engages with
MANUAL SWEEP Potentiometer.
8-113
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
NOTE
Depth of MANUAL SWEEP Shaft (26) can be adjusted if necessary by carefully tapping
SWEEPTIME/DIV Shaft (28) farther into the white plastic rotor.
i. Turn Front Switch Assembly over and remove FREQ SPAN/DIV knob using a no. 4 hex wrench.
7.
j. Install Retainer Clip (25) on Bandwidth Shaft (61).
k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to temporarily install FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW knobs.
l. Pull and turn FREQ SPAN/DIV Knob until a set screw is visible on Coupling Hub (60). Push FREQ SPAN/DIV knob in and out to align pin on Coupling Hub with slots in Bandwidth Rotor (63). With FREQ SPAN/DIV knob pushed in and Coupling Hub flush against Bandwidth Rotor (pin aligned), tighten set screw using a no. 4 hex wrench. Turn FREQ SPAN/DIV knob until second set screw is visible, and tighten second set screw.
m. Push FREQ SPAN/DIV knob in and out while observing Bandwidth Rotor (63). Bandwidth Rotor will not move if
Coupling Hub (60) is properly aligned. Readjust Coupling Hub as necessary for proper operation.
Assembly of REFERENCE LEVEL Switch: a. Install remaining two Studs (59) on Front Switch Assembly. Check that all screws and studs have been tightened.
8-48A for correct dimensions for adjustment.
c. Inspect Ref Level Rotor (67). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 1 and hole 9, as shown in Figure 849F.
Check that Spring (11) and Ball Bearing (10) are in position. Insert Ref Level Shaft (6) through Ref Level Rotor so that rear Anticrush Drive Hub (7) seats properly into rotor.
d. Lightly grease long end of Ref Level Shaft (6) and insert through Front Switch Board Assembly A2Al, Attenuator
Drive Rotor (8), front Anticrush Drive Hub (7), and bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1).
e. Lightly grease detent holes on flat side of Ref Level Detent (68). Mount detent on three Studs (59) and fasten tightly with three Standoffs (69).
CAUTION
Hollow Ref Level Shaft (6) might be damaged if set screws in Rotating Lockout
(70) are tightened excessively.
f. Place Rotating Lockout (70) on Ref Level Shaft (6) with teeth flat against Ref Level Detent (68). Lockout teeth should be aligned to miss pin on Ref Level Detent when Ref Level Shaft is pushed in (switch in any detent position). With Ref Level Shaft fully extended from front panel, use a no. 4 hex wrench to tighten Rotating
Lockout.
g. Push Ref Level Shaft (6) in and out and check for smooth mechanical feel and proper Rotating Lockout (70) alignment. Rotating Lockout should not bind against Ref Level Detent (68) and should allow Ref Level Shaft to turn smoothly between detent positions. Adjust Rotating Lockout as necessary for proper operation.
8-114
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 h. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to lightly tighten one set screw in front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) visible between
Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) and Front Switch Diecast (1).
i. Turn Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) so that long pin (for Input Attenuator pointer) is at bottom of Front Switch Diecast
(1). Hold Attenuator Drive Rotor in position and push in on Ref Level Shaft (6) to align front Anticrush Drive Hub
(7).
j. Push Ref Level Shaft (6) in and out while observing Ref Level Rotor (67) and Attenuator Drive Rotor (8). Rotors will not move when front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) is properly adjusted.
k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to firmly tighten both set screws in front Anticrush Drive Hub (7). Recheck Ref Level
Shaft (6) as in step j, and readjust front Anticrush Drive Hub as necessary.
l. Slip Miter Gear (57) over Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17). Do not tighten at this time.
8.
m. Inspect Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, 72-76). Ref Level Fine Shaft (72) should turn smoothly. Check Ref
Level Fine Potentiometer (76) and connecting wires for good electrical connections. Lightly grease Ref Level
Fine Shaft and hollow Index Disc Locator (71) shaft.
n. Install Index Disc Locator (71) on Front Switch Assembly. Hole in locator bar rides over left-most Standoff (69) used to support Ref Leve Fine Pot Plate (75). Install Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, 72-76) on Front Switch
Shaft (72) should turn smoothly without binding over its full rotation. Adjust position of Ref Level Fine Pot Plate as necessary.
Installation of RF Input Attenuator A3: a. Mount RF Input Attenuator to Attenuator Bracket (55) using two Screws (53). Check all eight attenuator positions by hand for proper detent action and smooth operation. Leave attenuator in full counter-clockwise position.
b. Slide Miter Gear (57) to end of Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) against Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75). Set
Attenuator Assembly in place on Front Switch Assembly, with notch in Attenuator Bracket (55) lightly greased and aligned with Attenuator Shaft Assembly. Use Washer (56) and Screw (19) to fasten Attenuator Bracket to lower left corner of Front Switch Diecast (1). (Do not tighten Miter Gear at this time.) c. Insert RF Input Cable Assembly W1 through front panel and loosely attach with hex nut. Carefully connect cable assembly to RF Input Attenuator using a 5/16-inch open-end wrench. Tighten cable assembly to front panel using a 5/8-inch open-end wrench (Options 001 and 002: use special 9/16-inch nut driver to tighten front panel dress nut).
NOTE
Front-panel control knobs and their attaching parts are identified in Figure 6-2.
Numbers in parentheses match numerical callouts on Figure 6-3.
9.
Installation of Knobs: a. Turn SWEEP TRIGGER Shaft (28) fully clockwise (as seen from front of Front Switch Assembly) to spring4oaded SINGLE position and release. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install SWEEP TRIGGER knob with
SINGLE line aligned with painted arrow on front panel. Check for proper switch operation and alignment.
8-115
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 b. Turn SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28) to align Ball Bearing (10) on SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor with left-most edge of stop boss on Front Switch Diecast (1). This positions SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor with Ball Bearing slightly right of
12 o'clock position (as seen from front of Front Panel Assembly). Use a no. 4 hex wrench to lightly tighten
SWEEP TIME/DIV knob onto SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft with approximate center of green AUTO position aligned with painted arrow on front panel. Turn SWEEP TIME/DIV knob to any calibrated sweep time position and align knob markings exactly with painted arrow on front panel. Tighten SWEEP TIME/DIV knob and check for proper switch operation and alignment.
c. Uncouple RESOLUTION BW Shaft (61) from FREQ SPAN/DIV Shaft (9) by pulling both shafts out. Turn each shaft fully clockwise. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install FREQ SPAN/DIV knob with 100 MHz indicated, checking that the plastic indicator guide on back of knob does not completely bottom into hole in Front Switch Diecast (1).
Install RESOLUTION BW Knob with 3 MHz indicated. Check for proper operation and alignment of both switches. Push-pull action should be smooth and positive.
proper shim width. Nylon washers should shim Index Disc slightly away from labelled ring on REFERENCE
LEVEL knob to prevent rubbing against painted numbers. Add or remove shim washers as necessary to provide slight clearance.
e. Turn Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) fully counter-clockwise so that Input Attenuator Pointer guide pin (P/O 8) is at bottom of front panel. Turn Ref Level Shaft (6) fully clockwise. Place plastic Input Attenuator Pointer over guide pin (pointer should indicate 70 dB). Place large end of conical spring against Input Attenuator Pointer and slide
REFERENCE LEVEL knob, nylon washer(s), and Index Disc (from step d) onto Ref Level Shaft, securing with retainer clip.
f. Use a no. 6 hex wrench to adjust Miter Gears (57) for alignment of Input Attenuator Pointer with 70 dB front panel label and proper gear mesh (Input Attenuator A3 still in full counter-clockwise position).
g. Turn REFERENCE LEVEL knob to indicate level of CAL OUTPUT signal (i.e., -30 dB; Option 002: +20 dBm V) and tighten knob securely with a no. 4 hex wrench. Check for proper operation and alignment of REFERENCE
LEVEL and INPUT ATTEN controls, and readjust knob, gears, and Rotating Lockout (70) as necessary.
Reference Level should range from -10 dBm to -100 dBm with 0 dB INPUT ATTEN selected (Option 002: +40 dBm V to -50 dBm).
h. Turn REF LEVEL FINE Shaft (72) fully counter-clockwise and use a no. 4 hex wrench to install REF LEVEL
FINE knob with 0 dB indicated. Check for proper operation and alignment and readjust knob as necessary.
i. Turn BASELINE CLIPPER Shaft and VIDEO FILTER Shaft (39) fully counter-clockwise and use a no. 2 spline wrench to install BASELINE CLIPPER and VIDEO FILTER knobs in OFF position. Check for proper operation and alignment and readjust as necessary.
j. Loosely tighten second Hex Nut (32) on Coarse Tune Bushing (42) against Front Switch Diecast (1). Install front panel nut and washer on Coarse Tune Bushing and tighten with special 1/2-inch nut driver.
k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install COARSE TUNE and FINE TUNE knobs. Base of COARSE TUNE knob should clear front panel. Check for proper operation of TUNING control.
8-116
14.
15.
16.
Model 8558B
10.
11.
TM 11-6625-3061-14
INSTALLATION OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY INTO HP 8558B CHASSIS
Set Front Switch Assembly into place in chassis, being careful not to bend semi-rigid cables or pinch wires or ribbon cables. Attach Front Switch Diecast (1) to left and right side gussets with four screws.
Connect four wires (0, 916, 918, 923) to correspondingly4abelled pins in upper right corner of Front Switch Board
A2A1.
Attach DPM Driver Assembly A1A2 to DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21) with four Screws (19).
12.
13.
Connect 14-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1W1 (52) to DPM Driver Assembly A1A2.
Connect 50-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1 W2 (53) to Motherboard Assembly A16.
Use a 5/16-inch open-end wrench to carefully connect Semi-rigid Cable W14 to RF Input Limiter U1.
Use special 9/16-inch nut driver to install CAL OUTPUT and 1ST LO OUTPUT connectors to front panel with two dress nuts.
17.
18.
Attach brown CAL OUTPUT Cable W8 to Front Switch Standoff (69) with tiewrap.
Slide HP 8558B into display mainframe, turn instrument ON, and verify proper operation of all controls.
8-117
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-48. Shaft Assemblies
8-118
Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-49. Rotor Assemblies
8-119
Model 8558B
Figure 8-50. Machined Parts
Figure 8-51. Proper Positioning of Rotors on Front Switch Diecast
8-120
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
Figure 8-52. Front View of Switchboard Assembly A2A1
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-53. Rear View of Front Switch Assembly A2
8-121/8-122(blank)
DA Pam 310-1
DA Pam 738-750
TM 750-244-2
TM 11-6625-3061-24P
TM 11-6625-3061-14
APPENDIX A
REFERENCES
Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms.
The Army Maintenance Management System (TAMMS).
Procedures for Destruction of Electronics Materiel to Prevent Enemy Use (Electronics
Command).
Organizational, Direct Support, and General Support Maintenance, Repair Parts and Special
Tools List, and Maintenance Allocation Chart for Spectrum Analyzer Hewlett-Packard Model
8558B
A-1/(A-2 blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
APPENDIX B
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM LIST
Section I. INTRODUCTION
B-1. Scope
The appendix lists integral components of and basic issue items for Spectrum Analyzer, HP Model 8558B to help you inventory items required for safe and efficient operation.
B-2. General
This Components of End Item List is divided into the-following sections: a.
Section II. Integral Components of the End Item. These items, when assembled, comprise the Spectrum
Analyzer, HP Model 8558B and must accompany it whenever it is transferred or turned in. The illustrations referenced will help you in identify these items.
b.
Section III. Basic Issue Items. Not applicable.
B-3. Explanation of Columns a.
Illustration. This column is divided as follows:
(1) Figure number. Indicates the figure number of the illustration on which item is shown.
(2) Item number. The number used to identify item called out in the illustration.
b.
National Stock Number. Indicates the National Stock Number assigned to the item and which will be used for requisitioning.
c. Description. Indicated the Federal item name and, if required, a minimum description to identify the item. The part number indicated the primary number used by the manufacturer, which controls the design and characteristics of the item by means of its engineering drawings, specifications, standards, and inspection requirements to identify an item or range of items. Following the part number, the Federal Supply Code for Manufacturers (FSCM) is shown in parentheses.
d.
Location. The physical location of each item listed is given in the column. The lists are designed to inventory all items in one
B-1
TM 11-6625-3061-14 area of the major item before moving in to an adjacent area.
e.
Usable on Code. Not applicable.
f.
Quantity Required (Qty Reqd). This column lists the quantity of each item required for a complete major item.
g.
Quantity. This column is left blank for use during the inventory. Under the Rcvd column, list the quantity you actually receive on your major item. The Date columns are for your use when you inventory the major item.
B-2
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Section II. INTEGRAL COMPONENTS OF END ITEM
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
ILLUSTRATION QUANTITY
(A) (B) NATIONAL DESCRIPTION USUABLE
FIG. ITEM STOCK ON QTY
NO. NO. NUMBER PART NUMBER CAGE LOCATION CODE REQD RCVD DATE
SPECTRUM ANALYZER,
HP MODEL 8558B 28480
B-3
TM 11-6625-3061-14
APPENDIX D
MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION
Section I. INTRODUCTION
D-1. General
This appendix provides a summary of the maintenance operations for Spectrum Analyzer, HP Model 8558B. It authorizes categories of maintenance for specific maintenance function on repairable items and components and the tools and equipment required to perform each function. This appendix may be used as an aid in planning maintenance operations.
D-2. Maintenance Function
Maintenance functions will be limited to and defined as follows: a.
Inspect. To determine the serviceability of an item by comparing its physical, mechanical, and/or electrical characteristics with established standards through examination.
b.
Test. To verify serviceability and to detect incipient failure by measuring the mechanical or electrical characteristics of an item and comparing those characteristics with prescribed standards.
c.
Service. Operations required periodically to keep an item in proper operating condition; ie., to clean
(decontaminate), to preserve, to drain, to paint, or to replenish fuel, lubricants, hydraulic fluids, or compressed air supplies.
d.
Adjust. To maintain, within prescribed limits, by bringing into proper or exact position, or setting the operating characteristics to specified parameters.
e.
Aline. To adjust specified variable elements of an item to bring about optimum or desired performance.
f.
Calibrate. To determine and cause corrections to be made or to be adjusted in instruments or test measuring and diagnostics equip-
D-1
TM 11-6625-3061-14 ments use in precision measurement. Consists of comparison of two instruments, one in which is a certified standard of known accuracy of the instrument being compared.
g.
Install. The act of emplacing, seating, or fixing into position an item, part, module (component or assembly) in a manner to allow the proper functioning of the equipment or system.
h.
Replace. The act of substituting a serviceable like type part, subassembly, or module (component or assembly) for an unserviceable counterpart.
i.
Repair. The application of maintenance services (inspect, test, service, adjust, aline, calibrate, replace) or other maintenance actions (welding, grinding, riveting, staightening, facing, remachining, or resurfacing) to restore serviceability to an item by correcting specific damage, fault, malfunction, or failure in a part, subassembly, module
(component or assembly), end item, or system. This function does not include the trial and error replacement of running spare type items such as fuses, lamps, or electron tubes.
j.
Overhaul. That maintenance effort (service/action) necessary to restore an item to a completely serviceable/operational condition as prescribed by maintenance standards (.i..e., DMWR) in appropriate technical publications. Overhaul is normally the highest degree of maintenance performed by the Army. Overhaul does not normally return an item to like new condition.
k.
Rebuild. Consists of those services/actions necessary for the restoration of unserviceable equipment to a like new condition in accordance with original manufacturing standards. Rebuild is the highest degree of materiel maintenance applied to Army equipment.
The rebuild operation includes the act of returning to zero those age measurements (hours, miles, etc.) considered in classifying Army equipments/components.
D-3. Column Entries a.
Column 1, Group Number. Column 1 lists group numbers, the purpose of which is to indentify components, assemblies, subassemblies,
D-2
TM 11-6625-3061-14 and modules with the next higher assembly.
b.
Column 2, Component/Assembly. Column 2 contains the noun names of components, assemblies, subassemblies, and modules for which maintenance is authorized, c.
Column 3, Maintenance Functions. Column 3 lists the functions to be performed on the item listed column 2.
When items are listed without maintenance functions, it is solely for purpose of having the group numbers in the MAC and RPSTL coincide.
d.
Column 4, Maintenance Category. Column 4 specifies, by the listing of a "work time" figure in the appropriate subcolumn(s), the lowest level of maintenance authorized to perform the function listed in column 3. This figure represents the active time required to perform that maintenance function at the indicated category of maintenance. If the number or complexity of the tasks within the listed maintenance function vary at different maintenance categories, appropriate "work time" figures will be shown for each category. The number of task-hours specified by the "work time" figure represents the average time required to restore an item (assembly, subassembly, components, module, end item or system) to a serviceable condition under typical field operating conditions. This time includes preparation time, troubleshooting time, and quality assurance/quality control time in addition to the time required to perform the specific tasks indentified for the maintenance function authorized in the maintenance allocation chart. Subcolumns of column 4 are as follows:
C - Operator/Crew
O - Organizational
F - Direct Support
H - General Support
D - Depot e.
Columns 5, Tools and Equipment. Column 5 specifies by code, those common tools sets (not individual tools) and special tools, test, and support equipment required to perform the designated function.
f.
which is pertinent
D-3
TM 11-6625-3061-14 to the item opposite the particular code.
D-4. Tool and Test Equipment Requirements (Sec III)
a.
Tool and Test Equipment Reference Code. The numbers in this column coincide with the numbers used in the tools and equipment column of the MAC. The numbers indicate the applicable tool or test equipment for the maintenance functions.
b.
Maintenance Category. The codes in this column indicate the maintenance category allocated the tool or test equipment.
c.
Nomenclature. This column lists the noun name and nomenclature of the tools and test functions.
d.
National/NATO Stock Number. This column lists the National/NATO Stock Number of the specific tool or test equipment.
e.
Tool number. This column lists the manufacturer's part number of the tool followed by the Federal Supply Code for manufacturers (5 digit) in parentheses.
a.
Reference Code. This code refers to the appropriate item in section II, column 6.
b.
Remarks. This column provides the required explanatory information necessary to clarify items appearing in
D-4
TM 11-6625-3061-14
(1)
GROUP
NUMBER
00
01
0101
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
(2)
THIRD CONVERTER
08558-60154
A9
BW FILTER NO. 1
08559-60058
All
BW FILTER NO. 2
08558-6019
A13
LOG AMPLIFIER ASSY
5061-5411
A14
SECTION II MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION CHART
FOR
SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B
COMPONENT ASSEMBLY
SPECTRUM ANALYZER
HP8558B
MTBF= 10,000 Hrs
FRONT SWITCH ASSY
08558-60100
A2
SWITCH BOARD ASSY
08558-60160
A2A1
FIRST CONVERTER
08558-60004
A4
SECOND CONVERTER
08558-60097
AS
MOTHERBOARD ASSY
08558-65159
A16
(3)
MAINTENANCE
FUNCTION
Inspect
Test
Test
Adjust
Calibrate
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
Inspect
Test
Replace
Repair
(4)
MAINTENANCE LEVEL
C O F H
0.1
3.0
0.3
0.1
9.2
10.
D
(5)
TOOLS AND
EQUIPMENT REMARKS
3.0
1-20
6
1,3-25
1,2,6-
20,22-
30
10.
B
A
B
(6)
B,C,E
D
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
03
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
0.1
0.3
1.0
4.0
6
6
0.1
0.5
2.0
6
4.0
6
DRSEL-MA Form 6031,(1 Jul 76) HISA-FM 2314-79
D-5
TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION III. TOOL AND TEST EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS
FOR
SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B
TOOL OR TEST MAINTENANCE NATIONAL/NATO TOOL
EQUIPMENT CATEGORY NOMENCLATURE STOCK NUMBER NUMBER
REF CODE
1 H TRACKING GENERATOR HP8444A 6625-00-185-4802
2 H FUNCTION GENERATOR HP3310A 6625-01-028-4989
3 H POWER SPLITTER HP11667A 6625-01-017-2713
4 H 10 dB ATTENUATOR HP8491A 5985-00-128-0195
5 H 50 ohm TERMINATOR HP908A
6 F,H TOOL KIT, ELEC EQUIP TK-105/G 5180-00-610-8177
7 H TUNING TOOL 08555-60107
8 H ALINEMENT TOOL, MET TIP 8710-0630 5120-01-080-7650
9 H ALINEMENT TOOL, PLASTIC 8710-0033 1005-00-634-8012
10 H DISPLAY MAINFRAME HP181T
11 H FREQUENCY COUNTER HP5342A 6625-01-103-2958
12 H DIGITAL VOLTMETER HP3455A 6625-01-874-1000
13 H POWER METER HP435A 6625-00-449-9167
14 H POWER SENSOR HP8482A
15 H AMPLIFIER HP8447D 6625-01-065-0305
16 H SIGNAL GENERATOR HP8460 6625-00-318-6304
17 H COMB GENERATOR HP8406A 6625-00-937-3525
18 H 300 MHz LP FILTER TPL300-4AB
19 H STEP ATTENUATOR HP355C 5985-00-525-5074
20 H STEP ATTENUATOR HP355D 5985-00-957-1860
21 H SWEEP OSCILLATOR HP8350A
22 H RF PLUGIN HP83522A
23 H TIME COUNTER HP5308A 6625-01-022-6231
24 H OSCILLOSCOPE HP1741A 6625-01-058-0139
25 H CRYSTAL DETECTOR HP423B 6625-01-035-0626
26 H SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP141T 6625-00-424-4370
27 H BOARD PULLER 03950-4001
28 H EXTENDER BOARD, 6 PIN 08559-60042
29 H EXTENDER BOARD, 10 PIN 85680-60028 6625-01-137-2674
30 H EXTENDER BOARD, 22 PIN 08565-60107
31 H EXTENDER CABLE ASSY 5060-0303 5995-01-036-2960
D-6
TM 11-6625-3061-14
SECTION IV. REMARKS
SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B
REMARKS REFERENCE
CODE
C
D
A
B
E
Adjustments made when combining units with other subassemblies in display frame.
Test, repair, and calibrate by USATSG at general support.
Subassemblies A3, A6, A7, A8, A10, A12, A15, A17 and W1 through W6 are throw-aways.
Repair consists of replacement of subassemblies and mainframe components as required.
A1is not a replaceable subassembly and has no part number.
D-7/(D-8 blank
By Order of the Secretary of the Army:
Official:
MILDRED E. HEDBERG
Brigadier General, United States Army
The Adjutant General
Distribution:
To be distributed in accordance with special list.
JOHN A. WICKHAM JR.
General, United States Army
Chief of Staff
*U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE: 1986-612-069
Model 8558B
FRONT PANEL FEATURES
1.
VERTICAL POSN: Adjusts vertical position of CRT trace.
9.
1st LO OUTPUT: 50-ohm BNC output provides 2.05-3.55 GHz first LO signal at approximately + 10 dBm. Terminate with
50ohm load when not in use.
2.
3.
4.
VERTICAL GAIN: Adjusts deflection circuit gain for amplitude scale calibration of CRT display.
FREQUENCY CAL: Removes tuning hysteresis from first LO (YIG oscillator).
Should be pressed before calibration and whenever TUNING (22) is changed by more than 50 MHz.
FREQUENCY ZERO: Adjusts
FREQUENCY MHz (20) readout for calibration on LO feedthrough.
10. INPUT 50f: Precision type N (female) signal input connector with 50-ohm input impedance.
Options 001 and 002: INPUT 75f- 75-ohm
BNC (female) signal input connector.
CAUTION
50-ohm BNC connectors might cause damage if used directly with
Option 001 and 002 75-ohm BNC
INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.
0 (Zero Span): Spectrum analyzer operates as a manually-tuned receiver, at frequency indicated by FREQUENCY
MHz readout, for time-domain display of signal modulation. 16 calibrated sweep times selectable with SWEEP TIME/DIV control (11).
195 MHz for increased resolution at lower frequencies.
21. START-CENTER: Selects mode of
FREQUENCY MHz (20) readout.
14. REF LEVEL CAL: Adjusts spectrum analyzer RF gain to calibrate top CRT graticule line for absolute amplitude measurements.
22. TUNING: Adjusts spectrum analyzer start or center frequency. Coarse tuning is provided by large knob; smaller knob provides FINE tuning.
180-Series Display Mainframes
15. RESOLUTION BW: Selects spectrum analyzer 3-dB bandwidth. Alignment of
OPTIMUM markings ( > < ) automatically selects optimum resolution bandwidth for any frequency span. Control pushed in to couple mechanically with FREQ
SPAN/DIV.
23. CALIBRATOR (180TR, 182T): Provides 1 kHz square wave at two amplitudes: 250 mV and 10V p-p (not used with spectrum analyzer).
24. Ground Connection (180TR, 182T):
Provides chassis ground connection point.
5.
BASELINE CLIPPER: Blanks variable lower portion of CRT display. Prevents
CRT blooming with a variable persistence storage display mainframe (i.e.
181T/TR).
11. SWEEP TIME/DIV: Selects time required to sweep one major horizontal division on
CRT.
6.
VIDEO FILTER: Post-detection low-pass filter smooths CRT trace by averaging random noise. Filter bandwidth scaled by resolution bandwidth (15) setting. MAX
(detent) position selects 1.5 Hz bandwidth for maximum noise averaging and noise level measurements. MAX VIDEO
FILTER should not be used for CW signal analysis.
AUTO: Automatically selects fastest allowable sweep time as a function of
FREQ SPAN/DIV (13), RESOLUTION
BW (15), and VIDEO FILTER (6) settings to maintain display amplitude calibration. AUTO operation retained with FREQ SPAN/DIV and
RESOLUTION BW controls uncoupled.
7.
8.
SWEEP Indicator: Remains lit during each sweep.
SWEEP TRIGGER: Selects sweep trigger mode.
TIME/DIV: Selects calibrated sweep time; used primarily with 0 (Zero) frequency span for time-domain analysis of modulation waveforms.
Display amplitude calibration not automatically guaranteed for other frequency spans.
MAN: Enables manual frequency scan using MAN SWEEP knob.
VIDEO: Sweep triggered on internal post-detection video waveform. Onehalf major division of vertical deflection
(noise, AM signal, etc.) required to trigger sweep. Normally used with 0
(zero) frequency span for time-domain analysis.
LINE: Sweep triggered at ac line frequency.
12. PROBE POWER: Provides power for high-impedance active probes such as the
HP 1121A. (See Section I of HP 8558B
Operation and Service Manual for details regarding use with Options 001 and 002.)
13. FREQ SPAN/DIV: Selects CRT horizontal axis frequency calibration.
FREE RUN: End of each sweep triggers new sweep.
SINGLE: Single sweep triggered or reset by turning SWEEP TRIGGER clockwise momentarily.
MHz/DIV kHz/DIV: Selects desired frequency span. Alignment of OPTIMUM markings (><) selects optimum resolution bandwidth (15).
16. CAL OUTPUT: BNC output provides 280
MHz, -30 dBm calibration signal from 50f output impedance.
Option 001: 280 MHz, -30 dBm calibration signal from 759 output impedance.
Option 002: 280 MHz, + 20 dBmV calibration signal from 752 output impedance.
28. ASTIG: Adjusts CRT spot shape.
CAUTION
29. INTENSITY: Adjusts CRT trace intensity.
50-ohm BNC connectors might cause damage if used directly with
Option 001 and 002 75-ohm BNC
INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.
30. FIND BEAM: Intensifies trace and forces on-screen display (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).
17. 10 dB/DIV - dB/DIV - LIN (Amplitude
Scale): Selects CRT vertical axis amplitude calibration (logarithmic or linear scale). Reference Level remains constant at top CRT graticule line.
31. HORIZONTAL POSITION: Single knob provides coarse and fine horizontal adjustment of CRT trace.
32. MAGNIFIER: Selects horizontal deflection factor (normally left in X1 position).
18. REFERENCE LEVEL: Adjusts' power level (in dBm or dBmV) represented |by top CRT graticule line. Large outer knob provides adjustment in calibrated 10-dB steps; FINE vernier provides 12 dB of continuous adjustment.
19. INPUT ATTEN: Selects desired RF input attenuation, indicated by blue numbers
(push and turn).
20. FREQUENCY MHz: Displays spectrum analyzer start or center frequency.
Automatically ranges at approximately
25. SCALE (180TR, 182T): Adjusts CRT graticule illumination.
26. TRACE ALIGN: Adjusts CRT trace alignment with horizontal graticule lines.
27. FOCUS: Adjusts CRT trace sharpness.
33. DISPLAY: Selects CRT sweep source
(normally left in INT position).
34. EXT VERNIER: Provides continuous deflection factor adjustment for external CRT sweep signals. In CAL detent position, deflection factor is selected by MAGNIFIER
(32) control (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).
(36) ac or dc coupling (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).
36. EXT INPUT: BNC input for external CRT sweep signal (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).
NOTE
HORIZONTAL EXT INPUT does not sweep the spectrum analyzer first
LO. Analyzer should be set to 0
(zero) FREQ SPANIDIV, AUTO
TIMEIDIV, and SINGLE SWEEP
TRIGGER- when operated with an external horizontal input.
37. Switch with indicator light for turning power ON and OFF.
NOTE
See Appendix A for details regarding HP 181TITR Variable
Persistence Storage Display
Mainframes.
HP 8558B Front Panel, Option 001
HP 8558B Front Panel, Option 002
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 3-1. HP 8558B Installed in HP 182T Display Mainframe
Model 8558B
REAR PANEL FEATURES
1.
P1 Connector: Connects spectrum analyzer plug-in to display mainframe.
output impedance. Output bandwidth controlled by spectrum analyzer
2.
HORIZ GAIN: Allows
±
1/2 major division of horizontal gain adjustment to calibrate spectrum analyzer plug-in with display mainframe.
RESOLUTION BW setting; output amplitude controlled by INPUT ATTEN,
REFERENCE LEVEL FINE, and first six REFERENCE LEVEL positions
(i.e., with 0 dB input attenuation, - 10 through -60 dBm; for Option 002, +
40 through - 10 dBmV).
3.
AUX A Vertical Output: BNC output provides detected video signal from a
50-ohm output impedance. Typical 0-800 mV range corresponds to full
8-division display deflection.
6.
AUX D Horizontal Output: BNC output provides horizontal sweep voltage from a 5Kohm output impedance. -5V to + 5V range corresponds to full
10-division display deflection.
4.
AUX B PENLIFT/BLANKING OUTPUT: BNC output provides a + 15V penlift/blanking signal from a 10K-ohm output impedance when CRT trace is blanked. Otherwise, output is low at 0V (low impedance, 150 mA max.) for an unblanked trace.
7.
Z-Axis Input: BNC input with a 5K-ohm impedance allows external modulation of CRT trace intensity. Approximately + 2V blanks normalintensity trace; negative voltage increases trace intensity. Maximum input voltage
±
20 Vdc.
5.
AUX C 21.4 MHz IF OUTPUT: BNC output provides 21.4 MHz IF signal
(linearly related to spectrum analyzer RF input) from a 50-ohm 8.
NORMALIZER INTER-CONN (180TR/182T): Provides connections for HP
8750A Storage Normalizer.
Figure 3-2. Rear Panel Controls and Connectors (1 of 2)
3-6
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
20
21
22
23
24
36
37
38
39
40
32
33
34
35
41
42
43
44
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
4
5
6
2
3
1
1
1
7
8
9
10
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
45
46
46
47
47
58
59
60
61
62
55
56
56
57
63*
64
65
66*
Reference
Designation
0624-0099
0624-0206
2200-0103
2360-0115
2200-0170
0380-0005
2260-0003
2200-0105
2200-0164
2200-0168
08558-00108
08558-00089
08558-00088
08558-00087
0380-0005
3050-0105
1400-0082
2420-0001
2190-0016
2950-0043
2190-0068
2950-0054
0370-0606
5040-8817
08565-40011
08558-60161
08558-60164
08558-60165
08558-00114
08558-00121
08558-00122
08558-00116
08558-00115
08558-00003
5061-5426
08565-20093
08558-20037
08558-20036
08565-20051
08558-2003 8
08565-20096
5021-3229
08558-00030
08558-20164
08557-60045
2200-0165
2360-0194
2200-0104
2360-0201
1460-0532
08558-60166
08558-60167
08558-0012 3
08565-00043
0510-0089
08565-60047
08558-20161
08558-20162
5040-8819
0590-1251
0370-1121
08558-60170
08558-60031
08558-60038
0370-3021
08558-20163
08559-20050
0370-3006
0370-3004
08565-60170
2190-0390
2950-0001
2200-0119
3050-0929
4
5
1
7
9
4
0
2
4
3
1
2
3
8
5
9
5
1
6
9
8
4
1
1
7
4
3
1
2
8
9
7
5
8
9
2
1
4
3
0
2
7
1
0
9
3
9
6
9
1
2
8
5
6
6
3
1
3
5
0
0
7
5
5
3
8
5
6
6
8
0
2
6
8
1
6
2
1
1
3
1
1
81
1
12
3
1
2
1
2
2
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
8
1
6
2
2
4
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
3
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
HP Part C
Number D Qty Description
MECHANICAL CHASSIS PARTS
NOTE
COMPLETE FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLIES (LISTED
BELOW) INCLUDE A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSY,
PANEL, ALL KNOBS, & PROBE POWER INPUT, CAL
OUTPUT, AND LO OUTPUT CABLES
FRONT PANEL ASSY (STD.)
FRONT PANEL ASSY (OPT. 001)
FRONT PANEL ASSY (OPT. 002)
PANEL-FRONT (STD.)
PANEL-FRONT (OPT.001)
PANEL-FRONT (OPT.002)
SIDE GUSSET (LEFT)
SIDE GUSSET (RIGHT)
PANEL (REAR)
GUIDE RAIL (TOP)
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED
EXTRUSION, END PLATE ENCLOSURE
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE
EXTRUSION, ENCLOSURE DIVIDER
EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED
WINDOW, FREQ. DISPLAY (GLUED TO 1)
INSULATOR-GUIDE RAIL (BOTTOM)
GUIDE RAIL (BOTTOM)
CABLE ASSY (W10) VERTICAL OUTPUT
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .312-IN-LG 100 DEG
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-TPG 4-40 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-TPG 6-32 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 440 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 6-32 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 440 .625-IN-LG 82 DEG
SPACER-RND .312 IN-LG .18-IN-ID
NUT-HEX-PLSTC LKG 4-40-THD .141-IN-THK
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .188-IN-LG UNCT 82 DEG
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .438-IN-LG 82 DEG
COVER-LOG AMPLIFIER
COVER-BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1
COVER-STEP GAIN
COVER-BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2
SPACER-RND .312 IN-LG .18-IN-ID
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID
CLAMP-CABLE .125-iDIA .375-WD NYL
NUT-HEX-W/LKWR 6-32-THD .109-IN-THK
WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK
1 WASHER-LK INTL T 1/2 IN .505-IN-ID
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 1/2-28-THD .125-IN-THK
BEZEL-PB .330-IN-SQ;JADE GRAY
PUSHBUTTON- SQUARE; JADE GRAY
POINTER-INPUT ATTENUATOR
SPRING-CONICAL
KNOB ASSY-REFERENCE LEVEL (OPT. 002)
KNOB ASSY-REFERENCE LEVEL (STD. OPT. 001)
INDEX DISK (OPT. 002) REFERENCE LEVEL
INDEX DISK (STD. OPT. 001) REFERENCE LEVEL
RETAINER-RING BSC EXT .188-IN-DIA BE-CU
KNOB ASSY, REF. LEVEL (FINE)
KNOB ASSY, RESOLUTION BW
KNOB ASSY, FREQ. SPAN/DIV
PUSHBUTTON-SQUARE, WILLOW GREEN
NUT-SPCLY 15/32-32-THD .1-IN-THK .562-WD
KNOB-LOCK
CABLE ASSY-PROBE POWER (W16)
CABLE ASSY-75 OHM INPUT (W1) OPT. 001, 002
CABLE ASSY-50 OHM INPUT (W1) STD. SEE FIG 6-1
KNOB ASSY-MANUAL SWEEP
KNOB ASSY-SWEEP TIME/DIV
KNOB ASSY-SWEEP TRIGGER
KNOB ASSY-FINE TUNE
KNOB ASSY-COARSE TUNE
KNOB-BASELINE CLIP/VIDEO FILTER
WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK
SCREW-MACH 440 1-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD
(SHIM WASHER, NOT SHOWN, USED WITH 63 FOR
PROPER SPACING BETWEEN 46 AND 47.)
7-2. Front Panel Assembly (2 of 3) (CHANGE A)
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
0624-0099
0624-0206
2200-0103
2360-0115
2200-0170
0380-0005
2260-0003
2200-0105
2200-0164
2200-0168
08558-00108
08558-00089
08558-0008 8
08558-00087
0380-0005
3050-0105
1400-0082
2420-0001
2190-0016
2950-0043
2190-0068
2950-0054
0370-0606
5040-8817
08565-40011
08558-60161
08558-60164
08558-60165
08558-00114
08558-00121
08558-00122
08558-00116
08558-00115
08558-00003
5061-5426
08565-20093
08558-20037
08558-20036
08565-20051
08558-20038
08565-20096
5021-3229
08558-00030
08558-20164
08557-60045
2200-0165
2360-0194
2200-0104
2360-0201
1460-0532
08558-60166
08558-60167
08558-00123
08565-00043
0510-0089
08565-60047
08558-20161
08558-20162
5040-8819
0590-1251
0370-1121
08558-60170
08558-60031
08558-60038
0370-3021
08558-20163
08559-20050
0370-3006
0370-3004
08565-60170
2190-0390
2950-0001
2200-0119
3050-0929
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
6-31/6-32 (blank)
Figure 6-2. Mechanical Chassis Parts
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
42
43
44
45
46
58
59
60
61
62
54
55
56
57
63
64
65
66
72
73
74
75
76
77
67
68
69
70
71
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
17
18
19
20
21
33
34
35
36
37
29
30
31
32
38
39
40
41
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
Reference
Designation
A2
08559-20040
1430-0568
1460-1542
5001-5825
2100-3452
2100-3593
1430-0567
2190-0390
3050-0086
1460-0019
08558-60168
08558-60171
2200-0103
5001-5817
3050-0105
1430-0036
5001-5816
5021-3220
08558-20058
5021-3225
1460-1860
08558-40004
08558-20139
2100-3332
08558-20030
08558-40005
5061-5423
5021-3221
08558-20061
5061-5422
5021-3217
1490-0841
3050-0080
08558-00021
2100-0542
3050-0017
5021-3213
1460-0012
5021-3227
1480-0017
5001-5818
5021-3218
08559-60060
08558-60098
5021-3224
1410-0006
1460-0623
1480-0059
08558-20066
08558-20059
08558-20089
1460-1376
5061-5424
3050-0032
2200-0105
5001-5813
5001-5814
2260-0009
2200-0111
0380-0034
0510-0015
5021-3226
1460-0578
5061-5425
0510-0027
08558-00053
1460-0537
2950-0001
2190-0016
08558-40007
2190-0067
2950-0006
2100-3066
3050-0028
2100-3973
08558-20114
08558-20113
6
2
8
8
8
2
7
4
6
8
6
9
5
8
9
5
3
6
6
2
6
3
3
3
3
6
0
8
7
1
9
4
0
5
4
6
6
0
3
2
9
4
8
4
2
3
7
8
4
3
0
3
6
5
8
4
8
4
3
2
8
8
0
8
7
7
2
2
5
6
9
4
8
7
4
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
I
5
1
2
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
5
4
1
1
2
2
7
1
1
1
1
3
3
1
4
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
7
3
11
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
HP Part C
Number D Qty
08558-60100 2 1
Description
FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (MECH PARTS)
NOTE
SEE A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSY LISTING FOR
ELECTRICAL PARTS; SEE FIG 6-2 FOR FRONT
PANEL PARTS
DIECAST-FRONT SWITCH
SPRING-CPRSN .135-IN-OD .688-IN-OA-LG
SHAFT-LOCKING
PIN-DOWEL .125 OD
LINK-LOCKING
SHAFT-REF LEVEL
HUB ASSEMBLY-DRIVE, ANTI-CRUSH
ROTOR-ATTENUATOR DRIVE
SHAFT-FREQUENCY SPAN
BALL-BRG TYPE .1875-DIA GRADE-50 SST
SPRING-COMPRESSION .18-IN-OD .312-IN-OA-L
PIN-ROLL
ROTOR-FREQUENCY SPAN
HUB-DRIVE
BUSHING-SLOTTED
SPRING-HAIRPIN
SHAFT ASSEMBLY-ATTENUATOR
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 8 .189-IN-ID
SCREW-MACH 4 -40 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
BRACKET-LEFT DPM MOUNTING
BRACKET-RIGHT DPM MOUNTING
NUT-HEX-W/LKWR 4-40-THD .094-IN-THK
SCREW-MACH 4-40.5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
SPACER-RND .312-IN-LG .116-IN-ID
RETAINER-RING E-R EXT.125-IN-DIA STL
SHAFT-MANUAL SWEEP
SPRING-COMPRESSION
ROTOR/SHAFT ASSEMBLY, DOUBLE CONTACT
RETAINER-PUSH ON
STOP ARM
SPRING-HORSESHOE
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK
WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID
KNOB-FREQ. ZERO
WASHER-LK INTL T 1/4 IN .256-IN-ID
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 1/4-32-THD .094-IN-THK
RESISTOR-VAR 5K 5% PREC WW (A2R3) FREQ.
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 12 .25-IN-ID
RESISTOR-VAR 50K 20% 5W(VIDEO FILTER)
SHAFT-FINE TUNE
SHAFT-COARSE TUNE
BUSHING-COARSE TUNE SHAFT
GEAR-SPUR, 40T
SPRING-UNIVERSAL COUPLER
BRACKET-DUAL POT
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 10K 10%
RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%
GEAR-SPUR, 60T
WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD
WASHER-FL MTLC 3/8 IN .406-IN-ID
SPRING-COMPRESSION
CABLE ASSY, DPM RIBBON (A2A1W1) (P/O A2A1)
CABLE ASSY, INT RIBBON (A2A1W2) (P/O A2A1)
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
BRACKET-ATTENUATOR
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID
GEAR-MIT 16-T 32-DP 20-DG PA BRS
DETENT-BANDWIDTH
STUD-.500-IN-LG, 4-40 THD
HUB-COUPLING
SHAFT-BANDWIDTH
SPRING-CPRSN .18-IN-OD
ROTOR-SINGLE CONTACT
SPACER-ROTOR
RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 20% CC 1-TRN(A2A1R4)
BOARD-BANDWIDTH SWITCH (P/O A2A1)
ROTOR-DOUBLE CONTACT
DETENT-REF. LEVEL
STANDOFF-1 .438-1N-LG 4-40 THD
LOCKOUT-ROTATING
LOCATOR-INDEX DISC
SHAFT-REF. LEVEL (FINE)
COUPLING-RGD .375-LG BRS
WASHER-FL NM NO. 5 .13-IN-ID .25-IN-OD
PLATE-REF. LEVEL, FINE POT
RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN
WASHER-FL MTLC .25-IN-ID
Mfr.
Code
28480
Mfr Part Number
08558-60100
08559-20040
1430-0568
1460-1542
5001-5825
2100-3452
2100-3593
1430-0567
2190-0390
3050-0086
1460-0019
08558-60168
08558-60171
2200-0103
5001-5817
3050-0105
G462Y(MOD)
5001-5816
5021-3220
08558-20058
5021-3225
C0180-014-0310-S
08558-40004
08558-20139
2100-3332
08558-20030
08558-40005
5061-5423
5021-3221
08558-20061
5061-5422
5021-3217
1490-0841
3050-0080
08558-00021
2100-0542
3050-0017
5021-3213
1460-0012
5021-3227
1480-0017
5001-5818
5021-3218
08559-60060
08558-60098
5021-3224
GRADE 50
1460-0623
1480-0059
08558-20066
08558-20059
08558-20089
1460-1376
5061-54240
3050-0032
2200-0105
5001-5813
5001-5814
2260-0009
2200-0111
0380-0034
0510-0015
5021-3226
1460-0578
5061-5425
0510-0027
08558-00053
1460-0537
2950-0001
2190-0016
08558-40007
2190-0067
2950-0006
2100-3066
3050-0028
2100-3973
08558-20114
08558-20113
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
71041
28480
28480
28480
28480
92830
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
78707
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
6-33/6-34 (blank)
Figure 6-3. Front Switch Assembly
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
Reference
Designation
110
111
112
113
114
105
106
107
108
109
101
102
103
104
104
96
97
98
99
100
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
83
84
85
86
87
78
79
80
81
82
73
74
75
76
77
93
94
94
94
95
88
89
90
91
92
HP Part C
Number D Qty
3101-0044
00183-67407
0510-0045
0590-0012
08558-20093
08558-00045
08558-00044
5060-0467
08558-60038
08558-60031
08558-00107
0380-0063
1430-0567
1430-0568
1460-1542
3050-0086
08558-00069
08558-00070
08558-20111
08558-20112
08558-20113
08558-20114
1460-0623
2200-0165
6960-0016
2200-0121
2190-0004
2950-0001
7120-7136
2260-0001
08558-20056
08558-20058
2190-0102
3050-0124
08558-20055
3030-0332
08558-40007
2950-0142
08558-20049
2200-0151
08558-20048
1460-0537
08558-00053
08558-00026
2200-0151
2950-0054
2190-0068
2200-0155
08558-20071
08558-20092
08558-00082
08558-00083
08558-00084
2950-0072
9
1
2
6
2
8
9
3
1
4
6
5
8
7
8
6
5
1
7
8
8
0
4
9
0
6
3
4
0
5
8
6
3
5
6
8
2
9
4
5
8
5
3
9
4
5
7
3
3
5
4
0
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
1
2
Description
Mfr.
Code Mfr Part Number
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 4-40
SHAFT, BANDWIDTH
HUB, COUPLING
WASHER-LK INTL T-15/32 IN .472-IN-ID
WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 5 .13-IN-ID
SHAFT, MANUAL SWEEP
SCREW-SET 2-56 .094-IN-LG CUP-PT SST
KNOB, KNURLED
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .635-IN-THX
SHAFT, SWEEP TIME
WASHER-FL NM ¼ IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD
SHAFT, SWEEP TRIGGER
SPRING-TRSN MUW CD
STOP ARM
DETENT, SWEEP TRIGGER
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .75-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ½-28-THD .125-IN-THX
WASHER-LK INTL T ½ IN .505-IN-ID
SCRE-MACH 4-40 1-IN1LG PAN-HD-POZI
CABLE, LO OUTPUT
SHAFT, LATCH
PANEL, FRONT (SEE FIG. 6-2 FOR SUB-PANEL)
PANEL, FRONT (OPTION 001)
PANEL, FRONT (OPTION 002)
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ¼-32-THD .062-IN-THK
SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN 28480
KNOB 28480
RETAINER-RING F-R EXT .188-IN-DIA STL
NUT-KNRLD-R 15/32-32-THD .062-IN-THK
KNOB, LATCH
28480
28480
28480
KNOB, MANUAL SWEEP
KNOB, SWEEP TIME
CONNECTOR, MALE, PROBE POWER
CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF
CABLE ASSY, 75 OHM INPUT, RF
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
KNOB, TRIGGER SWITCH
SPACER-RND .125-IN-LG .129-IN-ID
GEAR, SPUR, 60 T
GEAR, SPUR, 40 T
SPRING, UNIVERSAL COUPLER
WASHER-FL MTLC 3/8 IN .406-IN-ID
SPRING
BRACKET, DUAL POT
BUSHING, COARSE TUNE SHAFT
WASHER, THRUSH
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
SHAFT, COARSE TUNE
SHAFT, FINE TUNE
SPRING-CPRSN .18-INOD .312-IN-OA-LG MUW
SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG
PLUG-HOLE TR-HD FOR .125-D-HOLE NYL
SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.1258-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI
WASHER-LK INTL T NO. 6 .115-IN-ID
NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK
LABEL, HP LOGO
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
28480
08558-20113
08558-20114
1460-0623
2200-0165
6960-0016
2200-0121
2190-0004
2950-0001
7120-7136
Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (2 of 3) (CHANGE A)
2260-0001
08558-20056
08558-20058
2190-0102
3050-0124
08558-20055
3030-0332
08558-40007
2950-0142
08558-20049
2190-0390
08558-20048
1460-0537
08558-00053
08558-00026
2200-0151
2950-0054
2190-0068
2200-0155
08558-20071
08558-20092
08558-00082
08558-00083
08558-00084
2950-0072
3101-0044
00183-67407
0510-0045
0590-0012
08558-20093
08558-00045
08558-00044
5060-0467
08558-60038
08558-60031
08558-00107
0380-0063
1430-0567
1430-0568
1460-1542
3050-0086
08558-00069
08558-00070
08558-20111
08558-20112
7-11/7-12 (blank)
Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (3 of 3) (CHANGE A)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
Figure 7-3. Front Switch Assembly A2, Schematic (CHANGE A)
7-13/7-14 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Model 8558B
Figure 7-6. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly Schematic (CHANGE B)
7-25/7-26 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-5. Simplified Block Diagram
8-15/8-16 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-6. Troubleshooting Block Diagram
8-17/8-18 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-11. A1A2 DPM Driver (and DPM Display), Schematic
8-23/8-24
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-13. A2 Front Switch, Schematic Diagram
8-27/8-28 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-18. A3 Input Attenuator, A4 First Converter, A5 Second Converter and A6 YIG Oscillator, Schematic
8-35/8-36 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-20. A7 Frequency Control, Schematic
8-43/8-44 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-23. A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic (1 of 2)
8-53/8-54 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-23. A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic (2 of 2)
8-55/8-56 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-26. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Schematic
8-61/8-62 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-30. A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1, Schematic
8-69/8-70 (blank)
Figure 8-33. A12 Step Gain, Schematic
8-75/8-76 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-35. A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2, Schematic
8-79/8-80 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
SERIAL PREFIX: 2147A
Figure 8-38. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic (1 of 2)
8-85/8-86 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-38. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic (2 of 2)
8-87/8-88 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-42. A15 Vertical driver and Blanking, Schematic
8-95/8-96 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-43. A16 Motherboard Assembly, Components and Test Point Locations Figure 8-44. A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram (1 of 2)
8-97/8-98
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-44. A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram (2 of 2)
8-99/8-100 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-46. A17 Inverter. Schematic
8-103/8-104 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
Figure 8-47. Location of Major Assemblies
8-105/8-106 (blank)
TM 11-6625-3061-14
PIN: 059359-000
advertisement
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project